Engineering Procedures For ABC Waters Design Features
Engineering Procedures For ABC Waters Design Features
Engineering Procedures For ABC Waters Design Features
Spillway Outletand Embankment
Spillway length to convey above design flow (100yr ARI)
Spillway level typically set atop of extended detention of
downstream treatment system and 0.3m above control
outlet and standing water level in sedimentation basin.
Afflux over spillway and provision of freeboard (0.3m) define
top of embankment
Concrete sill and downslope rock protection
Solid (Rock) Base
To detect when base has been
reached during de-silting
Stormwater Pipe Outfall
Energy dissipation and scour
protection
Permanent Pool
Sized to remove target sediment
size
Gross pollutant trap
(depending on catchment)
Removal of Litter and debris
Sediment Storage Volume
Sized to ensure desilting required every
5 years
Approximately half the permanent pool
volume
Control Outlet
Discharge capacity typically for design operation
flow (1yr ARI). In cases were outlet discharges
to conveyance system than outlet capacity set to
above design flow of the minor flood (2, 10 or
100yr ARI)
Typically formed by overflow pit and pipe
connection.
Surcharge over outlet established by spillway
outlet crest level
Flood debris guard (letter box grate)
Control Outlet
Discharge capacity typically for design operation
flow (1yr ARI). In cases where outlet discharges
to conveyance system, then outlet capacity set to
above design flow of the minor flood (2, 10 or
100yr ARI)
Typically formed by overflow pit and pipe
connection.
Surcharge over outlet established by spillway
outlet crest level
Flood debris guard (letter box grate)
Spillway Outlet and Embankment
Spillway length to convey above design flow (100yr ARI)
Spillway level typically set atop of extended detention of
downstream treatment system and 0.3m above control
outlet and standing water level in sedimentation basin.
Afflux over spillway and provision of freeboard (0.3m) define
top of embankment
Concrete sill and downslope rock protection
Solid (Rock) Base
To detect when base has been
reached during de-silting
Stormwater Pipe Outfall
Energy dissipation and scour
protection
Permanent Pool
Sized to remove target sediment
size
Gross pollutant trap
(depending on catchment)
Removal of Litter and debris
Sediment Storage Volume
Sized to ensure desilting required every
5 years
Approximately half the permanent pool
volume
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-3
Almost all sediment bed loads are larger than this target sediment size. By
targeting this particle size for pre-treatment, containment of a significant
proportion of sediment inflow is within the sedimentation basin.
Analysis of the characteristics of particulate nutrients and metals indicates that
coarse to medium sized sediments (i.e. > 125m) have low concentrations of
attached pollutants (e.g. nutrients, heavy metals) when compared to finer
sediment and colloidal particles. Basins sized to target coarse to medium
sized sediment are therefore expected to contain sediment that has low levels
of contamination and are unlikely to require special handling and disposal.
Removal of particles smaller than 125m is best undertaken by treatment
measures other than sedimentation basins (e.g. constructed wetlands and
bioretention systems).
Where the sedimentation basin forms part of a treatment train (i.e. inlet zone of a
constructed wetland) and when available space is constrained, it is important to
ensure that the size of the sedimentation basin is not reduced. If the sedimentation
basin is not sized adequately, larger sediments will not be trapped effectively and the
downstream treatment system is at risk of becoming smothered.
Conversely, a sedimentation basin should not be grossly oversized, as smaller
particles may be allowed to settle (due to longer residence times) and special clean-
out and disposal procedures would be required. Experiences have also shown that
grossly oversized sedimentation systems may also be subject to poor water quality
outcomes including the occurrence of algal blooms.
4.2.3 Sediment Storage
A further consideration in the design of a sedimentation basin is the provision of
adequate storage for settled sediment to prevent the need for frequent desilting.
Typically, a basin is designed to have frequency of desilting (clean-out frequency)
ranging from annually to once every five years (generally triggered when sediment
accumulates to half the basin pool depth).
The volume of accumulated sediment can be estimated from regular monitoring of
sediment levels with a measuring post and reference against the top water level.
Review of global literature suggests that a developing catchment can typically be
expected to discharge between 50m
3
and 200m
3
of sediment per hectare each year.
In a built-up catchment, the annual sediment export is generally one to two orders of
magnitude lower.
No data is available to help estimate the expected sediment load generated from
Singapore urban catchments and data from other sources have been used in the
interim to estimate the required sediment storage. In Australia, an expected mean
annual rate of 1.60m
3
/ha has been suggested (Engineers Australia, 2006).
Sediment loading rate for Singapore catchments may be higher than typically
observed in Australian catchments, owing to higher intensity and magnitude of rainfall.
Preliminary modeling suggests a sediment loading rate as high as 3 m
3
/ha/year may
be more appropriate for Singapore conditions.
4.2.4 Outlet Design
An outlet structure of a sedimentation basin can be configured in many ways and is
generally dependant on its intended operation. In most cases, the outlet design of a
sedimentation basin will consist of a control outlet structure and a spillway outlet
structure:
The control outlet can either be an overflow pit with pipe connection or a weir.
This structure conveys flows up to the design operation flow (Section 4.3.1)
to the downstream treatment system(s).
The spillway outlet weir structure configured to ensure that flows above the
design operation flow (Section 4.3.1) are discharged to a channel or pipe
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-4
system that by-passes the downstream treatment system(s). The spillway
bypass weir level is set above the control outlet structure and typically at the
top of the extended detention depth of the downstream treatment system.
Where the sedimentation basin discharges to a conveyance system (e.g. swale or
piped system), a control outlet may not be required and one outlet structure is often
adequate to convey discharge of all flows including flood flows.
4.2.5 Landscape Design
Sedimentation basins are often located within open space zones areas and can be
landscaped to create a focal point for passive recreation. The suitability of
sedimentation basins as water features will vary depending on catchment type. It
should be borne in mind that, unlike ponds located further down the stormwater
treatment train (see Chapter 10); sedimentation basins bear the first brunt of urban
stormwater pollution. Thus accumulation of gross pollutants, hydrocarbon (particularly
during dry weather flow conditions) and generally poor water quality can be expected.
The introduction of gross pollutant traps may be required if these basins have
important water feature functions.
Landscape design treatments for sedimentation basins generally focus on dense and
tall littoral vegetation planting to shield unsightly sections of the basins, restrict non-
designated access to the open water zone, and therefore increase public safety, but
can also include designated pathways, viewing platforms (preferably located at the
downstream end of the basin), and information signs. Landscape design must also
consider access to the sedimentation basin for maintenance (e.g. excavator).
4.2.6 Vegetation Specification
The role of vegetation in sedimentation basin design is to provide scour and erosion
protection to the basin batters and littoral zone (i.e. the area around the shallow
margin of the sedimentation basin). Terrestrial planting may also be recommended to
screen areas and provide a barrier to steeper batters.
Plant species should be selected based on the water level regime, soil types of the
region, and the life histories, physiological and structural characteristics, natural
distribution, and community groups of the plants. A list of suggested plant species
suitable for sedimentation basins will be developed in consultation with National Parks
Board of Singapore and form an separate guidelines.
Only the waters edge and batters of sedimentation basins should be planted and care
needs to be taken in species selection to ensure vegetative growth will not spread to
cover the deeper water zones. Similarly, floating or submerged macrophytes should
be avoided.
4.2.7 Maintenance
Sedimentation basins are designed with a sediment storage capacity to ensure
sediment removal frequency is acceptable (i.e. typically between once per year to
once every five years, refer to Section 4.2.3).
Maintenance is focus on ensuring inlet erosion protection is operating as designed,
monitoring sediment accumulation and ensuring that the outlet is not blocked with
debris. Cleaning of the sedimentation basin is typically triggered when sediment
accumulates to half the basin depth, determined from regular monitoring of sediment
depth with a measuring post during maintenance visits.
Accessibility for maintenance is an important design consideration. If an excavator is
able to reach all parts of the basin from the top of the batter then an access ramp may
not be required; however, an access track around the perimeter of the basin will be
required and will need to be accommodate in the overall landscape design. If
sediment collection requires earthmoving equipment to enter the basin, a stable ramp
will be required into the base of the sedimentation basin (maximum slope 1:10).
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-5
It is recommended that a sedimentation basin is constructed with a hard (i.e. rock)
bottom (with a bearing capacity to support maintenance machinery when access is
required within the basin). This serves an important role by allowing excavator
operators to detect when they have reached the base of the basin during desilting
operations.
Provision to drain the sedimentation basin of water for maintenance must be
considered (which may involve the use of a pump which is either permanently installed
on site or a portable unit). Approvals must be obtained to discharge flows downstream
receiving waters or to sewer.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-6
4.3 Design Process
The following sections detail the design steps required for sedimentation basins. Key
design steps following the site planning and concept development stages are:
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-7
4.3.1 Step 1: Determine Design Flows
A range of hydrologic methods can be applied to estimate design flows, ranging from
detailed catchment runoff routing models to the simple Rational Method use for typical
drainage design in Singapore. For catchment areas that are relatively small (< 50 ha),
the Rational Method design procedure is considered adequate. For Sedimentation
Basins with large catchments (> 50 ha), a runoff routing model should be used.
Two design discharges are required to size sedimentation basins and their structures:
Design Operation Flow for sizing the basin area and to size a control outlet
structure when discharging directly into a treatment system (e.g. wetland or
bioretention system). The 1 year ARI peak discharge is recommended as the
Design Operation Flow.
Above Design Flow for design of the spillway outlet structure to allow for
bypass of high flows around a downstream treatment system. This is defined by
either the:
Minor design flow (2 to 10 year ARI) corresponding to the discharge capacity
of downstream drainage infrastructure. The required design event for the
minor design flow in Singapore is the 5 year ARI peak discharge (Code of
Practice on Surface Water Drainage). The adoption of the 5 year ARI peak
discharge is appropriate for situations where only the minor drainage system
is directed to the sedimentation basin.
Major flood flow (50 to 100 year ARI) is conveyed by major canal and
waterways and/or designated overland flow paths or floodways within the
urban area that is engaged when the capacity of the local drainage
infrastructure is exceeded. In Singapore, this is either the 50 year or 100 year
ARI peak discharge depending on the catchment land use. This design flow
should be adopted as the Above Design Flow for the sedimentation basin
where both the minor and major drainage systems discharge into the basin.
4.3.2 Step 2: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Sedimentation basins should not be designed to have high flows diverted around
them. All flows should be directed through a sedimentation basin such that some level
of sedimentation is achieved even during high flow conditions.
Figure 4.3 shows the relationship between a required basin area and design discharge
for 125m sediment capture efficiencies of 70%, 80% and 90%. The sizing curves are
based on a typical shape and configuration, having a hydraulic efficiency () of 0.5
(see Section 4.3.3.1; Figure 4.4).
An upper and lower limit is given for the three target capture efficiencies, set by the
absence and presence of a permanent pool, respectively. The influence of a
permanent pool reduces flow velocities in the sedimentation basin and thus increases
detention times in the basin (and hence removal efficiency) and defines the lower limit
of required basin area. The permanent pool has a typical depth of two metres (for
ease of maintenance).
The performance of a typical sedimentation basin design can be expected to fall within
the shaded areas shown in Figure 4.3. As the design charts relate the size of a
required sedimentation basin to a design flow, they are applicable in all regions within
Singapore and can be used to verify the selected size of a proposed sedimentation
basin anywhere in Singapore.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-8
Figure 4.3 Sedimentation Basin Area Vs Design Discharges for varying capture
efficiencies of 125 m sediment
0
200
400
600
800
1000
1200
1400
1600
1800
0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4
Design Discharge (m
3
/s)
B
a
s
i
n
A
r
e
a
(
m
2
)
70% Capture Efficiency
80% Capture Efficiency
90% Capture Efficiency
0
100
200
300
400
0 0.1 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.6 0.7 0.8 0.9 1
Design Discharge (m
3
/s)
B
a
s
i
n
A
r
e
a
(
m
2
)
70% Capture Efficiency
80% Capture Efficiency
90% Capture Efficiency
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-9
4.3.3 Step 3: Confirm Size and Dimensions of the Sedimentation Basin
4.3.3.1 Sedimentation Basin Configuration
The configuration of a sedimentation basin, defined by its shape and locations of inlet
and outlet structures, has a large impact on the effectiveness of the basin to retain
sediment. The effectiveness of the basin at retaining sediment is described by the
hydraulic efficiency ().
The hydraulic efficiency is greatly influenced by the length to width ratio of the basin,
the relative position of the inlet and the outlet, and the inclusion and placement of any
baffles, islands or flow spreaders. Hydraulic efficiency has a range from 0 to 1, with 1
representing the most efficient configuration for sedimentation. Basins should not be
designed to have a hydraulic efficiency less than 0.5.
Guidance on estimating hydraulic efficiency is given in Figure 4.4. The shape
designed as o in diagrams O and P represent islands in the waterbody and the
double line in diagram Q represents a weir structure to distribute flows evenly
(Persson et al. 1999).
Consideration of maintenance access to a basin is also required when developing the
shape, as this can impact the allowable width (if access is from the banks) or the
shape if access ramps into a basin are required.
Figure 4.4 Hydraulic Efficiency,
4.3.3.2 Internal Batters
Batter slopes above and immediately below the water line of a basin should be
configured with consideration of public safety and landscape integration. Both hard
and soft edge treatments can be applied to compliment the landscape of a surrounding
area. Soft edge treatments involve using gentle slopes to the waters edge (e.g. 1:8 to
1:10), extending below the water line for a distance of between 2 to 3 m before batter
slopes steepen into deeper areas. Hard edge treatments typically have a large vertical
drop from the waters edge to the water line. Such systems may require a handrail for
public safety. In both hard and soft edge treatments, it is recommended to line the
bottom of the basin with rock to prevent vegetation (particularly weed) growth and to
guide extraction depths during sediment removal.
The safety requirements for individual basins will vary from site to site, and it is
recommended that developers engage an independent safety audit of each design. At
present no guidelines exist in Singapore for the design of Sedimentation Basins. In
their absence it is recommended that the following be adopted:
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-10
-
For water depths > 150 mm and maximum slope of 5:1 (H:V) or less, no
fencing is required.
-
For water depths > 150 mm and maximum slope > 5:1 (H:V) fencing is
required.
Figure 4.5 Design considerations for soft edge treatment for open waterbodies
(Source: GBLA 2004)
Figure 4.6 Design considerations for hard edge treatment for open waterbodies
(Source: GBLA 2004)
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-11
4.3.3.3 Sedimentation Basin Area
The required area (A) of a sedimentation basin can be defined through the use of the
(modified) Fair and Geyer (1954) expression of the sedimentation equation, i.e.:
n
*
e
p e
S
s
) d (d
) d (d
Q/A
v
n
R
+
+
+ =
1
1 1
Equation 4.1
Where
R = fraction of target sediment removed
v
s
= settling velocity of target sediment
Q/A
S
= applied flow rate divided by basin surface area (m
3
/s/m
2
)
n = turbulence or short-circuiting parameter
d
e
= extended detention depth (m) above permanent pool level
d
p
= depth (m) of the permanent pool
d* = depth below the permanent pool level that is sufficient to retain the target
sediment (m) adopt 1.0 m or d
p
whichever is lower.
Good practice in the design of sedimentation basins is to include a permanent pool to
reduce flow velocities and provide storage of settled sediment. The presence of a
permanent pool reduces flow velocities in the sedimentation basin and thus increases
detention times. With the outlet structure being located some distance above the bed
of a sedimentation basin, it is also not necessary for sediment particles to settle all the
way to the bed of the basin to be effectively retained. It is envisaged that sediments
need only settle to an effective depth (d*) which is less than the depth to the bed of the
sedimentation basin. This depth is considered to be approximately 1.0 m below the
permanent pool level.
The turbulence parameter, n, is related to hydraulic efficiency () described in Section
4.3.3.1. A value of n is estimated using the following relationship:
=
=
1
1
1
1
n
n
Equation 4.2
The concept design stage will generally guide the selection of the fraction of target
sediment removed (R) and permanent pool depth (d
p
) depending on water quality
objectives and the nature of local catchment geology. The selection of the target
sediment size will led to the determination of the theoretical settling velocity of the
target particle size for use in Equation 4.1 to compute removal efficiency for a given
size basin.
Table 4.1 lists the typical settling velocities (v
s
) of sediments under ideal conditions
(velocity in standing water).
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-12
Table 4.1: Settling Velocities (v
s
) under Ideal Conditions
Classification of particle size
Particle diameter
( m)
Settling velocities
(mm/s)
Very coarse sand 2000 200
Coarse sand 1000 100
Medium sand 500 53
Fine sand 250 26
Very fine sand 125 11
Coarse silt 62 2.3
Medium silt 31 0.66
Fine silt 16 0.18
Very fine silt 8 0.04
Clay 4 0.011
Source: (Maryland Dept. of Environment 1987 in Engineers Australia 2006)
4.3.3.4 Storage Volume for Sediments
A further consideration in the design of a sedimentation basin is the provision of
adequate storage for settled sediment to prevent the need for frequent desilting. Basin
desilting is triggered when accumulated sediment reaches half of the permanent pool
volume. To ensure this storage zone is appropriate the following must be met:
The sedimentation basin storage volume (V
s
) is defined as the storage available in the
bottom half of the sedimentation basin permanent pool depth. The sedimentation
basin storage volume can be determined by applying the following equation:
( )
2 2
T b
p
A A
d
V
+
=
Equation 4.3
Where
A
b
= Area of the basin at the base
A
T
= Area of the basin at half the permanent pool depth
The basin areas are determined based on the surface dimensions and the batter
slopes.
The volume of accumulated sediments over period before the basin is desilted (V
s
) is
established by gaining an understanding of the sediment loads entering the
sedimentation basin and applying the fraction of target sediment removed (R):
c o c s
F L R A V =
Equation 4.4
Where
V
s
= volume of sediment storage required (m
3
)
A
c
= contributing catchment area (ha)
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-13
R = capture efficiency (%), estimated from Equation 4.1
L
o
= sediment loading rate (m
3
/ha/year) preliminary MUSIC modelling
suggests a sediment loading rate of 3 m
3
/ha/year may be appropriate for
Singapore conditions.
F
c
= desired cleanout frequency (years)
4.3.4 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems
Stormwater conveyed by a pipe or open channel would normally discharge directly into
a sedimentation basin as this is often the first element of a stormwater treatment train.
It will be necessary to ensure that inflow energy is adequately dissipated to prevent
localised scour in the vicinity of a pipe or channel outlet.
Design of inlet structures for adequate scour protection is common hydraulic
engineering practice and the reader is referred to standard hydraulic design
handbooks for further guidance on design of scour prevention methods and
appropriate sizing of energy dissipation structures (e.g. Henderson 1966; Chow 1959).
If conceptual design of the stormwater system identified the need to remove
anthropogenic litter (i.e. industrial or commercial situations) then some form of gross
pollutant trap (GPT) may be required as part of an inlet structure. The provision of a
GPT will depend on catchment activities as well as any upstream measures in place.
There are a number of proprietary products available for removing gross pollutants.
While there are no suitable references related to gross pollutant traps in Singapore,
the reader is referred to Chapter 7 of Australian Runoff Quality (Engineers Australia
2006). The storage capacity of gross pollutant traps should be sized to ensure that
maintenance (cleanout) frequency is not greater than once every 3 months.
4.3.5 Step 5: Design Outlet Systems
As outlined in Section 4.2.4, the outlet of a sedimentation basin will consist of a
control outlet structure and a spillway outlet structure:
4.3.5.1 Design of Control Outlet - Overflow Pit and Pipe Outlet Configuration
For a sedimentation basin that operates as a pre-treatment within a treatment train
configuration, the control outlet structure discharging to the downstream treatment
system (e.g. constructed wetland) is an overflow pit and pipe with the following design
criteria:
Ensure that the crest of the overflow pit is set at the permanent pool level of
the sedimentation basin.
The overflow pit is sized to convey the design operational flow (e.g. the 1 year
ARI peak discharge from the catchment). The dimension of the outlet pit is
determined by considering two flow conditions: weir and orifice flow as
expressed in Equation 4.5 and Equation 4.6.
Provide protection against blockage of the overflow pit by flood debris by
installation of debris screening (see Figure 4.7).
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-14
Figure 4.7 Examples of debris screens
The following equations apply to the design of control outlet devices:
1. Weir flow condition when free overfall conditions occur over the pit:
2 / 3
w
des
h C B
Q
P
=
Equation 4.5
Where
P = Perimeter of the outlet pit (m)
B = Blockage factor (0.5)
h = Depth of water above the crest of the outlet pit (m)
Q
des
= Design discharge (m
3
/s)
C
W
= Weir coefficient (1.7)
2. Orifice flow conditions when the inlet pit is completely submerged
(corresponding to conditions associated with larger flood events):
h g 2 C B
Q
A
d
des
o
=
Equation 4.6
Where
C
d
= Orifice discharge coefficient (0.6)
B = Blockage factor (0.5)
h = Depth of water above the centroid of the orifice (m)
A
o
= Orifice area (m
2
)
Q
des
= Design discharge (m
3
/s)
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-15
The pipe that connects the sedimentation basin to the downstream treatment system
(e.g. macrophyte zone of a constructed wetland or bioretention system) should have
sufficient capacity to convey the design operational flow (i.e. the 1 year ARI peak flow)
when downstream water level is at the permanent pool level. This ensures the
majority of flows have the opportunity to enter the downstream treatment system
before the bypass system is engaged. As downstream water level increases due to
the filling of the extended detention of the downstream treatment system, the capacity
of the connecting pipe may reduce and ultimately triggering a by-pass from the
sedimentation basin (see Chapter 9 Constructed Wetlands).
An energy dissipater is usually required at the end of the pipes to reduce velocities
and distribute flows into the downstream treatment system.
If the outlet of the connection pipe is submerged, an energy loss equation can be used
to estimate the pipe velocity using the following:
g
V k
h
=
2
2
Equation 4.7
Where:
h = head level driving flow through the pipe (defined as the spillway outlet level
minus the normal water level in the downstream treatment system)
K = head loss coefficient assume k = 2, as a conservative estimate of the sum
of entry and exit loss coefficients (K
in
+ K
out
)
V = pipe velocity (m/s)
g = gravity (9.81 m/s
2
)
The area of pipe required to convey the design operation flow (1 year ARI) is then
calculated by dividing the above design operation flow by the velocity. Alternatively, if
the pipe outlet is not fully submerged, the orifice equation should be used (Equation
4.6) to estimate the size of the connection pipe.
4.3.5.2 Design of Control Outlet Weir Configuration
If a weir outlet structure is to be used instead of an overflow pit and pipe configuration,
the required length of the weir for control outlet operation can be computed using the
weir flow equation (Equation 4.5) and the design operation flow (Section 4.3.1).
Depending on the width of the weir, a weir blockage factor may still be required in
which case a factor of 0.5 is recommended.
4.3.5.3 Design of Spillway Outlet Weir Configuration
For operation under above-design conditions, a spillway outlet weir will required to
safely convey above-design flows.
For sedimentation basins serving as pre-treatment to downstream systems, this
spillway will form part of the high flow bypass system, which protects the downstream
treatment system from scouring during above design storm flows. The spillway
outlet weir level should ideally be set at the top of the extended detention level of the
downstream treatment system.
The length of the spillway outlet weir is to be sized to safely pass the maximum flow
discharged into the downstream treatment system (as defined by the above design
flow in Section 4.3.1). The water level above the crest of the bypass weir plus
freeboard provision (typically 0.3 m) sets the elevation of the embankment crest of the
sedimentation basin.
The required length of the spillway outlet weir can be computed using the weir flow
equation (Equation 4.5) and the above design flow (Section 4.3.1). No provision for
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-16
blockage is necessary (i.e. blockage factor of 1.0). The spillway outlet weir should be
designed using standard methods to avoid scour and erosion. Typically, a concrete sill
is required with rock protection on the downslope sides of the sill. Figure 4.8 shows
typical spillway structures of sedimentation basins providing a means of bypassing
above design flows around downstream constructed wetlands.
Figure 4.8 Example overflow spillway structures of inlet zones (sedimentation
basins) of constructed wetlands.
4.3.6 Step 6: Specify Vegetation
Vegetation planted along the littoral zone of a sedimentation basin serves the primary
function of inhibiting public access to the open waterbody and preventing edge
erosion. Terrestrial planting beyond the littoral zone may also be recommended to
screen areas and provide an access barrier to uncontrolled areas of the stormwater
treatment system.
A list of suggested plant species suitable for sedimentation basin littoral zones will be
developed for Singapore in consultation with National Parks Board of Singapore.
4.3.7 Step 7: Maintenance Plan and Schedule
Consider how maintenance is to be performed on the Sedimentation Basin (e.g. how
and where is access available, where is litter likely to collect etc.). A specific
maintenance plan and schedule should be developed for the basin, either as part of a
maintenance plan for the whole treatment train, or for each individual asset. Guidance
on maintenance plans is provided in Section 4.7.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-17
4.3.8 Design Calculation Summary
The table below provides a design calculation summary sheet for the key design
elements of a sedimentation basin to aid the design process.
Sedimentation Basin CALCULATION CHECKSHEET
CALCULATION TASK OUTCOME CHECK
Catchment characteristics
- Land Uses
Residential Ha
Commercial Ha
Roads Ha
- Fraction Impervious
Residential -
Commercial -
Roads -
Weighted average -
Conceptual Design
Basin Area m
2
Notional permanent pool depth m
Permanent pool level of sedimentation basin m
Basin extended detention m
Overflow level m
Identify design criteria
Design operation flow year
Above design flow year
1. Estimate design flow rates
Time of concentration
estimate from flow path length and velocities minutes
Identify rainfall intensities
station used for IFD data:
Design Rainfall Intensity for design operation flow mm/hr
Design Rainfall Intensity for above design flow mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient
Design operation flow
Above design flow
(refer to the Singapore Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage(2000))
Peak design flows
Design operation flow m
3
/s
Above design flow m
3
/s
2. Confirm treatment performance and concept design
Capture efficincy of sedimentation basin %
3. Confirm size and dimensions of sedimentation basin
- Inlet design
Area of sedimentation basin m
2
Aspect Ratio L:W (1)
Hydraulic Efficiency
Depth of permanent pool m
- Internal batters
Cross Section Batter Slope (below permanent pool depth) V:H (1)
- Sediment Storage Volume
Sediment storage volume, Vs
m
3
Volume of accumulated sediment over 5years (Vs,5yr) m
3
Vs>Vs,5year -
Sediment clean-out frequency, given Vs years
4. Design inflow systems
Scour protection and/or energy dissipation provided
5. Design outlet structures
- Overflow pit
Pit dimension L x B
Overflow crest level m
Provision of debris trap -
- Connection Pipe
Connection pipe dimension mm dia
Connection pipe invert level m
- Control outlet weir (Spillway)
Weir crest level m
Weir length m
Afflux m
Freeboard to top of embankment m
6. Vegetation Specification
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-18
4.4 Checking tools
The following sections provide a number of checking aids for designers and referral
authorities.
Checklists have been provided for:
-
Design assessments
-
Construction (during and post)
-
Operation and maintenance inspections
4.5 Design assessment checklist
The checklist below presents the key design features that should be reviewed when
assessing a design of a sedimentation basin either for temporary or permanent use.
These considerations include configuration, safety, maintenance and operational
issues that should be addressed during the design phase.
Where an item results in an N when reviewing the design, referral should be made
back to the design procedure to determine the impact of the omission or error.
In addition to the checklist, a proposed design should have all necessary permits for its
installations. The referral agency should ensure that all relevant permits are in place.
These can include permits to clear vegetation, to dredge, create a waterbody, divert
flows or disturb downstream aquatic habitats.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-19
Checklist 1: Sedimentation basin design checklist
Sedimentation Basin Design Assessment Checklist
Basin Location:
Hydraulics: Design operational flow (m
3
/s): Above design flow (m
3
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Basin Area (ha):
TREATMENT Y N
Treatment performance verified from sizing curves??
BASIN CONFIGURATION Y N
Inlet pipe/structure sufficient for maximum design flow (minor and/or major flood event)?
Scour protection provided at inlet?
Basin located upstream of treatment system (i.e. macrophyte zone of wetland)?
Configuration of basin (aspect, depth and flows) allows settling of particles >125 m?
Basin capacity sufficient for desilting period (i.e. >= twice sedimentation accumulation over clean out
frequency?)
Maintenance access allowed for into base of Sedimentation Basin?
Public access to basin prevented through dense vegetation or other means?
Gross pollutant protection measures provided on inlet structures where required?
Freeboard provided to top of embankment?
Public safety design considerations included in design and safety audit of publicly accessible areas
undertaken?
Overall shape, form, edge treatment and planting integrate well (visually) with host landscape?
HYDRAULIC STRUCTURES Y N
'Control' outlet structure required?
'Control' outlet structure sized to convey the design operation flow?
Designed to prevent clogging of outlet structures (i.e. provision of appropriate grate structures)?
'Spillway' outlet control (weir) sufficient to convey 'above design flow'?
'Spillway' outlet has sufficient scour protection?
Visual impact of outlet structures has been considered?
COMMENTS
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-20
4.6 Construction Advice
This section provides general advice for the construction of sedimentation basins. It is
based on observations from construction projects around Australia.
4.6.1 Building phase damage
It is important to have protection from upstream flows during construction of a
Sedimentation Basin. A mechanism to divert flows around a construction site,
protection from litter and debris is required.
To overcome the challenges associated within delivering sedimentation basins a
staged approach to construction and establishment should be adopted (Leinster,
2006):
Stage 1: Functional Installation. The functional elements of the sedimentation basin
are constructed as part of civil works. The basin is allowed to form part of the
sediment and erosion control strategy.
Stage 2: Sediment and Erosion Control. During the Building Phase the sedimentation
basin will form part of the sediment and erosion control strategy to protect downstream
aquatic ecosystems.
Stage 3: Operational Establishment. At the completion of the Building Phase, the
sedimentation basins can be desilted (to establish the design bathymetry) and
landscaped.
Protection from vehicular impact during construction should be provided by traffic
controlling devices (for example, bollards).
4.6.2 High flow contingencies
Contingencies to manage risks associated with flood events during construction are
required. All machinery should be stored above acceptable flood levels and the site
stabilised as well as possible at the end of each day. Plans for dewatering following
storms should also be made.
4.6.3 Maintenance access
An important component of a Sedimentation Basin is accessibility for maintenance.
Should excavators be capable of reaching all parts of the basin an access track may
not be required to the base of the inlet zone; an access track around the perimeter of
the basin is required regardless. If sediment is collected using earthmoving
equipment, then a stable ramp will be required into the base of the inlet zone
(maximum slope 1:10).
4.6.4 Solid base
To aid maintenance it is recommended to construct the inlet zone either with a hard
(i.e. rock or concrete) bottom or a distinct sand layer. These serve an important role
for determining the levels that excavation should extend to during sediment removal
(i.e. how deep to dig) for either systems cleaned from the banks or directly accessed.
Hard bases are also important if maintenance is by driving into the basin.
4.6.5 Dewatering removed sediments
An area should be constructed that allows for dewatering of removed sediments from
a Sedimentation Basin. This allows the removed sediments to be transported as dry
material and can greatly reduce disposal costs compared to liquid wastes. This area
should be located such that water from the material drains back into the basin.
Material should be allowed to drain for a minimum of overnight before disposal.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-21
4.6.6 Inlet checks
It is good practice to check the operation of inlet erosion protection measures following
the first few rainfall events. It is important to check for these early in the systems life, to
avoid continuing problems. Should problems occur in these events the erosion
protection should be enhanced.
4.6.7 Timing for Planting
Timing of vegetation planting is dependent on a suitable time of year (and potential
irrigation requirements) as well as timing in relation to the phases of development.
Consideration should be made for:
-
Growth period (relative to planting). It is recommended that plants be planted
within their growth period to allow the plants to go through a growth period
soon after planting
-
Establishment of root zone prior to wet season
Further advice from the National Parks Board of Singapore should be sought when
considering the suitable timing for planting.
4.6.8 Weed Control
Weed control along the littoral zone of a sedimentation basin is best undertaken
through a combination of high planting density and applying suitable biodegradable
erosion control matting. Organic mulch is generally not recommended for the littoral
zone affected by frequent inundation. If the use of mulch on the littoral zones is
preferred, it must be secured in place with appropriate mesh or netting (e.g. jute
mesh).
4.6.9 Construction Inspection Checklist
The following checklist presents the key items to be reviewed when inspecting the
sedimentation basin during and at the completion of construction. The checklist is to
be used by Construction Site Supervisors and local authority Compliance Inspectors to
ensure all the elements of the sedimentation basin have been constructed in
accordance with the design. If an item is ticked as unsatisfactory appropriate actions
must be specified and delivered to rectify the construction issue before final inspection
sign-off is given.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-22
Checklist 2: Construction inspection checklist: Sedimentation Basin
Sedimentation Basin Construction Inspection Checklist
Inspected by:
Site: Date:
Time:
Constructed
by:
Weather:
Contact during site visit:
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION
Preliminary works Structural components (continued)
1. Erosion and sediment control plan
adopted
19. No seepage through banks
2. Limit public access 20. Inlet energy dissipation installed
3. Location same as plans 21. No seepage through banks
4. Site protection from existing flows 22. Ensure spillway is level
Earthworks 23. Provision of maintenance drain
5. Integrity of banks 24. Collar installed on pipes
6. Batter slopes as plans Vegetation
7. Impermeable (e.g. clay) base installed 25. Stabilisation immediately following
earthworks and planting of terrestrial
landscape around basin
8. Maintenance access (e.g. ramp)
installed
26. Weed removal prior to planting
9. Compaction process as designed 27. Planting as designed (species and
densities)
10. Level of base, banks/ spillway as
designed
28. Vegetation layout and densities as
designed
11. Check for groundwater intrusion Sediment and erosion control
12. Stabilisation with sterile grass
29. Sedimentation Basins to be used
during construction
Structural components 30. Silt fences and traffic control in
place
13. Location and levels of outlet as
designed
14. Safety protection provided
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-23
15. Pipe joints and connections as
designed
16. Concrete and reinforcement as
designed
17. Inlets appropriately installed
18. Inlet energy dissipation installed
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 8. Check for uneven settling of banks
2. Confirm structural element sizes 9. Evidence of stagnant water, short
circuiting or vegetation scouring
3. Check batter slopes 10. Evidence of litter or excessive
debris
4. Vegetation plantings as designed 11. Inlet erosion protection working
5. Erosion protection measures working 12. Maintenance access provided
6. Maintenance access provided 13. Construction generated sediment
removed (including desilting of
sedimentation basin if used during
construction)
7. Public safety adequate 14. Provision of removed sediment
drainage area
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED
1.
2.
3.
4.
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-24
4.7 Maintenance Requirements
Sedimentation basins treat runoff by slowing flow velocities and promoting settlement
of coarse to medium sized sediments. Maintenance is focus on ensuring inlet erosion
protection is operating as designed, monitoring sediment accumulation and ensuring
that the outlet is not blocked with debris.
Inspections of the inlet configuration following storm events should be made soon after
construction to check for erosion. In addition, regular checks of sediment build up will
be required as sediment loads from developing catchments or construction sites vary
enormously. The basins should be cleaned out if more than half full of accumulated
sediment.
Similar to other types of practices, debris removal and weed control is an ongoing
maintenance function. Debris, if not removed, can block inlets or outlets, and can be
unsightly if located in a visible location. Inspection and removal of debris should be
done regularly, but debris should be removed whenever it is observed on the site.
Weed management in sedimentation basins is important to ensure that weeds do not
out-compete the species planted for the particular design requirements.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-25
4.7.1 Operation & Maintenance Inspection Form
The form below should be used whenever an inspection is conducted and kept as a
record on the asset condition and quantity of removed pollutants over time.
Checklist 3: Sedimentation Basin maintenance checklist
Sedimentation Basin Maintenance Checklist
Inspection Frequency: 1 to 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS Y N Action Required (details)
Litter accumulation?
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Sediment requires removal (record depth, remove if >50%)?
All structures in satisfactory condition (pits, pipes, ramps etc)?
Evidence of dumping (building waste, oils etc)?
Littoral vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Replanting required?
Weeds require removal from within basin?
Settling or erosion of bunds/batters present?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Outlet structure free of debris?
Maintenance drain operational (check)?
Resetting of system required?
COMMENTS
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-26
4.8 Sedimentation Basin Design
Worked Example
4.8.1 Worked example introduction
A sedimentation basin and wetland system is proposed to treat runoff from a freeway
located in Singapore. This worked example focuses on the sedimentation basin (inlet
zone) component of the system. A typical photograph of such a system is shown in
Figure 4.9.
Catchment Description
The sedimentation basin receives stormwater from road runoff. Road runoff is
conveyed by conventional stormwater pipes (up to the 100 year ARI event) and there
are two freeway outfall pipes that discharge to the sedimentation basin. Each outfall
services about 500m length of the 40 m wide freeway, giving a total contributing area
of 2Ha (100% impervious) to each outfall.
Design Objectives
All stormwater runoff will be subjected to primary treatment, by sedimentation of
coarse to medium size sediment.
As the sedimentation basins form part of a treatment train the design requirements of
the sedimentation basin system are to:
Promote sedimentation of particles larger than 125m with a 90% capture
efficiency for flows up to the 1-year ARI (unattenuated) peak discharge.
Provide for connection to the downstream macrophyte zone with discharge
capacity corresponding to the 1-year ARI (unattenuated) peak discharge.
Provide for by-pass operation when the inundation of the downstream macrophyte
zone reaches the design maximum extended detention depth with a discharge
capacity corresponding to the 100-year ARI peak discharge.
Site Constraints and Concept Design
The site is triangular in shape with a surface area of 500 m
2
as shown in Figure 4.10.
The site of the sedimentation basin has a fall of approximately 2m (from RL 5 m to RL
3 m) towards a degraded watercourse.
The conceptual design process established the following key design elements to
ensure effective operation of the constructed wetland and sedimentation basin:
Notional permanent pool depth of sedimentation basin of 2m
Wetland macrophyte zone extended detention depth of 0.5m (permanent water
level of RL 3.4m)
Sedimentation basin permanent pool level (control outlet pit level) 0.3m (RL
3.7m) above the permanent pool level of the wetland
Spillway outlet weir set 0.3 m above the permanent pool of the sedimentation
basin at RL 4.0m such that the spillway is aligned with the top of the extended
detention for the wetland (RL 4.0m) and triggering a by-pass when the water level
in the wetland reaches then top of extended detention.
Landscape Requirements
Landscape design will be required and this will include the following:
-
Littoral zone vegetation
-
Terrestrial vegetation
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-27
Figure 4.9: Sedimentation Basin for Treatment of Freeway Runoff
Freeway Carriageway
Creek
Site of Sedimentation
Basin & Wetland
System
6.0
5.0
4.0
3.0
50 m
20 m
Freeway Carriageway
Creek
Site of Sedimentation
Basin & Wetland
System
6.0
5.0
4.0
3.0
50 m
20 m
Figure 4.10: Layout of Proposed site for Sedimentation Basin
4.8.2 Calculation Steps
The design of the sedimentation basin has been divided into the following 6
calculations steps:
Step 1 Determine Design Flows
Step 2 Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Step 3 Confirm Size and Dimensions of the Sedimentation Basin
Step 4 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems
Step 5 Design outlet structures
Step 6 Vegetation Specification
Details for each calculation step are provided below. A design calculation summary
has been completed for the worked example and is given at the conclusion of the
calculation steps.
Inlet 1
Inlet 2
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-28
Step 1 Determine Design Flows
The procedures in Singapores Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (Part II)
(the Rational Method) are used to determine design flow rates. The coefficients
prescribed in the code of practice are based on land use within the catchment.
The site has two contributing catchments, each catchment being 2Ha in area, 500m
long (along the freeway) and drained by culverts. The time of concentration (t
c
) of the
catchment consists of the overland flow time (t
o
) plus the drain flow time from the most
remote drainage inlet to the point of design (t
d
), viz. t
c
= t
o
+ t
d
.
Overland flow time has been estimated to be relatively short (~ 4 min). A drain flow
velocity of 2m/s was assumed for the purposes of estimating the time of concentration
(t
c
).
min 8
60
min 1
/ 2
500
4 |
\
|
+ =
s s m
m
t
c
Rainfall intensities for Singapore (for the 1yr and 100yr average recurrence intervals)
are estimated using the IDF curves
1
for Singapore, with the time of concentration
equaling 8 minutes. The 1 year ARI rainfall intensity was extrapolated using a log
normal probability scale from the IDF data available:
I
1
~ 110 mm/hr I
100
~ 283 mm/hr
The runoff coefficients for the 1 year and 100 year ARI events were assumed to be 1.0
as given in the Code of Practice for Surface Water Drainage for roads and freeways.
The rational method is described by
360
CIA
Q =
Given the parameters for C, I and A described above:
Q
1
= 1.2 m
3
/s Q
100
= 3.1m
3
/s
In summary, the design flow rates for the sedimentation basin are
Operation Design Discharge = 1.2m
3
/s
Design discharge for connection to
macrophyte zone
= 1.2m
3
/s
Spillway Design Discharge = 3.1m
3
/s
Step 2 Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
An initial estimate of the sedimentation basin area can be established using the curves
provided in Figure 4.3. Assuming a notional permanent pool depth of 2m, a
sedimentation basin area of approximately 260m
2
is required to capture 90% of the
125m particles for flows up to the design operation flow of 1.2m
3
/s.
1
Please Refer to Code of Practice for Surface Water Drainage
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-29
Step 3 Confirm Size and Dimensions of the Sedimentation Basin
Sedimentation Basin Area
Confirmation of the sedimentation basin area is provided by using Equation 4.1:
n
*
e
p e
S
s
) d (d
) d (d
Q/A
v
n
R
+
+
+ =
1
1 1
Given
v
s
= 0.011m/s
Q/A
S
= 0.0046m
3
/s/m
2
d
e
= 0.3m
d
p
= 2m
d* = 1m (as d
P
is not less than 1m)
An aspect ratio of 1 (W) to 4 (L) is adopted based on the available space (Figure 4.10).
Using Figure 4.4 (configuration I), the hydraulic efficiency () is estimated to be
approximately 0.4. This value is less than desirable; however, site constraints prevent
any other configuration. The turbulence factor (n) is computed from Equation 4.2 to be
1.67 and the corresponding removal efficiency to be 88%. This is reasonably close to
the design removal efficiency of 90% but it may be necessary to increase the size of
the basin to compensate for the lower than desired hydraulic efficiency. To achieve
90% capture efficiency, the required basin area would be approximately 300 m
2
.
Sedimentation Basin storage
The sedimentation basin storage volume (V
s
) is defined as the storage available in the
bottom half of the sedimentation basin permanent pool depth.
Considering the relatively small size of the sedimentation basin (8m width), it is not
possible to achieve the notional permanent pond depth of 2m using the 5:1 (H:V)
required for public safety (Section 4.3.3.2). Therefore 4:1 (H:V) batter is to be adopted
for the ground above the permanent pool level and to 0.2m below permanent pool
level. A 2:1 (H:V) internal batter slope is to be adopted for 0.2m to 2m below the
permanent pool level. The sedimentation basin will be fenced around most of its
perimeter to ensure public safety.
Given a 2:1 (H:V) internal batter slope below the permanent water level, the area of
the basin at 1m depth (i.e. half the permanent pool depth) is 115m
2
and at 2m depth
(base of basin) is 2m
2
.
The sedimentation basin storage volume V
s
calculated using Equation 4.3 is
approximately 58m
3
and corresponds to the approximately 11 years of accumulated
sediment (adopting a sediment generation rate of 3 m
3
/ha/yr and a capture efficiency
of 87%)
The dimensions for the sedimentation basin are summarised below.
Open water area = 260m
2
Basin length = 32m
Basin width = 8m
Depth of permanent pool = 2m
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-30
Step 4 Design inflow systems
To prevent scour of deposited sediments from piped inflows, rock protection and
benching is to be placed at the pipe headwall as shown in Figure 4.11.
Stormwater
pipe
25 mm dia.
weephole
Concrete
outlet apron
Place nom. 100 mm dia
rock to bottom of batter
Wing Wall
Plan Inlet Structure Section Inlet Structure
Stormwater
pipe
25 mm dia.
weephole
Concrete
outlet apron
Place nom. 100 mm dia
rock to bottom of batter
Wing Wall
Plan Inlet Structure Section Inlet Structure
Figure 4.11: Conceptual Inlet Structure with Rock Benching
Step 5 Design outlet structures
Design of Control Outlet - Overflow Pit and Pipe Outlet Configuration
The control outlet structure is to consist of an outlet pit with the crest of the pit set at
the permanent pool level of the sedimentation basin (RL 3.7m). The overflow pit is
sized to convey the design operational flow (1 year ARI).
According to Section 4.3.5.1, two possible flow conditions need to be checked, i.e.
weir flow conditions (with extended detention of 0.3m) and orifice flow conditions.
a. Weir Flow Conditions
From Equation 4.5, the required perimeter of the outlet pit to pass 1.2m
3
/s with
an afflux of 0.3m can be calculated assuming 50% blockage:
m P
P
h C B
Q
P
w
des
6 . 8
3 . 0 7 . 1 5 . 0
2 . 1
2 / 3
2 / 3
=
=
=
An overflow pit typically of 1.5m by 3m will be required.
b. Orifice Flow Conditions
From Equation 4.6, the required area of the outlet pit can be calculated as
follows:
2
7 . 1
3 . 0 81 . 9 2 6 . 0 5 . 0
2 . 1
2
m A
A
h g C B
Q
A
o
o
d
des
o
=
=
=
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-31
A 1.5m by 3m overflow pit would have an opening area of 4.5 m
2
. In this case, the
orifice flow condition with a 1.7 m
2
area would be sufficient to convey the design
discharge.
The top of the pit is to be fitted with a grate.
The size of the outlet pipe or connection pipe to the wetland macrophyte zone can be
calculated by firstly estimating the velocity in the outlet/connection pipe using the
following (Equation 4.7
):
g 2
V 2
h
2
=
Where
h = head level driving flow through the pipe (defined as the spillway outlet level
minus the higher of the normal water level in the downstream treatment
system or the obvert of the pipe)
= RL 4.0m RL 3.4m = 0.6m
g = gravity (9.81 m/s
2
)
The above equation gives a pipe flow velocity of 2.4 m/s, giving a required pipe area of
0.5m
2
to convey a flow of 1.2 m
3
/s. This area is equivalent to an 800mm diameter
pipe. To accommodate this pipe diameter, a pit dimension of 1.5 m x 1.5 m will be
required.
If the sedimentation basin is the inlet zone of a wetland system, the obvert of the pipe
is to be set just below the permanent water level in the wetland macrophyte zone (RL
3.4m) meaning the invert is at RL 2.6m.
In summary, the control outlet structure will be an overflow pit, 1.5m by 1.5m with the
crest level at RL 3.7m and a raised grated cover set at RL 3.8m. The
outlet/connection pipe to the wetland will be 800mm in diameter, the invert set at RL
2.6m.
Design of Spillway Outlet - Weir Outlet
The above design flow controlled discharge will be provided by a spillway outlet weir
designed to convey the above design flow (100 year ARI). The crest of the spillway is
set at 0.3 m above the permanent pool of the sedimentation basin.
The length of the spillway outlet weir determines the afflux for the 100 year ARI peak
discharge and sets the top of embankment of the sedimentation basin. It is common
practice to allow for 0.3 m of freeboard above the afflux level when setting the top of
embankment elevation.
An afflux of 0.3 m has been adopted in defining the length of the spillway weir. This
value was adopted as a tradeoff between the bank height and the width of the weir. A
bank height of 0.9 m (0.3 m afflux and 0.3 m freeboard plus 0.3 m extended detention)
above the normal water level was deemed acceptable. The elevation of the crest of
the spillway is RL 4.0m. The weir length is calculated using the weir flow equation
(Equation 4.5) substituting outlet perimeter P with weir length L and blockage factor
B=1 (no blockage):
m L
L
h C
Q
L
w
yr
11
3 . 0 7 . 1
1 . 3
2 3
2 / 3
100
=
=
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-32
The spillway outlet is located adjacent to the inflow culvert to minimise risk of
sediment scour.
Step 6 Vegetation Specification
The vegetation specification for the littoral zone of a sedimentation basin will be advised
once the list of recommended plantings has been established by National Parks Board of
Singapore.
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-33
4.8.3 Design Calculation Summary
The sheet below summarises the results of the design calculations.
Sedimentation Basin CALCULATION CHECKSHEET
CALCULATION TASK OUTCOME CHECK
Catchment characteristics
- Land Uses
Residential 0 Ha
Commercial 0 Ha
Roads 4 Ha
- Fraction Impervious
Residential 0 -
Commercial 0 -
Roads 1 -
Weighted average 1 -
Conceptual Design
Basin Area 260 m
2
Notional permanent pool depth 2 m
Permanent pool level of sedimentation basin RL 3.8 m
Basin extended detention 0.3 m
Overflow level RL 4.1 m
Identify design criteria
Design operation flow 1 year
Above design flow 100 year
1. Estimate design flow rates
Time of concentration
estimate from flow path length and velocities 8 minutes
Identify rainfall intensities
station used for IFD data: Singapore
Design Rainfall Intensity for design operation flow 110 mm/hr
Design Rainfall Intensity for above design flow 283 mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient
Design operation flow 1
Above design flow 1
(refer to the Singapore Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage(2000))
Peak design flows
Design operation flow 1.2 m
3
/s
Above design flow 3.1 m
3
/s
2. Confirm treatment performance and concept design
Capture efficincy of sedimentation basin 87% %
3. Confirm size and dimensions of sedimentation basin
- Inlet design
Area of sedimentation basin 260 m
2
Aspect Ratio 4 L:W (1)
Hydraulic Efficiency 0.4
Depth of permanent pool 2 m
- Internal batters
Cross Section Batter Slope (below permanent pool depth) 2 V:H (1)
- Sediment Storage Volume
Sediment storage volume, Vs 86 m
3
Volume of accumulated sediment over 5years (Vs,5yr) 52 m
3
Vs>Vs,5year yes - OK -
Sediment clean-out frequency, given Vs 8 years
4. Design inflow systems
Scour protection and/or energy dissipation provided yes
5. Design outlet structures
- Overflow pit
Pit dimension 1.5m x 3m L x B
Overflow crest level RL 3.8 m
Provision of debris trap yes -
- Connection Pipe
Connection pipe dimension 802 mm dia
Connection pipe invert level RL 2.7 m
- Control outlet weir (Spillway)
Weir crest level RL 4.1 m
Weir length 11 m
Afflux 0.3 m
Freeboard to top of embankment 0.3 m
6. Vegetation Specification HOLD
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-34
4.8.4 Construction drawings
Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 Chapter 4 - -- - Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins Sedimentation Basins
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 4-35
4.9 References
Chow, V.T., 1959, Open-Channel Hydraulics, McGraw-Hill Book Co.
Engineers Australia, 2006, Australian Runoff Quality: A guide to Water Sensitive
Urban Design, Editor-in-Chief Wong, T H F, ISBN 0 85825 852 8, Engineers
Australia, Canberra, Australia, 2006
Fair G.M. and Geyer J.C., 1954, Water Supply and Waste Disposal, John Wiley and
Sons, New York, Vol. 2
Graeme Bentley Landscape Architects (GBLA), 2004, Preliminary drawings for
Mernda Wetland, Report for Stockland
Henderson, F.M., 1966, Open Channel Flow, Macmillan Publishing, New York
Institution of Engineers Australia, 2001, Australian Rainfall and Runoff A guide to
flood estimation, Editor in Chief Pilgram, D.H.
Leinster, S 2006, Delivering the Final Product Establishing Water Sensitive Urban
Design Systems, 7th International Conference on Urban Drainage Modelling and 4th
International Conference on Water Sensitive Urban Design Book of Proceedings,
Volume 2, A Deletic and T Fletcher (eds), Melbourne.
NSW Department of Housing, 1998, Managing Urban Stormwater: Soils and
Construction, 3
rd
Edition
Persson, J., Somes, N.L.G. and Wong T.H.F., 1999, Hydraulic efficiency and
constructed wetland and ponds, Water Science and Technology Vol 40 No 3 pp 291
289
Public Utilities Board (PUB), 2000, Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage, Fifth
Edition
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 1
Swales and buffer strips
5
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 2
5
Chapter 5 Swales and Buffer Strips
Contents
5.1 Introduction............................................................................................................. 3
5.2 Design Considerations for Swales ........................................................................... 4
5.2.1 Landscape Design ............................................................................................................................ 4
5.2.2 Hydraulic Design .............................................................................................................................. 4
5.2.3 Vegetation Types.............................................................................................................................. 5
5.2.4 Driveway Crossings .......................................................................................................................... 5
5.2.5 Traffic Controls ................................................................................................................................. 6
5.2.6 Roof Water Discharge ...................................................................................................................... 7
5.2.7 Services ............................................................................................................................................ 7
5.3 Swale Design Process .............................................................................................. 8
5.3.1 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design ........................................................... 9
5.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows .................................................................................................... 13
5.3.3 Step 3: Dimension the Swale with Consideration of Site Constraints ............................................. 13
5.3.4 Step 4: Determine Design of Inflow Systems ................................................................................. 15
5.3.5 Step 5: Verify Design ...................................................................................................................... 17
5.3.6 Step 6: Size Overflow Pits (Field Inlet Pits) .................................................................................... 18
5.3.7 Step 7: Make Allowances to Preclude Traffic on Measures ............................................................ 18
5.3.8 Step 8: Specify Plant Species and Planting Densities .................................................................... 18
5.3.9 Step 9: Consider Maintenance Requirements ................................................................................ 18
5.3.10 Design Calculation Summary ......................................................................................................... 19
5.4 Construction advice ............................................................................................... 20
5.4.1 Building phase damage .................................................................................................................. 20
5.4.2 Traffic and deliveries ...................................................................................................................... 20
5.4.3 Inlet erosion checks ........................................................................................................................ 20
5.4.4 Timing for planting .......................................................................................................................... 20
5.5 Maintenance Requirements ................................................................................... 21
5.6 Checking tools ....................................................................................................... 22
5.6.1 Design assessment checklist ......................................................................................................... 22
5.6.2 Construction Checklist .................................................................................................................... 22
5.6.3 Operation and Maintenance Inspection Form ................................................................................. 22
5.7 Swale Worked Example ......................................................................................... 27
5.7.1 Worked example introduction ......................................................................................................... 27
5.7.2 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design ......................................................... 29
5.7.3 Step 2: Determine Design Flows .................................................................................................... 29
5.7.4 Step 3: Configuring the Swale ........................................................................................................ 30
5.7.5 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems ....................................................................................................... 32
5.7.6 Step 5: Verification Checks ............................................................................................................ 32
5.7.7 Step 6: Size Overflow Pits .............................................................................................................. 33
5.7.8 Step 7: Traffic Control ..................................................................................................................... 33
5.7.9 Step 8: Vegetation specification ..................................................................................................... 33
5.7.10 Calculation summary ...................................................................................................................... 34
5.8 References ............................................................................................................. 35
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 3
5.1 Introduction
Vegetated swales are used to remove coarse and medium sediments and convey stormwater in
lieu of or with underground pipe drainage systems. They are commonly combined with buffer
strips and bioretention systems (refer Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales). Swales utilise overland
flow and mild slopes to convey water slowly downstream. They protect waterways from
damage by erosive flows from frequent storm events because swale flow velocities are slower
than piped systems.
The interaction between stormwater flow and vegetation within swale systems facilitates
pollutant settlement and retention. Even swales with relatively low vegetation height (such as
mown grass) can achieve significant sediment deposition rates provided flows are well
distributed across the full width of the swale and the longitudinal grade of the swale is kept low
enough (typically less than 4 % grade) to maintain slower flow conditions.
Swales alone cannot provide sufficient treatment to meet current stormwater treatment/ water
quality objectives, but can enable water quality objectives to be met by providing an important
pretreatment function for other ABC Waters Design Features in a treatment train. Swales are
particularly good at coarse sediment removal and can provide the necessary pretreatment for
tertiary treatment systems such as wetlands and bioretention basins. Some examples of
swales are provided in Figure 5.1.
Figure 5.1 Elevated and at-grade driveway crossings across swales
Buffer strips (or buffers) are areas of vegetation through which runoff flows (as overland flow) to
a discharge point. Sediment is deposited as flow passes through vegetation over a shallow
depth. Effective treatment relies upon well distributed sheet flow. Vegetation slows flow
velocities, encouraging coarse sediments to settle out of the water column. With the
requirement for uniformly distributed flow, buffer strips are suited to treat road runoff in
situations where road runoff is discharged via flush kerbs or through regular kerb cut-outs. In
these situations, buffer strips (located in the swale batter) can form part of a roadside swale
system that receives the distributed inflows from the adjoining road pavement. The coverage of
buffer strips in this chapter is limited to their application as part of a roadside swale system only.
The reader is referred to Australian Runoff Quality (Engineers Australia 2006) for additional
discussion on buffer strip design and for worked examples.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 4
5.2 Design Considerations for Swales
5.2.1 Landscape Design
Swales may be located within parkland areas, easements, car parks or along roadway corridors
within footpaths or centre medians. Landscape design of swales and buffer strips along the road
edge can assist in defining the boundary of road or street corridors as well as enhancing
landscape character. The landscape design of swales and buffers must address stormwater
quality objectives whilst also incorporating landscape functions. As such, it is important that
swales and buffers are carefully designed to integrate with the surrounding landscape
character.
5.2.2 Hydraulic Design
Typically, swales are applicable for smaller scale contributing catchments up to 1 ha. If larger
than this, flow depths and velocities are such that the water quality improvement function of the
swale, and its long-term function may be compromised. For water quality improvement, swales
need only focus on ensuring frequent storm flows (typically up to the 3 month ARI flow) are
conveyed within the swale profile. In most cases, however, a swale will also be required to
provide a flow conveyance function as part of a minor drainage and/or major drainage system.
In particular, swales located within road reserves must also allow for safe use of adjoining
roadway, footpaths and bike paths by providing sufficient conveyance capacity to satisfy current
engineering infrastructure design requirements as defined by the Code of Practice on Surface
Water Drainage (PUB 2006). In some cases, flows will encroach onto the road surface to
acceptable levels. It may also be necessary to augment the capacity of the swale with
underground pipe drainage to satisfy the road drainage criteria. This can be achieved by
locating overflow pits (field inlet pits) along the invert of the swale that discharge into an
underlying pipe drainage system. Careful attention should be given to the design of overflow
pits to ensure issues of public safety (particularly when raised grates are being used) and
aesthetic amenity are taken into account.
The longitudinal slope of a swale is another important hydraulic design consideration. Swales
generally operate best with longitudinal slopes of between 1 % and 4 %. Slopes milder than
this can become waterlogged and have stagnant ponding. However, the use of subsoil drains
beneath the invert of the swale can alleviate this problem by providing a pathway for drainage of
any small depressions that may form along the swale. For longitudinal slopes steeper than 4 %,
check banks (e.g. small rock walls) along the invert of the swale, or equivalent measures, can
help to distribute flows evenly across the swales, as well as reduce velocities and potential for
scour. Check dams are typically low level rock weirs (e.g. 100 mm) that are constructed across
the base of a swale. It is also important to protect the vegetation immediately downstream of
check dams. Rock pitching can be used to avoid erosion.
A rule of thumb for locating check dams is for the crest of a downstream check dam to be at 4
% grade from 100 mm below the toe of an upstream check dam (refer Figure 5.2). The impact
of check dams on the hydraulic capacity of the swale must be assessed as part of the design
process.
Figure 5.2: Location of Check Dams in Swales
Velocities within swales must be kept low to avoid scouring of collected pollutants and
vegetation, preferably less than 0.5 m/s for minor flood flows (up to 5 year ARI events) and not
more than 2.0 m/s for major flood flow. Similar checks should also be undertaken to assess
4% slope
Check dams (100mm high)
Swale base
100mm
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 5
depth x velocity within the swale, at crossings and adjacent to pedestrian and bicycle pathways
to ensure public safety criteria are satisfied. These are:
depth x velocity < 0.6 m
2
/s for low risk locations and 0.4 m
2
/s for high risk locations (e.g.
where pedestrian traffic is expected to be high)
maximum flow depth on driveway crossings = 0.3 m.
5.2.3 Vegetation Types
Swales can use a variety of vegetation types including turf, sedges and tufted grasses.
Vegetation is required to cover the whole width of the swale, be capable of withstanding design
flows and be of sufficient density to prevent preferred flow paths and scour of deposited
sediments (Figure 5.3).
Figure 5.3 Swale systems: heavily vegetated (left), use of check dams (centre), grass
swale with elevated crossings (right)
Turf swales are commonly used in residential areas. Turf swales should be mown and well
maintained in order for the swale to operate effectively over the long term. Swales that are
densely vegetated with tall vegetation offer improved sediment retention by slowing flows more
and providing enhanced sedimentation for deeper flows. However, densely vegetated swales
have higher hydraulic roughness and therefore require a larger area and/ or more frequent use
of swale field inlet pits to convey flows compared to turf swales. Densely vegetated swales can
become features of the urban landscape and once established, require minimal maintenance
and are hardy enough to withstand large flows (Figure 5.4).
Figure 5.4 Swale incorporated into road reserve
The reader should consult the National parks Board of Singapore more specific guidance on the
selection of appropriate vegetation for swales and buffers.
5.2.4 Driveway Crossings
A key consideration when designing swales along roadways is the requirement for provision of
driveway crossings (or crossovers). Driveway crossings can be at-grade or elevated. At-
grade crossings follow the profile of the swale (e.g. like a ford), while elevated crossings are
raised above the invert of the swale (e.g. like a bridge deck or culvert, see Figure 5.5).
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 6
Crossings constructed at-grade reduce the maximum allowable swale batter slopes to
approximately 1 in 9 to ensure vehicles can traverse the crossing without bottoming out. This
means the swale will have a shallow profile thus reducing its flow conveyance capacity. At-
grade crossings are typically cheaper to construct than elevated crossings, however they need
to be constructed at the same time as the swale to avoid damaging the swale. This imposes a
fixed driveway location on each allotment, which can potentially constrain future house layouts.
At-grade crossings are best suited to developments where the spacing between crossings is
typically more than 15 m.
Figure 5.5 At-grade (left) under construction with trees yet to be established, pre-
constructed at-grade (centre) and elevated driveway crossings to allow
vehicle access across swales (right)
Elevated crossings are not appropriate in all street applications; however, where appropriate,
they can be designed as streetscape features. They also provide an opportunity for locating
check dams (to distribute flows) or to provide temporary ponding above a bioretention system
(refer Chapter 6 Bioretention Swales). A major limitation with elevated crossings can be their
high life cycle costs compared to at-grade crossings (particularly in dense urban
developments) due to the need for on-going maintenance. Safety concerns with traffic
movement adjacent to elevated crossings and the potential for blockages of small culvert
systems beneath the crossing are other possible limitations. These limitations can be overcome
by careful design through the use of spanning crossings rather than using small culverts and
through the use of durable decking materials in place of treated timber.
5.2.5 Traffic Controls
Another design consideration is keeping traffic and building materials off swales (particularly
during the building phase of a development). If swales are used for parking then the topsoil will
be compacted and the swale vegetation may be damaged beyond its ability to regenerate
naturally. In addition, vehicles driving on swales can cause ruts along the swale that can create
preferential flow paths that will diminish the swales water quality treatment performance as well
as creating depressions that can retain water and potentially become mosquito breeding sites.
To prevent vehicles driving on swales and inadvertent placement of building materials, it is
necessary to consider appropriate traffic control solutions as part of the swale design. These
can include planting the swale with dense vegetation that will discourage the movement of
vehicles onto the swale or, if dense vegetation cannot be used, providing physical barriers such
as kerb and channel (with breaks to allow distributed water entry to the swale) or bollards and/
or street tree planting.
Kerb and channel should be used at all corners, intersections, cul-de-sac heads and at traffic
calming devices to ensure correct driving path is taken. For all of these applications, the kerb
and channel is to extend 5 m beyond tangent points. The transition from barrier or lay back type
kerb to flush kerbs and vice versa is to be done in a way that avoids creation of low points that
cause ponding onto the road pavement.
Where road edge guide posts or bollards are used, consideration should be given to
intermixing mature tree plantings with the bollards to break the visual monotony created by a
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 7
continuous row of bollards (Figure 5.6). Bollards should comply with relevant government
specifications.
Figure 5.6 Traffic bollards mixed with street trees to protect swale from vehicles
5.2.6 Roof Water Discharge
Roof water should be discharged onto the surface of the swale for subsequent conveyance and
treatment by the swale (and downstream treatment measures) before being discharged to
receiving aquatic environments. Depending on the depth of the roof water drainage system and
the finished levels of the swale, this may require the use of a small surcharge pit located within
the invert of the swale to allow the roof water to surcharge to the swale. Any residual water in
the surcharge pit can be discharged to the underlying subsoil drainage by providing perforations
in the base and sides of the surcharge pit. If a surcharge pit is used, an inspection chamber
along the roof water drainage line is to be provided within the property boundary. Surcharge pits
are discussed further in Section 5.3.4.3.
Roof water should only be directly connected to an underground pipe drainage system if an
appropriate level of stormwater treatment is provided along (or at the outfall of) the pipe
drainage system.
5.2.7 Services
Swales located within standard road reserves are to have services located within the services
corridors in accordance with government requirements. Sewers located beneath swales are to
be fully welded polyethylene pipes with rodding points. Care should be taken to ensure the
service conduits do not compromise the performance of the swale. Consideration will also need
to be given to access to services for ongoing maintenance without the need to regularly disrupt
or replace the swale.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 8
5.3 Swale Design Process
The design process for swales involves in the first instance designing the swale to
meet flow conveyance requirements and then ensuring the swale has the necessary
design features to optimise its stormwater quality treatment performance.
The key design steps are:
Each of these design steps is discussed in the following sections. A worked example
illustrating application of the design process on a case study site is presented in
Section 5.7.
1. Confirm treatment performance of concept design
2. Determine design flows
3. Dimension the swale with consideration of site
constraints
a. Swale width and side slopes
b. Maximum swale length (i.e. length between overflow pits)
4. Determine design of inflow systems
5. Verify design
a. Scour velocity checks
b. Safety checks - depth x velocity; maximum depth over crossings
c. Confirm treatment performance
6. Size overflow pits (field inlet pits)
7. Make allowances to preclude traffic on measures
9. Consider maintenance requirements, including
development of a written maintenance plan
8. Specify plant species and planting densities
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 9
5.3.1 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Before commencing detailed design, the designer should first undertake a preliminary
check to confirm the swale outlined on the concept design is adequate to deliver the
level of stormwater quality improvement inferred within the concept design
documentation. The swale treatment performance curves shown in Figure 5.7 to
Figure 5.9 can be used to undertake this verification check.
The curves in Figure 5.7 to Figure 5.9 were derived using the Model for Urban
Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC), assuming the swale is a stand
alone system (i.e. not part of a treatment train). The curves show the total suspended
solid (TSS), total phosphorus (TP) and total nitrogen (TN) removal performance for a
typical swale design, being:
Top width 4.5 m
Base width 1 m
Side slopes 1 in 9
The curves in Figure 5.7 to Figure 5.9 are generally applicable to swale applications
within residential, industrial and commercial land uses.
If the configuration of the swale concept design is significantly different to that
described above, then a stormwater quality model such as MUSIC should be used in
preference to the curves in Figure 5.7 to Figure 5.9. The detailed designer should also
use the stormwater quality model to verify swale concept designs that are part of a
treatment train.
Swales should form part of the stormwater treatment train as they will not achieve
load-based pollutant reduction objectives on their own. Therefore, other stormwater
quality best management practices should be incorporated into the surrounding
catchment to augment the stormwater treatment performance of any proposed swale
system.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 10
S wale TS S Reduc tion (Varying S lope)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atc hment)
%
T
S
S
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
1% Slope
3% Slope
5% Slope
Veg et at ion Heig h t = 0.25m
S wale TS S Reduc tion (Varying Veg)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atc hment)
%
T
S
S
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
0.05m Veg
0.15m Veg
0.25m Veg
0.5m Veg
Lon g it udin al Slo pe = 3%
Figure 5.7 Swale TSS Removal Performance
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 11
S wale TP Reduc tion (Varying S lope)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atchment)
%
T
P
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
1% Slo pe
3% Slo pe
5% Slo pe
Veg et at ion Heig ht = 0.25m
S wale TP Reduc tion (Varying Veg)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atchment)
%
T
P
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
0.05m Veg
0.15m Veg
0.25m Veg
0.5m Veg
Long it ud inal Slo pe = 3%
Figure 5.8 Swale TP Removal Performance
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 12
S wale TN Reduc tion (Varying S lope)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atchment)
%
T
N
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
1% Slo pe
3% Slo pe
5% Slo pe
Veg et atio n Heig h t = 0.25m
S wale TN Reduc tion (Varying Veg)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
S wale S ize (% of Impervious C atc hment)
%
T
N
R
e
d
u
c
t
i
o
n
0.05m Veg
0.15m Veg
0.25m Veg
0.5m Veg
Lo ng it ud inal Slope = 3%
Figure 5.9 Swale TN Removal Performance
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 13
5.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows
Two design flows are required to be estimated for the design of a swale, particularly
where they are designed within a road reserve. These are to size the swale for
conveyance of flows rather than treatment:
minor flood flow (2-10 year ARI; typically the 5 year ARI peak discharge) to allow
minor floods to be safely conveyed
major flood flow (50-100 year ARI) to check flow velocities, velocity depth criteria,
conveyance within road reserve, and freeboard to adjoining property.
The Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (PUB 2006) identifies the Rational
Method as the procedure most commonly used to estimate peak flows from small
catchments in Singapore.
5.3.3 Step 3: Dimension the Swale with Consideration of Site Constraints
Factors to consider are:
Maximum contributing catchment area (<1ha)
Allowable width given the proposed road reserve and/ or urban layout
How flows will be delivered into a swale (e.g. cover requirements for pipes or
kerb details)
Vegetation height
Longitudinal slope
Maximum side slopes and base width
Provision of crossings
Other requirements in accordance to the Code of Practice on Surface Water
Drainage (PUB 2006).
Depending on which of the above characteristics are fixed, other variables may be
adjusted to derive the optimal swale dimensions for the given site conditions. The
following sections outline some considerations in relation to configuring a swale.
5.3.3.1 Swale Width and Side Slopes
The maximum swale width needs to be identified early in the design process as it
dictates the remaining steps in the swale design process. The maximum width of
swale is usually determined from an urban layout and at the concept design stage.
Where the swale width is not constrained by an urban layout (e.g. when located within
a large open space area), then the width of the swale may be selected based on
consideration of landscape objectives, maximum side slopes for ease of maintenance
and public safety, hydraulic capacity required to convey the desired design flow, and
treatment performance requirements.
Selection of an appropriate side slope for swales located in parks, easements or
median strips is heavily dependent on site constraints, and swale side slopes are
typically between 1 in 10 and 1 in 4.
For swales located adjacent to roads, side slopes will typically be dictated by the
driveway crossing. Where there are no driveway crossings then the maximum swale
side slopes will be established from ease of maintenance and public safety
considerations. Where elevated crossings are used, swale side slopes would
typically be between 1 in 6 and 1 in 4. Elevated crossings will require provision for
drainage under the crossings with a culvert or similar. Where at grade crossings are
used, swale side slopes are typically 1 in 9. The selection of crossing type should be
made in consultation with urban and landscape designers.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 14
5.3.3.2 Maximum Length of a Swale
Provided the water quality function of the swale is met, the maximum length of a swale
is the distance along a swale before an overflow pit (field inlet pit) is required to drain
the swale to an underlying pipe drainage system.
The maximum length of a swale located within parkland areas and easements is
calculated as the distance along the swale to the point where the flow in the swale
from the contributing catchment (for the specific design flood frequency) exceeds the
bank full discharge capacity of the swale. For example, if the swale is to convey the
minor flood flow without overflowing, then the maximum swale length would be
determined as the distance along the swale to the point where the minor flood flow
from the contributing catchment is equivalent to the bank full flow capacity of the swale
(bank full flow capacity is determined using Mannings equation as discussed below).
The maximum length of a swale located along a roadway is calculated as the distance
along the swale to the point where flow on the adjoining road pavement (or road
reserve) no longer complies with PUB road design standards (for both the minor and
major flood flows) as defined by the Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage
(PUB 2006).
5.3.3.3 Swale Capacity Mannings Equation and Selection of Mannings n
Mannings equation is used to calculate the flow capacity of a swale. This allows the
flow rate and flood levels to be determined for variations in swale dimensions,
vegetation type and longitudinal grade. Mannings equation is given by:
n
S R A
Q
1/2 2/3
= Equation 5.1
Where: Q = flow in swale (m
3
/s)
A = cross section area (m
2
)
R = hydraulic radius (m)
S = channel slope (m/m)
n = roughness factor (Mannings n)
Mannings n relates to the roughness of the channel and is a critical variable in
Mannings equation. It varies with flow depth, channel dimensions and the vegetation
type. For constructed swale systems, recommended values are between 0.15 and 0.3
for flow depths shallower than the vegetation height (preferable for treatment) and
significantly lower for flows with depth greater than the vegetation (e.g. 0.03 0.05 at
more than twice the vegetation depth i.e. 50-100 year ARI). It is considered
reasonable for Mannings n to have a maximum at the vegetation height and then to
sharply reduce as depths increase.
Figure 5.10 shows a plot of Mannings n versus flow depth for a grass swale with
longitudinal grade of 5 %. It is reasonable to expect the shape of the Mannings n
relation with flow depth to be consistent with other swale configurations, with the
vegetation height at the boundary between low flows and intermediate flows (Figure
5.10) on the top axis of the diagram. The bottom axis of the plot has been modified
from Barling and Moore (1993) to express flow depth as a percentage of vegetation
height.
Further discussion on selecting an appropriate Mannings n for a swale is provided in
Appendix E of the MUSIC User Guide (CRCCH 2005).
n
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 15
Figure 5.10 Impact of Flow Depth on Hydraulic Roughness (adapted from
Barling & Moore (1993))
5.3.4 Step 4: Determine Design of Inflow Systems
Inflows to swales can be via distributed runoff (e.g. from flush kerbs along a road) or
point outlets such as pipe culverts. Combinations of these two inflow pathways can
also be used.
5.3.4.1 Distributed Inflow
An advantage of flows entering a swale system in a distributed manner (i.e. entering
perpendicular to the direction of the swale) is that flow depths are kept as shallow
sheet flow, which maximises contact with the swale vegetation on the batter receiving
the distributed inflows. This swale batter is often referred to as a buffer. To ensure
the function of the buffer, flow depths must be shallow (below the vegetation height)
and erosion must be avoided. The buffer provides good pre-treatment through coarse
sediment removal prior to flows being conveyed along the swale.
Distributed inflows can be achieved either by having a flush kerb or by using kerbs
with regular breaks in them to allow for even flows across the buffer surface (Figure
5.11).
Figure 5.11 Kerb arrangements to promote distributed flow into swales
80 10 20 40 60 90 105 200 80 10 20 40 60 90 105 200
Depth as % of vegetation height
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 16
5.3.4.2 Buffer Requirements
There are several design guides that may to be applied to ensure buffers operate to
improve water quality and provide a pretreatment role. Key design parameters of
buffer systems are:
Providing distributed rather than concentrated flows onto a buffer to avoiding
erosion and channelled flows
Maintaining flow depths less than vegetation heights. This may require flow
spreaders, or check dams.
Minimising the slope of the buffer. It is best if slopes can be kept below 5 %,
however buffers can still perform well with slopes up to 20 % provided flows are
well distributed. The steeper the buffer the more likely flow spreaders will be
required to avoid rill erosion.
Maintenance of buffers is required to remove accumulated sediment and debris.
Therefore access is an important consideration. Sediments will accumulate mostly
immediately downstream of the pavement surface and then progressively further
downstream as sediment builds up.
It is important to ensure coarse sediments accumulate off the road surface at the start
of the buffer. Figure 5.12 (left) shows sediment accumulating on a street surface
where the vegetation is the same level or slightly higher than the road. To avoid this
accumulation, a flush kerb with an arris should be used so that the top of the
vegetation is set 60 mm below the edge of pavement. This requires the finished
topsoil surface of the swale (i.e. before turf is placed) to be approximately 100 mm
below the edge of pavement level. Sediments can then accumulate off any trafficable
surface.
Figure 5.12 Flush kerb without set-down, showing sediment accumulation on
road (left) and flush kerb with 60 mm set-down to allow sediment to
flow into the vegetated area (right).
5.3.4.3 Concentrated Inflow
Concentrated inflows to a swale can be in the form of a concentrated overland flow or
a discharge from a pipe drainage system. For all concentrated inflows, energy
dissipation at the swale inflow location is an important consideration to minimise any
erosion. This can usually be achieved with rock benching and/ or dense vegetation.
The most common constraint on pipe systems discharging to swales is bringing the pipe flows to
pipe flows to the surface of a swale. In situations where the swale geometry does not permit the
permit the pipe to achieve free discharge to the surface of the swale, a surcharge pit may need
may need to be used. Surcharge pits should be designed so that they are as shallow as possible
as possible and have pervious bases to avoid long term ponding in the pits (this may require
require under-drains to ensure it drains, depending on local soil conditions). The pits need to be
Road edge
Road surface
60 mm set down
Buffer strip
Sediment accumulation area
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 17
PLAN
Drainage holes to be drilled
in base of pit
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
PLAN
Drainage holes to be drilled
in base of pit
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
need to be accessible so that any build up of coarse sediment and debris can be monitored and
monitored and removed if necessary.
Figure 5.13 shows an example of a typical surcharge pit discharging into a swale.
Surcharge pits are not considered good practice, due to additional maintenance issues
and mosquito breeding potential and should therefore be avoided where possible.
Figure 5.13 Example of Surcharge Pit for Discharging Concentrated Runoff into
a Swale
Surcharge pits are most frequently used when allotment runoff is required to cross a
road into a swale on the opposite side of the road or for allotment and roof runoff
discharging into shallow profile swales. Where allotment runoff needs to cross under a
road to discharge into a swale it is preferable to combine the runoff from more than
one allotment to reduce the number of crossings required under the road pavement.
5.3.5 Step 5: Verify Design
5.3.5.1 Vegetation Scour Velocity Check
Potential scour velocities are checked by applying Mannings equation to the swale
design to ensure the following criteria are met:
less than 0.5 m/s for minor flood (2 to 10 year ARI; typically the 5 year ARI)
discharge
less than 2.0 m/s and typically less than 1.0 m/s for major flood (50 to 100
year ARI) discharge.
5.3.5.2 Velocity and Depth Check Safety
As swales are generally accessible by the public, it is important to check that depth x
velocity within the swale, at crossings and adjacent to pedestrian and bicycle
pathways, satisfies the following public safety criteria:
depth x velocity of < 0.4 m
2
/s is not exceeded for all flows up to the major
design event, as defined in relevant local government guidelines
maximum depth of flow over at-grade crossings = 0.3 m
5.3.5.3 Confirm Treatment Performance
If the previous two checks are satisfactory then the swale design is adequate from a
conveyance function perspective and it is now necessary to reconfirm the treatment
performance of the swale by reference back to the information presented in Section
5.3.1.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 18
5.3.6 Step 6: Size Overflow Pits (Field Inlet Pits)
To size a swale field inlet pit, two checks should be made to test for either drowned or
free flowing conditions. A broad crested weir equation can be used to determine the
length of weir required (assuming free flowing conditions) and an orifice equation used
to estimate the area between openings required in the grate cover (assuming drowned
outlet conditions). The smaller of the two pit configurations would normally suffice
although other consideration such as the required pit to fit the stormwater pipe
conveying overflows to the receiving waters need also to be considered. In addition a
blockage factor is to be used, that assumes the field inlet is 50 % blocked.
For free overfall conditions (weir equation):
3/2
h L C B Q
w weir
= Equation 5.2
Where Q
weir
= flow over weir (pit) (m
3
/s)
B = blockage factor (0.5)
C
w
= weir coefficient (1.66)
L = length of weir (m)
h = depth of water above weir crest (m)
Once the length of weir is calculated, a standard sized pit can be selected with a
perimeter at least the same length of the required weir length.
For drowned outlet conditions (orifice equation):
h g 2 A C B Q
d orifice
= Equation 5.3
Where Q
orifice
= flow into drowned pit (m
3
/s)
B = blockage factor (0.5)
C
d
= discharge coefficient (0.6)
A = total area of orifice (openings) (m
2
)
g = 9.80665 m/s
2
h = depth of water above centre of orifice (m)
When designing grated field inlet pits reference should be made to the procedure
described in the Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (Public Utilities Board
2006)
5.3.7 Step 7: Make Allowances to Preclude Traffic on Measures
Refer to Section 5.2.5 for discussion on traffic control options.
5.3.8 Step 8: Specify Plant Species and Planting Densities
The reader should consult the National Parks Board for guidance of appropriate plant
species and planting densities applicable for stormwater swales in Singapore.
5.3.9 Step 9: Consider Maintenance Requirements
Consider how maintenance is to be performed on the swale (e.g. how and where is
access available, where is litter likely to collect etc.). A specific maintenance plan and
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 19
schedule should be developed for the swale, either as part of a maintenance plan for
the whole treatment train, or for each individual asset. Guidance on maintenance
plans is provided in Section 5.5.
5.3.10 Design Calculation Summary
The following design calculation table can be used to summarise the design data and
calculation results from the design process.
SWALES DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY SHEET
Calculation Task
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Outcome Check
Catchment Characteristics
Catchment Area ha
Catchment Land Use (i.e. residential, Commercial etc.)
Catchment Slope %
Conceptual Design
Swale Top Width m
Swale Length m
Swale Location (road reserve/ park/other)
Road Reserve Width m
1 Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Swale Area m
2
TSS Removal %
TP Removal %
TN Removal %
2 Determine Design Flows
Time of concentration minutes
Identify Rainfall intensities
Minor Storm (I2 I10 year ARI) mm/hr
Major Storm (I50-100 year ARI) mm/hr
Design Runoff Coefficient
Minor Storm (C2 C10 year ARI)
Major Storm (C50-100 year ARI)
Peak Design Flows
Minor Storm (2 - 10 year ARI) m
3
/s
Major Storm (50-100 year ARI) m
3
/s
3 Dimension the Swale
Swale Width and Side Slopes
Base Width m
Side Slopes 1 in
Longitudinal Slope %
Vegetation Height mm
Maximum Length of Swale
Mannings n
Swale Capacity
Maximum Length of Swale
4 Design Inflow Systems
Swale Kerb Type
60 mm set down to Buffer/ Swale Vegetation Yes/ No
Adequate Erosion and Scour Protection (where required)
5 Verification Checks
Velocity for 2-10 year ARI flow (< 0.25 - 0.5 m/s) m/s
Velocity for 50-100 year ARI flow (< 2 m/s) m/s
Velocity x Depth for 50-100 year ARI (< 0.4 m
2
/s) m
2
/s
Depth of Flow over Driveway Crossing for 50-100 year ARI (< 0.3 m) m
Treatment Performance consistent with Step 1
6 Size Overflow Pits (Field Inlet Pits)
System to convey minor floods (2-10 year ARI) L x W
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 20
5.3.10.1 Typical Design Parameters
Table 5.1 provides typical values for a number of key swale design parameters.
Table 5.1: Typical Design Parameters
Design Parameter Typical Values
Swale longitudinal slope 1 % to 4 %
Swale side slope (for areas not requiring access, e.g. parks,
easements, median strips)
1 in 4 to 1 in 10
Swale side slope for trafficability (for footpaths with at-grade
crossings)
Maximum 1 in 9
Swale side slope (elevated driveway crossings) 1 in 4 to 1 in 10
Mannings n (with flow depth less than vegetation height) (Refer
Figure 5.10)
0.15 to 0.3
Mannings n (with flow depth greater than vegetation height) 0.03 to 0.05
Maximum velocity to prevent scour in minor event (e.g. Q
2
) 0.25 - 0.5 m/s
Maximum velocity for Q
50-100
1.0 - 2.0 m/s
5.4 Construction advice
This section provides general advice for the construction of swales. It is based on
observations from construction projects around Australia.
5.4.1 Building phase damage
Protection of soil and vegetation is important during building phase, uncontrolled
building site runoff is likely to cause excessive sedimentation, introduce weeds and
litter and require replanting following the building phase. Can use a staged
implementation - i.e. during building use geofabric, soil (e.g. 50mm) and instant turf
(laid perpendicular to flow path) to provide erosion control and sediment trapping.
Following building, remove and revegetate possibly reusing turf at subsequent stages.
5.4.2 Traffic and deliveries
Ensure traffic and deliveries do not access swales during construction. Traffic can
compact the soil and cause preferential flow paths, deliveries can smother vegetation.
Wash down wastes (e.g. silt, concrete) can disturb vegetation and cause uneven
slopes along a swale. Swales should be protected during construction phase and
controls implemented to avoid wash down wastes.
5.4.3 Inlet erosion checks
It is good practice to check the operation of inlet erosion protection measures following
the first few rainfall events. It is important to check for these early in the systems life,
to avoid continuing problems. Should problems occur in these events the erosion
protection should be enhanced.
5.4.4 Timing for planting
Timing of vegetation is dependent on a suitable time of year (and potential irrigation
requirements) as well as timing in relation to the phases of development. For example
temporary planting during construction for sediment control (e.g. with turf) then remove
and plant out with long term vegetation.
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 21
5.5 Maintenance Requirements
Swale treatment relies upon good vegetation establishment and therefore ensuring
adequate vegetation growth is the key maintenance objective. In addition, they have a
flood conveyance role that needs to be maintained to ensure adequate flood
protection for local properties.
The most intensive period of maintenance is during the plant establishment period
(first two years) when weed removal and replanting may be required. It is also the time
when large loads of sediments may impact on plant growth, particularly in developing
catchments with an inadequate level of erosion and sediment control.
Typical maintenance of swale elements will involve:
Routine inspection of the swale profile to identify any areas of obvious
increased sediment deposition, scouring of the swale invert from storm flows,
rill erosion of the swale batters from lateral inflows or damage to the swale
profile from vehicles.
Routine inspection of inlet points (if the swale does not have distributed
inflows), surcharge pits and field inlet pits to identify any areas of scour, litter
build up and blockages.
Removal of sediment where it is impeding the conveyance of the swale and/
or smothering the swale vegetation and if necessary re-profiling of the swale
and re-vegetating to original design specification.
Repairing damage to the swale profile resulting from erosion or vehicle
damage.
Clearing of blockages to inlet or outlets.
Regular watering/ irrigation of vegetation until plants are established and
actively growing.
Mowing of turf or slashing of vegetation (if required) to preserve the optimal
design height for the vegetation.
Removal and management of invasive weeds.
Removal of plants that have died and replacement with plants of equivalent
size and species as detailed in the plant schedule.
Pruning to remove dead or diseased vegetation material and to stimulate new
growth.
Litter and debris removal.
Vegetation pest monitoring and control.
Inspections are also recommended following large storm events to check for scour. All
maintenance activities must be specified in a maintenance plan (and associated
maintenance inspection forms) to be developed as part of the design procedure.
Maintenance personnel and asset managers will use this plan to ensure the swales
continue to function as designed. Maintenance plans and forms must address the
following:
inspection frequency
maintenance frequency
data collection/ data storage requirements
detailed cleanout procedures (main element of the plans) including:
o equipment needs
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 22
o maintenance techniques
o occupational health and safety
o public safety
o environmental management considerations
o disposal requirements (of material removed)
o access issues
o stakeholder notification requirements
o data collection requirements (if any)
design details
An example operation and maintenance inspection form is provided in the checking
tools provided in Section 5.6.3.
5.6 Checking tools
This section provides a number of checking aids for designers and approval
authorities. In addition, advice on construction techniques and lessons learnt from
building swale systems are provided.
Checklists are provided for:
Design assessments
Construction (during and post)
Operation and maintenance inspections
Asset transfer (following defects period).
5.6.1 Design assessment checklist
The Design Assessment Checklist on the following page presents the key design
features that are to be reviewed when assessing a design of a swale. These
considerations include configuration, safety, maintenance and operational issues that
need to be addressed during the design phase. If an item receives an N when
reviewing the design, referral is made back to the design procedure to determine the
impact of the omission or error. In addition to the checklist, a proposed design is to
have all necessary permits for installation.
5.6.2 Construction Checklist
The Construction Checklist on the following page presents the key items to be
reviewed when inspecting the swale during and at the completion of construction. The
checklist is to be used by Construction Site Supervisors and compliance inspectors to
ensure all the elements of the swale have been constructed in accordance with the
design. If an item receives an N in satisfactory criteria then appropriate actions must
be specified and delivered to rectify the construction issue before final inspection sign-
off is given.
5.6.3 Operation and Maintenance Inspection Form
The Operation and Maintenance forms on the following pages should be used
whenever an inspection is conducted and kept as a record on the asset condition and
quantity of removed pollutants over time. Inspections should occur every 1 to 6
months depending on the size and complexity of the swale system, and the stage of
development (i.e. inspections should be more frequent during building phase and until
the swale landform has stabilised).
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 23
SWALE DESIGN ASSESSMENT CHECKLIST
Asset I.D. DA No.:
Swale Location:
Hydraulics: Minor Flood (m
3
/s): Major Flood (m
3
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Swale Area (m
2
):
TREATMENT Y N
Treatment performance verified?
INFLOW SYSTEMS Y N
Inlet flows appropriately distributed?
Swale/ buffer vegetation set down of at least 60 mm below kerb invert incorporated?
Energy dissipation (rock protection) provided at inlet points to the swale?
SWALE CONFIGURATION/ CONVEYANCE Y N
Longitudinal slope of invert >1% and <4%?
Mannings n selected appropriate for proposed vegetation type?
Overall flow conveyance system sufficient for design flood event?
Maximum flood conveyance width is compliant with Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (PUB 2006)
Overflow pits provided where flow capacity exceeded?
Velocities within swale cells will not cause scour?
Maximum ponding depth and velocity will not impact on public safety (V x d < 0.4 m/s)
Maintenance access provided to invert of conveyance channel?
LANDSCAPE Y N
Plant species selected can tolerate periodic inundation and design velocities?
Planting design conforms to acceptable sight line and safety requirements?
Street trees conform to Land Development Guidelines
Top soils are a minimum depth of 300mm for plants and 100 mm for turf
Existing trees in good condition are investigated for retention?
Swale and buffer strip landscape design integrates with surrounding natural and/ or built environment?
OTHER NOTES
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 24
SWALE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION CHECKLIST
Asset I.D.: Inspected by:
Site:
Date:
Time:
Constructed By:
Weather:
Contact during visit:
Items Inspected
Checked Satisfactory Items Inspected Checked Satisfactory
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION & ESTABLISHMENT
A. FUNCTIONAL INSTALLATION Structural Components
Preliminary Works
13. Location and levels of pits as
designed
1. Erosion/ sediment control plan adopted 14. Safety protection provided
2. Traffic control measures 15. Location of check dams as designed
3. Location same as plans
16. Swale crossings located/ built as
designed
4. Site protection from existing flows 17. Pipe joints/ connections as designed
5. Critical root zones (0.5 m beyond drip line) of
nominated trees are protected
18. Concrete and reinforcement as
designed
19. Inlets appropriately installed
Earthworks 20. Inlet erosion protection installed
6. Existing topsoil is stockpiled for reuse
21. Set down to correct level for flush
kerbs
7. Bed of swale level? B. EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL
8. Batter slopes as plans 22. Silt fences and traffic control in place
9. Longitudinal slope in design range
23. Stabilisation immediately following
earthworks
10. Provision of sub-soil drainage for mild slopes (<1%) C. OPERATIONAL ESTABLISHMENT
11. Compaction process as designed Vegetation
12. Appropriate topsoil on swale 24. Test and ameliorate topsoil, if required
25. Planting as designed (species/
densities)
26. Weed removal and watering as
required
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 6. Check for uneven settling of soil
2. Traffic control in place 7. Inlet erosion protection working
3. Confirm structural element sizes 8. Maintenance access provided
4. Check batter slopes 9. Construction sediment removed
5. Vegetation as designed 10. Evidence of local surface ponding
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED:
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 25
SWALE (AND BUFFER) MAINTENANCE CHECKLIST
Asset I.D.:
Inspection Frequency: 1 to 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS Y N ACTION REQUIRED (DETAILS)
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter within swale?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures (e.g. crossovers)?
Traffic damage present?
Evidence of dumping (e.g. building waste)?
Vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Replanting required?
Mowing required?
Sediment accumulation at outlets?
Clogging of drainage points (sediment or debris)?
Evidence of ponding?
Set down from kerb still present?
Soil additives or amendments required?
Pruning and/ or removal of dead or diseased vegetation required?
COMMENTS
Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 Chapter 5 S SS Swales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips wales and Buffer Strips
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 26
ASSET TRANSFER CHECKLIST
Asset Description:
Asset I.D.:
Asset Location:
Construction by:
'On-maintenance' Period:
TREATMENT Y N
System appears visually to be working as designed?
No obvious signs of under-performance?
MAINTENANCE Y N
Maintenance plans and indicative maintenance costs provided for each asset?
Vegetation establishment period completed (2 years)?
Inspection and maintenance undertaken as per maintenance plan?
Inspection and maintenance forms provided?
Asset inspected for defects?
ASSET INFORMATION Y N
Design Assessment Checklist provided?
As constructed plans provided?
Copies of all required permits (both construction and operational) submitted?
Proprietary information provided (if applicable)?
Digital files (e.g. drawings, survey, models) provided?
Asset listed on asset register or database?
COMMENTS
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 27
5.7 Swale Worked Example
5.7.1 Worked example introduction
As part of a development, runoff from allotments and a street surface is to be collected
and conveyed in a vegetated swale system to downstream treatments. The swale will
be vegetated with turf (100mm tall). An additional exercise in this worked example is
to investigate the consequences on flow capacity of using a taller species such as
sedges in the swale (vegetation height equal to 300mm).
A concept design for the development proposed this system as part of a treatment
train. The street will have a one-way cross fall (to the high side) with flush kerbs, to
allow for distributed flows into the swale system across a buffer zone.
The swale is to convey minor flood events, including all flows up to a five-year ARI
storm. However, the width of the swale is fixed at 5.0 m and there will be a maximum
catchment area the swale can accommodate, above which an underground pipe will
be required to preserve the conveyance properties of the downstream swale. Access
to the allotments will be via an at-grade crossover with a maximum slope of 1 in 10 (10
%).
Figure 5.14 Cross section of proposed buffer/swale system
The contributing catchment area includes 35 m width and 100m length residential
allotments on one side, a 7m wide road pavement surface and a 1.5 m footpath and
5.0 m swale and services easement (depicted in Figure 5.14, examples of similar
systems are illustrated in Figure 5.15). The area is 100 m long with a 3 % slope.
Allotment runoff is to be discharged under a footpath via a conventional stormwater
pipe directly into the swale system with appropriate erosion control.
100m
35m
15m
7m
Allotment
Footpat
h
Road
Buffer
(Max 1 in 10 side
slopes with 1.2m base)
(3% slope)
Swale
5m
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 28
Figure 5.15 Similar buffer swale system for conveying runoff
Design criteria for the buffer/ swale system are to:
Promote sedimentation of coarse particles through the buffer by providing for
an even flow distribution and areas for sediment accumulation (i.e. set down at
kerb edge);
Provide traffic management measures that will preclude traffic damage (or
parking) within the buffer or swale (e.g. bollards or parking bays);
Provide check dams to control velocities and spread flows (potentially using
crossings);
Provide driveway access to lots within side slope limits and
Convey 5-year ARI flows within the swale and underground pipe system.
This worked example focuses on the design of the buffer strip and vegetated swale
conveyance properties. Analyses to be undertaken during the detailed design phase
include the following:
Design the swale system to accommodate driveway crossovers and check
dams where required
Select vegetation such that the hydraulic capacity of the swale is sufficient
Determine maximum length of swale to convey 5-year flows before an
underground pipe is required
Check velocities are maintained to acceptable levels
Overflow structure from swale to underground pipe (if required).
Additional design elements will be required, including:
Configure the street kerb details such that sheet flow is achieved through the
buffer strip
Configure house lot drainage so that erosion control is provided
Buffer strip vegetation
Swale vegetation (integral with hydraulic design of the system).
5.7.1.1 Design Objectives
The design objectives are summarised as follows:
Swale shall convey at least all flows up to the peak 5-year ARI storm event.
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 29
Sedimentation of coarse particles will be promoted within the buffer by
providing an even flow distribution.
Prevent traffic damage to the buffer swale system.
Flow velocities to be controlled to prevent erosion.
Allowance for suitable driveway gradients (max 1:9) to be provided at
crossovers into properties.
5.7.1.2 Site Characteristics
Catchment area: 3,500 m
2
(lots)
850 m
2
(roads and concrete footpath)
500 m
2
(swale and services easement)
Total = 4,850 m
2
Land use/surface type Residential lots, roads/concrete footpaths, swale and service
easement.
Overland flow slope:
Total main flow path length = 100m @ 3% slope
Soil type: Clay
Fraction impervious:
lots f = 0.65
roads/footpath f = 1.00
swale/service easement f = 0.10
Vegetation height of 100 mm
5.7.2 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Interpretation of Figure 5.7 to Figure 5.9 with the input parameters below is used to
estimate the reduction performance of the swale system to ensure the design will
achieve target pollutant reductions. To interpret the graphs the area of swale base to
the impervious catchment needs to be estimated. For a base width of 1.2 m, the area
of swale base as percentage of the contributing impervious catchment area:
1.2 x 100/ [(0.65 x 3500) + (1.0 x 850) + (0.1 x 500)] = 3.8 %
From the figures using an equivalent area in the reference site, it is estimated that,
depending on the height of the vegetation, pollutant reductions are between 70% and
82% for TSS, 47% to 59% for TP and 13% to 22% for TN respectively.
5.7.3 Step 2: Determine Design Flows
With a small catchment, the Rational Method is considered an appropriate approach to
estimate the 5 and 100-year ARI peak flow rates. The steps in these calculations
follow below.
5.7.3.1 Major and minor design flows
Time of concentration (t
c
)
The time of concentration is estimated assuming overland flow across the allotments
and along the swale and is determined to be 10 minutes.
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 30
Design rainfall intensities
Adopt from IDF table
1
for Singapore for a time of concentration (t
c
) of 10 minutes
ARI Intensity
5yr 166 mm/hr
100yr 275 mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient
Apply the Rational Formula method outlined in Code of Practice on Surface Water
Drainage (Public Utilities Board 2006).
Q = 0.002788.C.I.A
C
5
= 0.65
C
100
= 0.65
Peak design flows
Q
5
= 0.002788 x 0.65 x 166 x 0.485 = 0.15 m
3
/s
Q
100
= 0.002788 x 0.65 x 275 x 0.485 = 0.24 m
3
/s
5.7.4 Step 3: Configuring the Swale
5.7.4.1 Swale Width and Side Slopes
To facilitate at-grade driveway crossings the following cross section is proposed:
5.7.4.2 Maximum Length of Swale
The capacity of the swale is firstly estimated at the most downstream point. It is
considered to be the critical point in the swale as it has the largest catchment and has
the mildest slope. Flow velocities will also need to be checked at the downstream end
of the steep section of swale.
The worked example firstly considers the swale capacity using a turf grass surface
with a vegetation height of 100 mm. An extension of the worked example is to
investigate the consequence of using 300mm tall vegetation (e.g. sedges) instead of
grass.
A range of Mannings n values are selected for different flow depths appropriate for
grass. It is firstly assumed that the flow height for a 5-year ARI storm will be above the
1
Please refer to Code of Practice for Surface Water Drainage
2m 2m 1.2m
0.2m
1
10
1
10
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 31
vegetation and therefore Mannings n is quite low. A figure of 0.04 is adopted. The
flow depth will need to be checked to ensure it is above the vegetation.
Adopt slope 3% (minimum longitudinal slope)
Mannings n = 0.04 (at 0.2m depth)
Side slopes 1(v):10(h)
From Mannings equation: Q = (AR
2/3
S
o
1/2
)/n
Q
cap
= 0.683 m
3
/s >> Q
5
(0.15 m
3
/s) OK
The nominated swale has sufficient capacity to convey the required peak Q
5
flow
without any requirement for an additional piped drainage system (i.e. slope = 3%, n =
0.07, Q
5
= 0.15 m
3
/s), solving Mannings equation for depth, d
5-year
= 0.13 m.
The capacity of the swale (Q
cap
= 0.683m
3
/s) is also sufficient to convey the entire
peak Q
100
flow of 0.24m
3
/s without impacting on the adjacent road and footpath (i.e.
slope = 3%, n = 0.04, Q
100
= 0.2425 m
3
/s) and solving Mannings equation for depth
gives d
100-year
= 0.143 m. Usually the swale should be sized so that in a major event
the road accommodates some of the flow. However these dimensions are used to
facilitate at grade driveway crossings.
The flow depths of both the minor (0.13 m) and major (0.143 m) event flows are less
than the depth of the swale (0.2 m), indicating that all flow is contained within the
swales.
Based on this result, the maximum permissible length of swale is also much longer than
the actual length of the swale (i.e. 100 m) and as such no overflow pits are required
except at the downstream end of the swale to facilitate discharge to the trunk
underground pipe drainage system (see Chapter 6 for design of overflow pits).
To investigate flow rates at depths lower than the height of vegetation, Mannings n is
varied according to the flow depth relating to the vegetation height. This can be
performed simply in a spreadsheet application. The values adopted here are:
Table 5.2 Mannings n and flow capacity variation with flow depth turf
Flow Depth (m) Mannings n Flow (m
3
/s)
0.05 0.30 0.006
0.1 0.30 0.02
0.15 0.06 0.252
0.2 0.04 0.674
From the table of Mannings equation output (
Table 5.2), it can be seen that the 5-year ARI flow depth is above the vegetation
height and therefore the adopted Mannings n value of 0.07 is reasonable. The
boundary layer effect created by the turf significantly decreases between a flow depth
of 0.1 m and 0.15 m with Mannings n decreasing from 0.3 to 0.06. This is due to the
weight of the water flowing over the grass causing it to yield over creating a
smoother surface with less resistance to flow. Once the water depth has reached
twice the vegetation height (0.2 m), the Mannings n roughness coefficient has been
further reduced to 0.04.
For the purposes of this worked example, the capacity of the swale is also estimated
when using 300mm tall vegetation (e.g. sedges). The taller vegetation will increase
the roughness of the swale (as flow depths will be below the vegetation height) and
therefore a higher Mannings n should be adopted. The table below presents the
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 32
adopted Mannings n values and the corresponding flow capacity of the swale for
different flow depths.
Table 5.3 Mannings n and flow capacity variation with flow depth sedges
Flow Depth (m) Mannings n Flow (m
3
/s)
0.05 0.35 0.004
0.1 0.32 0.002
0.15 0.30 0.05
0.2 0.30 0.09
It can be seen in Table 5.3 that the swale with current dimensions is not capable of
conveying a 5-year discharge of 0.15 m
3
/s if sedges are to be planted. Either the
swale depth would need to be increased or overflow pits provided to allow excess
water to bypass the swale.
This worked example continues using 100mm turf for the remainder.
5.7.5 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems
There are two ways for flows to reach the swale, either directly from the road surface
or from allotments via an underground 100mm pipe.
Direct runoff from the road enters the swale via a buffer (the grass edge of the swale).
The pavement surface is set 60 mm higher than the start of the swale and has a taper
that will allow sediments to accumulate off the pavement surface in the first section of
the buffer. Flows from allotments will discharge into the base of the swale and
localised erosion protection is provided with grouted rock at the outlet point of the pipe.
5.7.6 Step 5: Verification Checks
5.7.6.1 Vegetation scour velocity checks
Two velocity checks are performed to ensure vegetation is protected from erosion at
high flow rates. 5-year and 100-year ARI flow velocities are checked and need to be
kept below 0.5m/s and 2.0 m/s respectively.
Velocities are estimated using Mannings equation:
Firstly, velocities are checked at the most downstream location for the 5-year ARI (i.e.
slope = 3%, n = 0.07, Q
5
= 0.15 m
3
/s)
d
5-year
= 0.13 m
V
5-year
= 0.46 m/s < 0.5 m/s therefore OK
Secondly, velocities are checked at the most downstream location for the 100-year
ARI (i.e. slope = 3%, n = 0.04, Q
5
= 0.24 m
3
/s)
D
100-year
= 0.143 m
V
100-year
= 0.645 m/s < 2.0 m/s therefore OK
5.7.6.2 Velocity and Depth Checks - Safety
Check at critical points (bottom of entire swale) that velocity depth product is less than
0.4 during a 100-year ARI flow.
At bottom of swale:
V= 0.645 m/s, d= 0.143m; therefore V.d = 0.092 m
2
.s <0.4 therefore OK.
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 33
5.7.6.3 Confirm Treatment Performance
As there has been no requirement to alter the swale geometry established for Swales
1 and 2 in Step 3, the same treatment performance identified in Step 1 still applies.
Where modifications to the swale geometry occur during the previous design steps, a
check of the new configuration with procedures identified in Step 1 is required to
ensure treatment performance is adequate.
5.7.7 Step 6: Size Overflow Pits
As the swale can carry a five-year ARI discharge, overflow structures are not required
for this worked example. See Chapter 5 for an example including the design of an
overflow pit.
5.7.8 Step 7: Traffic Control
Traffic control in the worked example is achieved by using traffic bollards mixed with
street trees.
5.7.9 Step 8: Vegetation specification
To compliment the landscape design of the area, a turf species is to be used. For this
application a turf with a height of 100 mm has been assumed. The landscape designer
will select the actual species. The establishment of vegetation in swales should be in
consultation with the National Parks Board of Singapore.
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 34
5.7.10 Calculation summary
The sheet overleaf shows the results of the design calculations.
SWALES DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY SHEET
Calculation Task
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Outcome Check
Catchment Characteristics (Swale 1)
Catchment Area 0.485 ha
Catchment Land Use (i.e. residential, Commercial etc.) Res
Catchment Slope 3 %
Conceptual Design
Swale Top Width 5 m
Swale Length 100 m
Swale Location (road reserve/ park/other) Road res
Road Reserve Width 13.5 m
1 Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Swale Area 125 m
2
TSS Removal 70 %
TP Removal 47 %
TN Removal 13 %
2 Determine Design Flows
Time of concentration
Swale 1
2-10 year ARI 10 minutes
50-100 year ARI 10 minutes
Swale 2
2-10 year ARI minutes
50-100 year ARI minutes
Identify Rainfall intensities
Swale 1
I2-10 year ARI 166 mm/hr
I50-100 year ARI 275 mm/hr
Swale 2
I2-10 year ARI mm/hr
I50-100 year ARI mm/hr
Design Runoff Coefficient
C2-10 year ARI 0.65
C50-100 year ARI 0.65
Peak Design Flows
2-10 year ARI 0.15 m
3
/s
50-100 year ARI 0.24 m
3
/s
3 Dimension the Swale
Swale Width and Side Slopes
Base Width 1.0 m
Side Slopes 1 in 10
Longitudinal Slope 3 %
Vegetation Height 100 mm
Maximum Length of Swale
Mannings n 0.04
Swale Capacity 0.63 m
3
/s
Maximum Length of Swale <100 m
4 Design Inflow Systems
Swale Kerb Type Flush
60 mm set down to Buffer/ Swale Vegetation Yes Yes/ No
Adequate Erosion and Scour Protection (where required) N/A
5 Verification Checks (refer to PUB Guidelines)
Velocity for 2-10 year ARI flow (< 0.5 m/s) 0.46 m/s
Velocity for 50-100 year ARI flow (< 2 m/s) 0.71 m/s
Velocity x Depth for 50-100 year ARI (< 0.4 m
2
/s) 0.11 m
2
/s
Depth of Flow over Driveway Crossing for 50-100 year ARI (< 0.3 m) 0.15 m
Treatment Performance consistent with Step 1 Yes
6 Size Overflow Pits (Field Inlet Pits)
System to convey minor floods Swale 1 L x W
System to convey minor floods Swale 2 L x W
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 35
5.8 References
Barling RD & Moore ID 1993, 'The Role of Buffer Strips in the Management of
Waterway Pollution', in Woodfull J et al. (eds), The Role of Buffer Strips in the
Management of Waterway Pollution from Diffuse Urban and Rural Sources, LWRRDC
Occasional Paper No. 01/93, Canberra
CRCCH (Cooperative Research Centre for Catchment Hydrology) 2005, MUSIC: User
Guide, Manual for MUSIC Version 3.0, CRCCH, Melbourne
Duncan HP 1995, A Review of Urban Storm Water Quality Processes, Cooperative
Research Centre for Catchment Hydrology, Report 95/9, Melbourne, Australia
Engineers Australia 2006, Australian Runoff Quality, Engineers Australia,
ACT,http://www.arq.org.au/
Public Utilities Board (2006). Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage. Singapore.
50p.
Weibel SR, Weidner RB, Cohen JM & Christianson AG, 1996, Pesticides and Other
Contaminants in Rainfall and Runoff, Journal American Water Works Association, vol.
58, no. 8, August 1966, pp. 1075-1084
Bioretention Swales
6
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
6
Chapter 6 Bioretention Swales
6.1 Introduction 6-1
6.2 Design Considerations for Bioretention Swales 6-4
6.2.1 Landscape Design................................................................................................................. 6-4
6.2.2 Hydraulic Design .................................................................................................................. 6-4
6.2.3 Preventing Exfiltration to In-situ Soils .................................................................................. 6-4
6.2.4 Vegetation Types .................................................................................................................. 6-5
6.2.5 Bioretention Filter Media ...................................................................................................... 6-5
6.2.6 Traffic Controls .................................................................................................................... 6-6
6.2.7 Services ................................................................................................................................ 6-7
6.3 Bioretention Swale Design Process 6-8
6.3.1 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design ................................................ 6-9
6.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows for the Swale Component ................................................ 6-12
6.3.3 Step 3: Dimension the Swale Component with Consideration to Site Constraints .............. 6-13
6.3.4 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems to Swale and Bioretention Components ............................. 6-15
6.3.5 Step 5: Design Bioretention Component ............................................................................ 6-18
6.3.6 Step 6: Verify Design .......................................................................................................... 6-22
6.3.7 Step 7: Size Overflow Pit ..................................................................................................... 6-23
6.3.8 Step 8: Make Allowances to Preclude Traffic on Swales...................................................... 6-24
6.3.9 Step 9: Specify Plant Species and Planting Densities .......................................................... 6-24
6.3.10 Step 10: Consider Maintenance Requirements ................................................................... 6-24
6.3.11 Design Calculation Summary .............................................................................................. 6-24
6.3.12 Typical Design Parameters ................................................................................................. 6-26
6.4 Construction advice and checking tools 6-27
6.4.1 Design Assessment Checklist ............................................................................................. 6-27
6.4.2 Construction Advice ........................................................................................................... 6-29
6.4.3 Construction checklist ........................................................................................................ 6-31
6.4.4 Asset transfer checklist ...................................................................................................... 6-32
6.5 Maintenance Requirements 6-33
6.5.1 Operation & Maintenance Inspection Form......................................................................... 6-35
6.6 Bioretention swale worked example 6-36
6.6.1 Worked Example Introduction ............................................................................................ 6-36
6.6.2 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design .............................................. 6-38
6.6.3 Step 2: Estimate Design Flows for Swale Component ......................................................... 6-38
6.6.4 Step 3: Dimensions of Swale .............................................................................................. 6-40
6.6.5 Step 4: Design of Swale Inlet .............................................................................................. 6-40
6.6.6 Step 5: Design of bioretention component ......................................................................... 6-41
6.6.7 Step 6: Verification checks ................................................................................................. 6-43
6.6.8 Step 7: Overflow pit design ................................................................................................ 6-43
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
6.6.9 Step 8: Allowances to preclude traffic on swales ................................................................ 6-44
6.6.10 Step 9: Vegetation specification ......................................................................................... 6-44
6.6.11 Step 10: Maintenance Plan ................................................................................................. 6-44
6.6.12 Calculation summary .......................................................................................................... 6-45
6.6.13 Construction drawings ....................................................................................................... 6-46
6.7 References 6-48
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-1
6.1 Introduction
Bioretention swales provide both stormwater treatment and conveyance functions.
These systems consist of both elements of a vegetated swale and a bioretention
system. These components are subtly different in the main function of the swale is
that of conveyance while the primary function of the bioretention component is the
promotion of soil filtration of stormwater. Typically, a bioretention swale would consist
of a vegetated swale when the bioretention system is installed in the base of a swale.
The swale may have a discharge capacity to convey stormwater flow for frequent
events (i.e. up to the 5 year ARI event in accordance to the Singapore Code of
Practice on Surface Water Drainage).
The swale component provides pretreatment of stormwater to remove coarse to
medium sediments while the bioretention system removes finer particulates and
associated contaminants. Figure 6.1 shows the layout of a bioretention swale.
Bioretention swales provide flow retardation for frequent storm events and are
particularly efficient at removing nutrients.
Figure 6.1 Bioretention swale as a centre road median
The bioretention swale treatment process operates by firstly filtering stormwater runoff
through surface vegetation associated with the swale. The bioretention component
then operates by percolating the runoff vertically through a prescribed filter media,
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-2
which provides treatment through fine filtration, extended detention treatment and
biological uptake.
Bioretention swales also act to reduce flow velocities compared with piped systems
and thus provide protection to natural receiving waterways from frequent storm events
by disconnecting impervious areas from downstream waterways. The bioretention
component is typically located at the downstream end of the overlying swale cell (i.e.
immediately upstream of the swale overflow pit(s) as shown on Figure 6.2 or can be
provided as a continuous trench along the full length of a swale).
Figure 6.2 Bioretention Swale Conceptual Layout
The choice of bioretention location within the overlying swale will depend on a number
of factors, including available area for the bioretention filter media and the maximum
batter slopes for the overlying swale. Typically, when used as a continuous trench
along the full length of a swale, the desirable maximum longitudinal grade of the swale
is 4%. For other applications, the desirable longitudinal slope of the bioretention zone
is either horizontal or as close as possible to encourage uniform distribution of
stormwater flows over the full surface area of bioretention filter media and allowing
temporary storage of flows for treatment.
Vegetated swale bioretention
Road surface
Overflow pit
Vegetated swale bioretention
Vegetated swale bioretention
Road surface
Overflow pit
Vegetated swale bioretention
Ponding for extended detention
Filter media
Overflow
pit
Drainage layer
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-3
Bioretention swales are not intended to be infiltration systems in that the intent is to
prevent excessive stormwater exfiltrate from the bioretention filter media to the
surrounding in-situ soils. Rather, the typical design intent is to recover the percolated
stormwater runoff at the base of the filter media, within perforated under-drains, for
subsequent discharge to receiving waterways or to a storage facility for potential
reuse. Thus these systems are suited even when close to structures as long as steps
are taken to prevent exfiltration to surround soils through the use of a impervious liner
where necessary.
In some circumstances however, where the in-situ soils are appropriate and there is a
particular design intention to recharge local groundwater, it may be desirable to permit
the percolated stormwater runoff to infiltrate from the base of the filter media to the
underlying in-situ soils.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-4
6.2 Design Considerations for
Bioretention Swales
This section outlines some of the key design considerations for bioretention swales
that the designer should be familiar with. Standard design considerations for the
swale component of bioretention swales are discussed in detail in Chapter 5 (Swales
and Buffers) and are not reproduced here. However, swale design considerations that
relate specifically to the interactions between the swale and bioretention components
are presented in this chapter so as to provide sufficient clarity of these interactions
with design considerations that are specifically related to the bioretention component.
Design considerations for the bioretention system are similar to that presented in
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins and are presented in both chapters for ease of
reference with the exception of submerged zones which may be incorporated in
bioretention swales to maximise treatment performance. Refer to Chapter 7.2 Key
design configurations for further detail.
6.2.1 Landscape Design
Bioretention swales may be located within parkland areas, easements, carparks or
along roadway corridors within footpaths (i.e. road verges) or centre medians.
Landscape design of bioretention swales along the road edge can assist in defining
the boundary of road or street corridors as well as providing landscape character and
amenity. It is therefore important that the landscape design of bioretention swales
addresses stormwater quality objectives and accommodates these other important
landscape functions.
6.2.2 Hydraulic Design
A key hydraulic design consideration for bioretention swales is the delivery of
stormwater runoff from the swale onto the surface of a bioretention filter media. Flow
must not scour the bioretention surface and needs to be uniformly distributed over the
full surface area of the filter media. In steeper areas, check dams may be required
along the swale to reduce flow velocities discharged onto the bioretention filter media.
It is important to ensure that velocities in the bioretention swale are kept below 0.5 m/s
for frequent runoff events (2-10 year ARI) and below 2.0 m/s for major (50-100 year
ARI) runoff events to avoid scouring. This can be achieved by ensuring the slope and
hydraulic roughness of the overlying swale reduce flow velocities by creating shallow
temporary ponding (i.e. extended detention) over the surface of the bioretention filter
media via the use of a check dam. This may also increase the overall volume of
stormwater runoff that can be treated by the bioretention filter media.
6.2.3 Preventing Exfiltration to In-situ Soils
Bioretention swales can be designed to generally preclude exfiltration of treated
stormwater to the surrounding in-situ soils. The amount of water potentially lost from
bioretention trenches to surrounding in-situ soils is largely dependant on the
characteristics of the surrounding soils and the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the
bioretention filter media (see Section 6.2.5).
If the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the filter media is one to two orders of
magnitude (i.e. 10 to 100 times) greater than that of the surrounding soil profile, the
preferred flow path for stormwater runoff will be effectively contained within the
bioretention filter media and into the perforated under-drains at the base of the filter
media. As such, there will be little exfiltration to the surrounding soils.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-5
If the selected saturated hydraulic conductivity of the bioretention filter media is less
than 10 times that of the surrounding soils, it may be necessary to provide an
impermeable liner. Flexible membranes or a concrete casting are commonly used to
prevent excessive exfiltration. The greatest pathway of exfiltration is through the base
of a bioretention trench. If lining is required, it is likely that only the base and the sides
of the drainage layer (refer Section 6.2.5) will need to be lined.
A subsurface pipe is often used to prevent water intrusion into a road sub-base. This
practice is to continue as a precautionary measure to collect any water seepage from
bioretention swales located along roadways.
Bioretention system built on highly porous landscape may suitably promote exfiltration
to surrounding soils. In such circumstances, the designer must consider site terrain,
hydraulic conductivity of the in-situ soil, soil salinity, groundwater and building setback.
Further guidance in this regard is provided in Chapter 9 Infiltration.
6.2.4 Vegetation Types
Bioretention swales can use a variety of vegetation types including turf (swale
component only), sedges and tufted grasses. Vegetation is required to cover the
whole width of the swale and bioretention filter media surface, be capable of
withstanding design flows and be of sufficient density to prevent preferred flow paths
and scour of the media surface. Turf grasses should ideally be avoided where the soil
filter is as these are shallow rooted systems with inadequate penetration to the full
depth of the filter media and the turf stems inadequately prevent clogging at the
surface of the filter media. Therefore it is preferred that the vegetation for the
bioretention component of bioretention swales is sedges. The National Parks Board of
Singapore should be consulted on suitable vegetation species for bioretention
systems.
Dense vegetation planted along the swale component can also offer improved
sediment retention by reducing flow velocity and providing enhanced sedimentation for
deeper flows. However, densely vegetated swales have higher hydraulic roughness
and this will need to be considered in assessing their discharge capacity. Densely
vegetated bioretention swales can become features of an urban landscape and once
established, require minimal maintenance and are hardy enough to withstand large
flows.
6.2.5 Bioretention Filter Media
Selection of an appropriate bioretention filter media is a key design step involving
consideration of three inter-related factors:
Saturated hydraulic conductivity required to optimise the treatment
performance of the bioretention component given site constraints on available
filter media area.
Depth of extended detention provided above the filter media.
Suitability as a growing media to support vegetation growth (i.e. retaining
sufficient soil moisture and organic content).
The high rainfall intensities experienced in Singapore is expected to result in
bioretention treatment areas being larger in Singapore than comparable systems
overseas in Australia and the United States. The area available for bioretention
swales in an urban layout is often constrained by factors such as the available area
within the footpaths of standard road reserves.
Selecting bioretention filter media for bioretention swale applications in Singapore will
often require careful consideration of saturated hydraulic conductivity and extended
detention depth to ensure the desired minimum volume of stormwater runoff receives
treatment. This must also be balanced with the requirement to also ensure the
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-6
saturated hydraulic conductivity does not become too high such that it can no longer
sustain healthy vegetation growth.
The maximum saturated hydraulic conductivity should not exceed 500 mm/hr (and
preferably be between 50 - 200 mm/hr) in order to sustain vegetation growth.
The concept design stage will have established the optimal combination of filter media
saturated hydraulic conductivity and extended detention depth using a continuous
simulation modelling approach (i.e. MUSIC). Any adjustment of either of these two
design parameters during the detailed design stage will require the continuous
simulation modelling to be re-run to assess the impact on the overall treatment
performance of the bioretention basin.
As shown in Figure 6.3, a bioretention system can consist of three layers. The filter
media is the primary soil layer consisting typically of sandy-loam material. In addition
to the filter media, a drainage layer is also required to convey treated water from the
base of the filter media to the outlet via a perforated under-drains unless the design
intent is to allow the filtered water to discharge (exfiltrate) into insitu soil. The drainage
layer surrounds perforated under-drains and consist typically of fine gravel of 2-5 mm
particle size. In between the filter media layer and the drainage layer is the transition
layer consisting of clean sand (1mm) to prevent migration of the base filter media into
the drainage layer and into the perforated under-drains.
[Refer to the Bioretention Media Guidelines produced by FAWB
1
(2007) for more
information.]
Filter media (sandy loam)
Transition layer (coarse sand)
Perforated collection pipe
0.6 - 2.0 m
1 - 3 m
0.3 - 0.7 m
0.2 -
0.6 - 2.0 m
1 - 3 m
0.3 - 0.7 m
0.2 - 0.5 m
Possible impervious liner
Vegetated swale
0.2 m
0.1 m
Drainage layer (coarse sand/ gravel)
Figure 6.3 Typical Section of a Bioretention Swale
6.2.6 Traffic Controls
Another design consideration is keeping traffic and building material deliveries off
swales, particularly during the building phase of a development. If bioretention swales
are used for parking, then the surface will be compacted and vegetation damaged
beyond its ability to regenerate naturally. Compacting the surface of a bioretention
swale will reduce the hydraulic conductivity of filter media and lead to reduced
treatment. Vehicles driving on swales can cause ruts that can create preferential flow
paths that diminish the water quality treatment performance as well as creating
depressions that can retain water and potentially become mosquito breeding sites.
A staged construction and establishment method (see Section 6.4.2) affords protection
to the sub-surface elements of a bioretention swale from heavily sediment laden runoff
during the subdivision construction and allotment building phases. However, to
prevent vehicles driving on bioretention swales and inadvertent placement of building
1
Facility for Advancing Water Biofiltration http://www.monash.edu.au/fawb/
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-7
materials, it is necessary to consider appropriate traffic control solutions as part of the
system design. These can include temporary fencing of the swale during the
subdivision construction and allotment building phases with signage erected to alert
builders and constractors of the purpose and function of the swales. Management of
traffic near swales can be achieved in a number of ways such as planting the interface
to the road carriageway with dense vegetation that will discourage the movement of
vehicles onto the swale or, if dense vegetation cannot be used, by providing physical
barriers such as kerb and channel (with breaks to allow distributed water entry to the
swale) or bollards and/ or street tree planting.
Kerb and channel should be used at all corners, intersections, cul-de-sac heads and at
traffic calming devices to ensure correct driving path is taken. For all of these
applications, it is recommended that the kerb and channel extends 5 m beyond
tangent points. The transition from barrier or lay back type kerb to flush kerbs and vice
versa is to be done in a way that avoids creation of low points that cause ponding onto
the road pavement.
Where bollards/road edge guide posts are used, consideration should be given to
intermixing mature tree plantings with the bollards to break the visual monotony
created by a continuous row of bollards. Bollards and any landscaping (soft or hard)
must comply with the relevant guidelines.
6.2.7 Services
Bioretention swales located within footpaths (i.e. road verges) must consider the
standard location for services within the verge and ensure access for maintenance of
services. Typically it is acceptable to have water and sewer services located beneath
the batters of the swale with any sewers located beneath bioretention swales to be
fully welded polyethylene pipes with rodding points.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-8
6.3 Bioretention Swale Design
Process
To create bioretention swales, separate calculations are performed to design the
swale and the bioretention system, with iterations to ensure appropriate criteria are
met in each section. The calculations and decisions required to design the swale
component are presented in detail in Chapter 5 Swales and Buffers and are
reproduced in this chapter. This is to allow designers and assessors to consult with
this chapter only for designing and checking bioretention swale designs. The key
design steps are:
Each of these design steps is discussed below, followed by a worked example
illustrating application of the design process on a case study site.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-9
6.3.1 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Before commencing detailed design, the designer should first undertake a preliminary
check to confirm the bioretention swale treatment area from the concept design is
adequate to deliver the required level of stormwater quality improvement. A
conceptual design of a bioretention basin is normally typically undertaken prior to
detailed design. The performance of the concept design must be checked to ensure
that stormwater treatment objectives will be satisfied.
The treatment performance curves shown in Figure 6.4 to Figure 6.6 reflect the
treatment performance of the bioretention component only and will be conservative as
they preclude the sediment and nutrient removal performance of the overlying swale
component. Notwithstanding this, the performance of the swale component for
nitrogen removal is typically only minor and thus the sizing of the bioretention
component will typically be driven by achieving compliance with best practice load
reduction targets for Total Nitrogen. Therefore, by using the performance curves
below, the designer can be confident that the combined performance of the swale and
bioretention components of a bioretention swale will be similar to that shown in the
curves for total Nitrogen and will exceed that shown for Total Suspended Sediment
and total Phosphorus.
These curves are intended to provide an indication only of appropriate sizing and do
not substitute the need for a thorough conceptual design process. Nevertheless it is a
useful visual guide to illustrate the sensitivity of bioretention treatment performance to
the ratio of bioretention treatment area and contributing catchment area. The curves
allow the designer to make a rapid assessment as to whether the bioretention trench
component size falls within the optimal size range or if it is potentially under or over-
sized.
The curves in Figure 6.4 to Figure 6.6 show the total suspended solid (TSS), total
phosphorus (TP) and total nitrogen (TN) removal performance for a typical bioretention
basin design with the following configurations:
Filter media saturated hydraulic conductivity (k) = 180 mm/hr (0.5 x 10
-4
m/s)
and 360mm/hr (1 x 10
-4
m/s)
Filter Media average particle size = 0.5mm
Filter Media Depth = 0.6m
Extended Detention Depth = from 0 mm to 300 mm
The curves in Figure 6.4 to Figure 6.6 are generally applicable to bioretention swale
applications within residential, industrial and commercial land uses.
If the characteristics of the bioretention component of the bioretention swale concept
design are significantly different to that described above, then the curves in Figure 6.4
to Figure 6.6 may not provide an accurate indication of treatment performance. In
these cases, the detailed designer should use MUSIC to verify the performance of the
bioretention swale.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-10
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urface Area ( as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
S
S
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
= 360mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
B ioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area ( as % of Impervious C atc hment)
T
S
S
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 6.4 Bioretention system TSS removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-11
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
B ioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atc hment)
T
P
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
=360mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
P
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 6.5 Bioretention system TP removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-12
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
5%
10%
15%
20%
25%
30%
35%
40%
45%
50%
55%
60%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tems S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
N
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
=360mm/h
0%
5%
10%
15%
20%
25%
30%
35%
40%
45%
50%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
N
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 6.6 Bioretention system TN removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
6.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows for the Swale Component
6.3.2.1 Design Flows
Two design flows are required for the design of a swale:
Minor (frequent) storm conditions (typically 5 year ARI) to size the hydraulic
structures to safely convey storm flows of frequent/minor events within the
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-13
swale and not increase any flooding risk compared to conventional stormwater
systems
Major flood flow (50 to 100 year ARI) to check flow velocities, velocity depth
criteria, conveyance within road reserve, and freeboard to adjoining property.
6.3.2.2 Design Flow Estimation
A range of hydrologic methods can be applied to estimate design flows. As the typical
catchment area should be relatively small (<50 ha) the Rational Method design
procedure is considered to be a suitable method for estimating design peak flows.
6.3.3 Step 3: Dimension the Swale Component with Consideration to Site
Constraints
Factors to consider in defining the dimensions of the bioretention swale are:
allowable width given the proposed road reserve and/ or urban layout
how flows are delivered into a swale (e.g. cover requirements for pipes or kerb
details)
vegetation height
longitudinal slope
maximum side slopes and base width
provision of crossings (elevated or at grade)
requirements of the Public Utilities Board Code of Practice on Surface Water
Drainage (2006).
Depending on which of the above factors are fixed, the other variables can be adjusted
to derive the optimal swale dimensions for the given site conditions. The following
sections outline some considerations in relation to dimensioning a swale.
6.3.3.1 Swale Width and Side Slopes
The maximum width of swale is usually determined from an urban layout and at the
concept design stage, and should be in accordance with relevant local guidelines or
standards of the Public Utilities Board. Where the swale width is not constrained by an
urban layout (e.g. when located within a large parkland area) then the width of the
swale can be selected based on consideration of landscape objectives, maximum side
slopes for ease of maintenance and public safety, hydraulic capacity required to
convey the desired design flow, and treatment performance requirements. Swale side
slopes are typically between 1 in 10 and 1 in 4. The maximum swale width needs to
be identified early in the design process as it dictates the remaining steps in the swale
design process.
For swales located adjacent to residential roads, the types of driveway crossing used
will typically dictate batter slopes. Where there are no driveway crossings, the
maximum swale side slopes will be established from ease of maintenance and public
safety considerations. Generally at-grade crossings, are preferred which require the
swale to have 1:9 side slopes with a nominal 0.5 m flat base to provide sufficient
transitions to allow for traffic movement across the crossing. Flatter swale side slopes
can be adopted but this will reduce the depth of the swale and its conveyance
capacity. Where elevated crossings are used, swale side slopes would typically be
between 1 in 6 and 1 in 4. Elevated crossings will require provision for drainage under
the crossings with a culvert or similar. The selection of crossing type should be made
in consultation with urban and landscape designers.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-14
6.3.3.2 Maximum Length of a Swale
The maximum length of a swale is the distance along a swale before an overflow pit
(or field inlet pit) is required to drain the swale to an underlying pipe drainage system.
The maximum length of a swale located along a roadway is calculated as the distance
along the swale to the point where flow on the adjoining road pavement (or road
reserve) no longer complies with the local standards for road drainage (for both the
minor and major flood flows). This is often related to the discharge capacity of the
swale and is calculated as the distance along the swale to the point where the flow in
the swale (for the specific design flood frequency) exceeds the bank full capacity of the
swale. For example, if the swale is to convey the minor flood flow (typically the 5 year
ARI event in accordance to the Singapore Code of Practice for Surface Drainage)
without overflowing, then the maximum swale length would be determined as the
distance along the swale to the point where the 5 year ARI flow from the contributing
catchment is equivalent to the bank full flow capacity of the swale (bank full flow
capacity is determined using Mannings equation as discussed section 6.3.3.3).
6.3.3.3 Swale Capacity Mannings Equation and Selection of Mannings n
The flow capacity of a swale can be calculated using Mannings equation. This allows
the flow rate (and flood levels) to be determined for variations in swale dimensions,
vegetation type and longitudinal slope.
n
S R A
Q
2 / 1 3 / 2
= Equation 6.1
Where A = cross section area of swale (m
2
)
R = hydraulic radius (m)
S = channel slope (m/m)
n = roughness factor (Mannings n)
Q = flow (m
3
/s)
Mannings n is a critical variable in Mannings equation relating to roughness of the
channel. It varies with flow depth, channel dimensions and vegetation type. For
constructed swale systems, typical Mannings n values are between 0.15 and 0.4 for
flow depths shallower than the vegetation height (preferable for treatment) and
significantly lower for flows with greater depth than the vegetation (e.g. 0.03 for flow
depth more than twice the vegetation height).
Figure 6.7 shows a plot of Mannings n versus flow depth for a grass swale with
longitudinal grade of 5 % which is also applicable for other swale configurations. The
bottom axis of the plot has been modified from Barling and Moore (1993) to express
flow depth as a percentage of vegetation height. Further discussion on selecting an
appropriate Mannings n for a swale is provided in Appendix E of the MUSIC User
Guide (CRCCH 2005).
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-15
Figure 6.7 Impact of Flow Depth on Hydraulic Roughness (adapted from
Barling and Moore (1993))
6.3.4 Step 4: Design Inflow Systems to Swale and Bioretention Components
Inflows to bioretention swales can be via distributed runoff (e.g. from flush kerbs on a
road) or point outlets such as pipe outfalls. Combinations of these inflow pathways
can also be used. Uniform distribution of inflow would generally provide better
operating conditions of bioretention swales owing to their long linear configuration.
6.3.4.1 Distributed Inflow
An advantage of flows entering a bioretention swale system in a distributed manner
(i.e. entering perpendicular to the direction of the swale) is that flow depths are kept as
shallow owing to sheet flow conditions. This maximises contact with the swale and
bioretention vegetation, particularly on the batter (buffer strip) receiving the distributed
inflows (see Figure 6.8). The buffer strip provides good pretreatment (i.e. significant
coarse sediment removal) prior to flows being conveyed along the swale.
Distributed inflows can be achieved either by having a flush kerb or by using kerbs
with regular breaks in them to allow for even flows across the buffer surface (Figure
6.9).
No specific design rules exist for designing buffer systems, however there are several
design guides that are to be applied to ensure buffers operate to improve water quality
and provide a pre-treatment role. Key design parameters of buffer systems are:
providing distributed flows into a buffer (potentially spreading stormwater flows
to achieve this)
avoiding rilling or channelised flows
maintaining flow heights lower than vegetation heights (this may require flow
spreaders, or check dams)
minimising the slope of buffer, best if slopes can be kept below 5 %, however
buffers can still perform well with slopes up to 20 % provided flows are well
distributed. The steeper the buffer the more likely flow spreaders will be
required to avoid rill erosion.
80 10 20 40 60 90 105 200 80 10 20 40 60 90 105 200
Depth as % of vegetation height
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-16
Figure 6.8 Flush Kerb with 60 mm Set-down to allow Sediment to Flow into
Vegetated Area
Figure 6.9 Kerb Arrangements with Breaks to Distribute Inflows on to
Bioretention Swales and Prevent Vehicle Access
Maintenance of buffers is required to remove accumulated sediment and debris
therefore access is important. Most sediments will accumulate immediately
downstream of the pavement surface and then progressively further downstream as
sediment builds up.
It is important to ensure coarse sediments accumulate off the road surface at the start
of the buffer. Figure 6.10 shows sediment accumulating on a street surface where the
vegetation is the same level as the road. To avoid this accumulation, a tapered flush
kerb must be used that sets the top of the vegetation at approximately 60 mm below
the road surface (refer Figure 6.8), which requires the top of the ground surface
(before turf is placed) to be approximately 100 mm below the road surface. This
allows sediments to accumulate off any trafficable surface.
Road edge
Road surface
60 mm set down
Buffer strip
Depth as % of
vegetation
height
Sediment accumulation area
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-17
Figure 6.10 Flush Kerb without Setdown, showing Sediment Accumulation on
Road
6.3.4.2 Concentrated Inflow
Concentrated inflows to a bioretention swale can be in the form of a concentrated
overland flow or a discharge from a piped drainage system (e.g. allotment drainage
line). For all concentrated inflows, energy dissipation at the inflow location is an
important consideration to minimise any erosion potential. This can usually be
achieved with rock benching and/ or dense vegetation.
The most common constraint on pipe systems discharging to bioretention swales is
bringing the pipe flows to the surface of a swale. In situations where the swale
geometry does not allow the pipe to achieve free discharge to the surface of the
swale, a surcharge pit may need to be used. Surcharge pits should be designed so
that they are as shallow as possible and have pervious bases or weep-holes to avoid
long term ponding in the pits (this may require under-drains to ensure it drains,
depending on local soil conditions). The pits need to be accessible so that any build
up of coarse sediment and debris can be monitored and removed if necessary.
Surcharge pits are not considered good practice due to additional maintenance issues
and mosquito breeding potential and should therefore be avoided where possible.
Surcharge pit systems are most frequently used when allotment runoff is required to
cross a road into a swale on the opposite side of the road or for allotment runoff
discharging into shallow profile swales. Where allotment runoff needs to cross under a
road to discharge to a swale, it is preferable to combine the runoff from more than one
allotment to reduce the number of crossings required under the road pavement.
Figure 6.11 illustrates a typical surcharge pit discharging into a swale.
Another important form of concentrated inflow in a bioretention swale is the discharge
from the swale component into the bioretention component, particularly where the
bioretention component is located at the downstream end of the overlying swale and
receives flows concentrated within the swale. Depending on the grade, its top width
and batter slopes, the resultant flow velocities at the transition from the swale to the
bioretention filter media may require the use of energy dissipation to prevent scour of
the filter media. For most cases, this can be achieved by placing several large rocks
in the flow path to reduce velocities and spread flows. Energy dissipaters located
within footpaths must be designed to ensure pedestrian safety.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-18
Figure 6.11 Example of Surcharge Pit for Discharging Allotment Runoff into a
Swale
6.3.5 Step 5: Design Bioretention Component
6.3.5.1 Specify the Bioretention Filter Media Characteristics
Generally three types of media are required in the bioretention component of
bioretention swales (refer Figure 6.3 in Section 6.2.5).
Filter Media
The filter media layer provides the majority of the pollutant treatment
function, through fine filtration and also by supporting vegetation. The
vegetation enhances filtration, keeps the filter media porous, provides
substrate for biofilm formation that is important for the uptake and removal of
nutrients and other stormwater pollutants. As a minimum, the filter media is
required to have sufficient depth to support vegetation. Typical depths are
between 600-1000 mm with a minimum depth of 400mm accepted in depth
constrained situations. It is important to note that if deep rooted plants such
as trees are to be planted in bioretention swales, the filter media must have a
minimum depth of 800 mm to provide sufficient plant anchoring depth.
Saturated hydraulic conductivity should remain between 50-200 mm/hr (and
should not be greater than 500 mm/hr. The following procedure is
recommended in determine the appropriate soil filter media to match the
design saturated hydraulic conductivity:
Identify available sources of a suitable base soil (i.e. topsoil) capable of
supporting vegetation growth such as a sandy loam or sandy clay loam.
In-situ topsoil should be considered first before importing soil. Any soil
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
Secured grate
Pipe connection from allotment
ELEVATION
Vertical drainage slots
Removeable geofabric for
cleaning sediment accumulation
PLAN
Drainage holes to be drilled
in base of pit
PLAN
Drainage holes to be drilled
in base of pit
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-19
found to contain high levels of salt (see last bullet point), extremely low
levels of organic carbon (< 3%), or other extremes considered retardant
to plant growth and microbial activity should be rejected. The base soil
must also be structurally sound and not prone to structural collapse as
this can result in a significant reduction in saturated hydraulic
conductivity. The risk of structural collapse can be reduced by ensuring
the soil has a well graded particle size distribution with a combined clay
and silt fraction of < 12%.
Using laboratory analysis, determine the saturated hydraulic conductivity
of the base soil using standard testing procedures. (In Australia,
reference is made to AS 4419-2003 Appendix H Soil Permeability). A
minimum of five samples of the base soil should be tested. Any
occurrence of structural collapse during laboratory testing must be noted
and an alternative base soil sourced.
To amend the base soil to achieve the desired design saturated
hydraulic conductivity either mix in a loose non-angular sand (to increase
saturated hydraulic conductivity) or conversely a loose loam (to reduce
saturated hydraulic conductivity).
The required content of sand or clay (by weight) to be mixed to the base
soil will need to be established in the laboratory by incrementally
increasing the content of sand or clay until the desired saturated
hydraulic conductivity is achieved. The sand or clay content (by weight)
that achieves the desired saturated hydraulic conductivity should then be
adopted on-site. A minimum of five samples of the selected base soil
and sand (or clay) content mix must be tested in the laboratory to ensure
saturated hydraulic conductivity is consistent across all samples. If the
average saturated hydraulic conductivity of the final filter media mix is
within 20% of the design saturated hydraulic conductivity then the filter
media can be adopted and installed in the bioretention system.
Otherwise, further amendment of the filter media must occur through the
addition of sand (or clay) and retested until the design saturated
hydraulic conductivity is achieved.
The base soil must have sufficient organic content to establish
vegetation on the surface of the bioretention system. If the proportion of
base soil in the final mix is less than 3%, it may be necessary to add
organic material. This should not result in more than 10% organic
content and should not alter the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the
final filter media mix.
The pH of the final filter media is to be amended (if required) to between
5.5 and 7.5. If the filter media mix is being prepared off-site, this
amendment should be undertaken before delivery to the site.
The salt content of the final filter media (as measured by EC1:5) must be
less than 0.63 dS/m for low clay content soils like sandy loam. (EC1:5 is
the electrical conductivity of a 1:5 soil/ water suspension).
Testing of this soil property should be undertaken prior to their
placement during construction. It should also be noted that soil hydraulic
conductivity will vary after placement and is expected to initially decrease
due to hydraulic compaction during operation. With maturity of plant
growth, the soil hydraulic conductivty canbe expected to recover to
asymptote to an equilibrium level comparable to its original value.
The selection of suitable soil filter media is a topic of continuing research.
Further information can be obtained from FAWB (2007).
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-20
Transition Layer
The particle size difference between the filter media and the underlying
drainage layer should be not more than one order of magnitude to avoid the
filter media being washed through the voids of the drainage layer. Therefore,
with fine gravels being used for the drainage layer (which will be at least two
orders of magnitude coarser than the likely average particle size of the filter
media), a transition layer is recommended to prevent the filter media from
washing into the perforated pipes. The material for the transition layer is
sand/coarse sand. An example particle size distribution (% passing) is
provided below (typical specification only):
1.4 mm 100 %
1.0 mm 80 %
0.7 mm 44 %
0.5 mm 8.4 %
The transition layer is recommended to be 100 mm thick.
The addition of a transition layer increases the overall depth of the
bioretention system and may be an important consideration for some sites
where total depth of the bioretention system may be constrained. In such
cases, two options are available to reduce the overall depth of the system,
ie.
the use of a sand drainage layer and/or perforated pipes with smaller
slot sized may need to be considered (Section 6.3.5.2).
use a geotextile layer with a mesh size specified to be between 0.7
to 1mm. (This option should be an option of last resort as the risk of
installing inappropriate liner is high).
Drainage Layer
The drainage layer is used to convey treated flows to the outlet via a
perforated under-drainage system. The composition of the drainage layer is
to be considered in conjunction with the selection and design of the
perforated under-drainage system (refer to Section 6.3.5.2) as the slot sizes
in the perforated pipes may determine the minimum drainage layer particle
size to avoid washout of the drainage layer into the perforated pipe system.
Gravel is the preferred media for the drainage layer to match with the typical
slot size of typical perforated or slotted under-drains.
However, there may be circumstances where site conditions constraint the
depth of the bioretention system. In such cases, it may be possible to use
sand as the drainage layer media to avoid having to provide a transition layer
between the filter media and the drainage layer. The drainage layer is to be
a minimum of 200 mm thick and it is advisable that the drainage media is
washed prior to placement in bioretention system to remove any fines.
6.3.5.2 Under-drain Design and Capacity Checks
The maximum spacing of the perforated pipes in wide bioretention trenches is 1.5 m
(centre to centre) to ensure effective drainage of the bioretention system.
By installing parallel pipes, the capacity of the perforated pipe under-drain system can
be increased. The recommended maximum diameter of the perforated pipes is 100
mm to minimise the required thickness of the drainage layer. Either flexible perforated
pipe (e.g. agricultural pipe) or slotted PVC pipes can be used, however care needs to
be taken to ensure that the slots in the pipes are not too large that sediment would
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-21
freely flow into the pipes from the drainage layer. This is also a consideration when
specifying the drainage layer media.
To ensure the slotted or perforated pipes are of adequate size, several checks are
required:
Ensure perforations are adequate to pass the maximum filtration rate of the
media.
Ensure the pipe itself has capacity to convey the design flow (ie. the maximum
filtration rate multiplied by the surface area).
Ensure that the material in the drainage layer will not be washed into the
perforated pipes.
6.3.5.3 Maximum filtration rate
The maximum filtration rate represents the maximum rate of flow through the
bioretention filter media and is calculated by applying Darcys equation (Equation 6.2)
as follows:
d
d h
W L K Q
max
base sat max
+
=
Equation 6.2
Where Q
max
= maximum infiltration rate (m
3
/s)
K
sat
= hydraulic conductivity of the soil filter (m/s)
W
base
= base width of the ponded cross section above the
soil filter (m)
L = length of the bioretention zone (m)
h
max
= depth of pondage above the soil filter (m)
d = depth of filter media (m)
The capacity of the perforated under-drains need to be greater than the maximum
filtration rate to ensure the filter media drains freely and the pipe(s) do not become the
hydraulic control in the bioretention system (i.e. to ensure the filter media sets the
travel time for flows percolating through the bioretention system rather than the flow
through the perforated under-drainage system).
To ensure the perforated under-drainage system has sufficient capacity to collect and
convey the maximum infiltration rate, it is necessary to determine the inflow capacity of
combined slotted area or perforation area of the under-drainage system. To do this,
the sharp edged orifice equation can be used, i.e.
the number and size of perforations is determined (typically from
manufacturers specifications)
the maximum driving head (being the depth of the filtration media plus the
depth of extended detention).
it is conservative but reasonable to use a blockage factor to account for partial
blockage of the perforations by the drainage layer media. A 50 % blockage of
the perforation is recommended. The orifice equation is expressed as
follows:-
h g 2 A C B Q
d perf
= Equation 6.3
Where
Q
perf
= flow through perforations or slots (m
3
/s)
B = blockage factor (0.5)
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-22
C
d
= orifice discharge coefficient (0.61 for sharp edge
orifice)
A = total area of the orifice (m
2
)
g = gravity (9.81 m/s
2
)
h = head above the perforated pipe (m)
It is essential that adequate inflow capacity is provided to enable the filtered water to
drain freely into the drainage layer.
After confirming the capacity of the under-drainage system to collect the maximum
filtration rate, it is then necessary to confirm the conveyance capacity of the under-
drainage system is sufficient to convey the collected runoff. To do this, Mannings
equation (Equation 6.1) can be used assuming pipe full flow conditions and a nominal
friction slope of 0.5%. The Mannings roughness used will be dependent on the type
of pipe used.
One end of the under-drains should be extended vertically to the surface of the
bioretention system to allow inspection and maintenance when required. The vertical
section of the under-drain should be a non-perforated or slotted pipe and capped to
avoid short circuiting of flows directly to the drain.
6.3.5.4 Check Requirement for Impermeable Lining
The saturated hydraulic conductivity of the natural soil profile surrounding the
bioretention system should be tested together with depth to groundwater, chemical
composition and proximity to structures and other infrastructure. This is to establish if
an impermeable liner is required at the base (only for systems designed to preclude
exfiltration to in-situ soils) and/or sides of the bioretention basin (refer also to
discussion in Section 6.2.5). If the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the filter media
in the bioretention system is more than one order of magnitude (10 times) greater than
that of the surrounding in-situ soil profile, no impermeable lining is required.
6.3.6 Step 6: Verify Design
6.3.6.1 Vegetation Scour Velocity Check
Potential scour velocities are checked by applying Mannings equation (Equation 6.1)
to the bioretention swale design to ensure the following criteria are met:
less than 0.5 m/s for minor flood (2-10 year ARI) discharge
less than 2.0 m/s for major flood (50-100 year ARI) discharge
2
.
6.3.6.2 Velocity and Depth Check Safety
As bioretention swales are generally accessible by the public, it is important at any
crossings and adjacent pedestrian and bicycle pathways to check that, the product of
flow depth and flow velocity within the bioretention swale satisfies the following
recommended public safety criteria:
depth x velocity < 0.6.m
2
/s for low risk locations and 0.4 m
2
/s for high risk
locations
maximum depth of flow over crossing = 0.3 m
2
This is consistent with the recommendation in the Singapore Code of Practice for Surface Drainage which stipulates
that the maximum velocity for a earth drain and concrete-lined drain should not exceed 1.5 m/s and 3 m/s respectively.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-23
6.3.6.3 Confirm Treatment Performance
If the previous two checks are satisfactory then the bioretention swale design is
satisfactory from a conveyance function perspective and it is now necessary to confirm
the treatment performance of the bioretention swale by reference to the performance
information presented in Section 6.2.5
6.3.7 Step 7: Size Overflow Pit
In a bioretention swale system, overflow pits are used to control innundation depth.
The crest of the pit is set raised above the surface of the bioretention filter media to
establish the design extended detention depth.
Grated pits are typically used and the allowable head for discharges into the pits is the
difference in level between the pit crest and the maximum permissible water level to
satisfy the minimum freeboard requirements of the Public Utilities Board. Depending
on the location of the bioretention swale, the design flow to be used to size the
overflow pit could be the maximum capacity of the swale, the minor flood flow (5 year
ARI) or the major flood flow (50-100 year ARI).
To size an overflow pit, two checks should be made to test for either drowned or free
flowing conditions. A weir equation can be used to determine the length of weir
required (assuming free overflowing conditions) and an orifice equation used to
estimate the area between openings required in the grate cover (assuming drowned
outlet conditions). The larger of the two pit configurations should be adopted. In
addition, a blockage factor is to be used, that assumes the grate is 50% blocked.
For free overfall conditions (weir equation):
2 / 3
w weir
h L C B Q = Equation 6.4
Where Q
weir
= Flow into pit (weir) under free overfall conditions (m
3
/s)
B = Blockage factor (= 0.5)
C
w
= Weir coefficient (= 1.7)
L = Length of weir (perimeter of pit) (m)
h = Flow depth above the weir (pit) (m)
Once the length of weir is calculated, a standard sized pit can be selected with a
perimeter at least the same length of the required weir length.
For drowned outlet conditions (orifice equation):
h g 2 A C B Q
d orifice
= Equation 6.5
Where B, g and h have the same meaning as in Equation 6.4
Q
orifice
= flow rate into pit under drowned conditions (m
3
/s)
C
d
= discharge coefficient (drowned conditions = 0.6)
A = area of orifice (perforations in inlet grate) (m
2
)
When designing grated field inlet pits, refer to relevant guidelines or standards for
grate types for inlet pits.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-24
6.3.8 Step 8: Make Allowances to Preclude Traffic on Swales
Refer to Section 6.2.6 for discussion on traffic control options.
6.3.9 Step 9: Specify Plant Species and Planting Densities
Refer to Section 6.2.4 and the National Parks Board of Singapore for advice on
selecting suitable plant species for bioretention swales in Singapore. Consultation with
landscape architects is recommended when selecting vegetation to ensure the
treatment system compliments the landscape design of the area.
6.3.10 Step 10: Consider Maintenance Requirements
Consider how maintenance is to be performed on the bioretention swale e.g. how and
where is access available, where is litter likely to collect etc.. A specific maintenance
plan and schedule should be developed for the bioretention swale in accordance with
Section 6.5.
6.3.11 Design Calculation Summary
The following design calculation table can be used to summarise the design data and
calculation results from the design process.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-25
BIORETENTION SWALES DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Calculation Task Outcome Check
Catchment Characteristics
Catchment Area ha
Catchment Land Use (i.e. residential, Commercial etc.)
Conceptual Design
Bioretention area m
2
Filter media saturated hydraulic conductivity mm/hr
Extended detention depth mm
1 Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Bioretention area to achieve water quality objectives m
2
TSS Removal %
TP Removal %
TN Removal %
2 Estimate Design Flows for Swale Compnent
Time of concentration relevant local government guideline minutes
Identify Rainfall intensities
I2-10 year ARI mm/hr
I50-100 year ARI mm/hr
Design Runoff Coefficient
C2-10 year ARI
C50-100 year ARI
Peak Design Flows
2-10 year ARI m
3
/s
50-100 year ARI m
3
/s
3 Dimension the Swale Component
Swale Width and Side Slopes
Base Width m
Side Slopes 1 in
Longitudinal Slope %
Vegetation Height mm
Maximum Length of Swale
Mannings n
Swale Capacity
Maximum Length of Swale
4 Design Inflow Systems to Swale & Bioretention Components
Swale Kerb Type
Adequate Erosion and Scour Protection (where required)
5 Design Bioretention Component
Filter media hydraulic conductivity mm/hr
Extended detention depth mm
Filter media depth mm
Drainage layer media (sand or fine screenings)
Drainage layer depth mm
Transition layer (sand) required
Transition layer depth mm
Under-drain Design and Capacity Checks
Flow capacity of filter media (maximum infiltration rate) m
3
/s
Perforations inflow check
Pipe diameter mm
Number of pipes
Capacity of perforations m
3
/s
CHECK PERFORATION CAPACITY > FILTER MEDIA CAPACITY
Perforated pipe capacity
Pipe capacity m
3
/s
CHECK PIPE CAPACITY > FILTER MEDIA CAPACITY
Check requirement for impermeable lining
Soil hydraulic conductivity mm/hr
Filter media hydraulic conductivity mm/hr
MORE THAN 10 TIMES HIGHER THAN IN-SITU SOILS?
5 Verification Checks
Velocity for 2-10 year ARI flow (< 0.5 m/s) m/s
Velocity for 50-100 year ARI flow (< 2 m/s) m/s
Velocity x Depth for 50-100 year ARI (< 0.4 m
2
/s) m
2
/s
Treatment Performance consistent with Step 1
6 Overflow Pit Design
System to convey minor floods L x W
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-26
6.3.12 Typical Design Parameters
Table 6.1 shows typical values for a number of key bioretention swale design
parameters.
Table 6.1: Typical Design Parameters for Bioretention Swales
Design Parameter Typical Values
Swale longitudinal slope 1% to 4 %
Swale side slope for trafficability (with at grade vehicular crossover) Maximum 1 in 9
Swale side slope Maximum 1 in 3
Mannings n (with flow depth lower than vegetation height) 0.15 to 0.3
Mannings n (with flow depth greater than vegetation height) 0.03 to 0.05
Maximum velocity for scour in minor event (e.g. 2-10 yr ARI) 0.5 m/s
Maximum velocity for 50-100 yr ARI
2.0 m/s
Perforated pipe diameter 100 mm (maximum)
Drainage layer average material diameter (typically fine gravel or
coarse sand)
1-5 mm diameter
Transition layer average material diameter typically sand to coarse
sand
0.7 1.0 mm
diameter
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-27
6.4 Construction advice and
checking tools
This section provides a number of checking aids for designers and referral authorities.
In addition, advice on construction techniques and lessons learnt from building
bioretention systems are provided.
Checklists are provided for:
Design assessments
Construction (during and post)
Operation and maintenance inspections
Asset transfer (following defects period).
6.4.1 Design Assessment Checklist
The checklist overleaf below presents the key design features that should be reviewed
when assessing a design of a bioretention basin. These considerations include
configuration, safety, maintenance and operational issues that should be addressed
during the design phase.
Where an item results in an N when reviewing the design, referral should be made
back to the design procedure to determine the impact of the omission or error.
In addition to the checklist, a proposed design should have all necessary permits for
its installations. The referral agency should ensure that all relevant permits are in
place. These can include permits to clear vegetation, to dredge, create a waterbody,
divert flows or disturb habitat.
Land ownership and asset ownership are key considerations prior to construction of a
stormwater treatment device. A proposed design should clearly identify the asset
owner and who is responsible for its maintenance. The proposed owner should be
responsible for performing the asset transfer checklist (see Section 0).
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-28
BIORETENTION SWALE DESIGN ASSESSMENT CHECKLIST
Asset I.D.
Bioretention
Location:
Hydraulics: Minor Flood (m
2
/s): Major Flood (m
2
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Bioretention Area (m
2
):
TREATMENT Y N
Treatment performance verified from curves?
SWALE COMPONENT Y N
Longitudinal slope of invert >1% and <4%?
Mannings 'n' selected appropriate for proposed vegetation type?
Overall flow conveyance system sufficient for design flood event?
Maximum flood conveyance width does not impact on traffic requirements?
Overflow pits provided where flow capacity exceeded?
Energy dissipation provided at inlet points to the swale?
Velocities within bioretention cells will not cause scour?
Set down of at least 60mm below kerb invert to top of vegetation incorporated?
BIORETENTION COMPONENT Y N
Design documents bioretention area and extended detention depth as defined by treatment performance requirements?
Overflow pit crest set at top of extended detention?
Maximum ponding depth and velocity will not impact on public safety (v x d <0.4)
Bioretention media specification includes details of filter media, drainage layer and transition layer (if required)?
Design saturated hydraulic conductivity included in specification?
Transition layer provided where drainage layer consists of gravel (rather than coarse sand)?
Perforated pipe capacity > infiltration capacity of filter media?
Selected filter media hydraulic conductivity > 10 x hydraulic conductivity of surrounding soil?
Maximum spacing of collection pipes <1.5m?
Collection pipes extended to surface to allow inspection and flushing?
Liner provided if selected filter media hydraulic conductivity > 10x hydraulic conductivity of surrounding soil?
Maintenance access provided to invert of conveyance channel?
LANDSCAPE & VEGETATION Y N
Plant species selected can tolerate periodic dry periods, inundation and design velocities?
Bioretention swale landscape design integrates with surrounding natural and/ or built environment?
Planting design conforms with acceptable sight line and safety requirements?
Top soils are a minimum depth of 300 mm for plants and 100 mm for turf?
Existing trees in good condition are investigated for retention?
Detailed soil specification included in design?
COMMENTS
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-29
6.4.2 Construction Advice
This section provides general advice for the construction of bioretention basins. It is
based on observations from construction projects around Australia.
6.4.2.1 Clean filter media
Ensure drainage media is washed prior to placement to remove fines.
6.4.2.2 Perforated Pipes
Suitable perforated pipes can be either a PVC pipe with slots cut into the length of it or
a flexible ribbed pipe with smaller holes distributed across its surface (an AG or
agricultural pipe). PVC pipes have the advantage of being stiffer with less surface
roughness therefore greater flow capacity; however the slots are generally larger than
for flexible pipes and this may cause problems with filter or drainage layer particle
ingress into the pipe. Stiff PVC pipes however can be cleaned out easily using simple
plumbing equipment. Flexible perforated pipes have the disadvantage of roughness
(therefore flow capacity) but have smaller holes and are flexible which can make
installation easier. Blockages within the flexible pipes can be harder to dislodge with
standard plumbing tools.
6.4.2.3 Tolerances
It is importance to stress the importance of tolerances in the construction of
bioretention swales (e.g base, longitudinal and batters) - having flat surfaces is
particularly important for a well distributed flow paths and even ponding over the
surfaces. Generally a tolerance of 50mm in surface levels is acceptable.
6.4.2.4 Building Phase Damage
Protection of filtration media and vegetation is important during the building phase.
Uncontrolled building site runoff is likely to cause excessive sedimentation, introduce
weeds and litter and require replanting following the building phase. Where possible,
a staged implementation should be adopted, i.e. during the site
development/construction phase, use geofabric and some soil and instant turf (lay
perpendicular to flow path) to provide erosion control and sediment trapping.
Following the building phase, temporary measures and sediments would be removed
and bioretention swale is revegetated in accordance with design planting schedule. It
is also possible to reuse the instant turf in the subsequent stages.
If these systems are not staged to be part of the sediment control system during
construction, it is advisable that stormwater flow during the site construction phases be
diverted around the bioretention swales to sediment controls system to avoid
smothering of planted vegetation by sediment loads from the construction site.
6.4.2.5 Traffic and Deliveries
Ensure traffic and deliveries do not access bioretention swales during construction.
Traffic can compact the filter media and cause preferential flow paths, deliveries (such
as sand or gravel) that can block filtration media is delivered onto the surface of the
bioretention filter media. Washdown wastes (e.g. concrete) can also cause blockage
of filtration media and damage vegetation. Bioretention areas should be fenced off
during building phase and controls implemented to avoid washdown wastes.
Management of traffic during the building phase is particularly important and poses
significant risks to the health of the vegetation and functionality of the bioretention
system. Measures such as those proposed above (e.g. staged implementation of final
landscape) should be considered.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-30
6.4.2.6 Sediment Build-up on Roads
Where flush kerbs are to be used, a set-down from the pavement surface to the
vegetation should be adopted. This allows a location for sediments to accumulate that
is off the pavement surface. Generally, a set down from kerb of 60mm to the top of
vegetation (if turf) is adequate. Therefore, total set down to the base soil is
approximately 100 mm (with approximately 40mm turf on top of base soil).
6.4.2.7 Inlet Erosion Checks
It is good practice to check the operation of inlet erosion protection measures following
the first few rainfall events. It is important to check for these early in the systems life,
to avoid continuing problems. Should problems occur in these events the erosion
protection should be enhanced.
6.4.2.8 Erosion Control
Immediately following earthworks it is good practice to revegetate all exposed surfaces
with sterile grasses (e.g. hydro-seed). These will stabilise soils, prevent weed
invasion yet not prevent future planting from establishing.
6.4.2.9 Timing for Planting
Timing of vegetation is dependent on a suitable time of year and potential irrigation
requirements, as well as timing in relation to the phases of development. For
example, temporary planting during construction for sediment control (e.g. with turf) is
removed and the bioretention system planted out with long term vegetation.
Alternatively, temporary planting (eg. turf or sterile grass) can be used until a suitable
season for appropriate long-term vegetation.
6.4.2.10 Weed Control
Conventional surface mulching of bioretention swales with organic material like
tanbark, should not be undertaken. Most organic mulch floats and runoff typically
causes this material to be washed away with the risk of blockage of drains occurring.
Weed management will need to be done manually until such time that the design
vegetation is established with sufficient density to effectively prevent weed
propagation.
6.4.2.11 Watering
Regular watering of bioretention swale vegetation is essential for successful
establishment and healthy growth. The frequency of watering to achieve successful
plant establishment is dependent upon rainfall, maturity of planting stock and the water
holding capacity of the soil. The following watering program is generally adequate but
should be adjusted (increased) to suit the site conditions:
Week 1-2 3 visits/ week
Week 3-6 2 visits/ week
Week 7-12 1 visit/ week
After this initial three month period, watering may still be required, particularly during
the first winter (dry period). Watering requirements to sustain healthy vegetation
should be determined during ongoing maintenance site visits.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-31
6.4.3 Construction checklist
BIORETENTION SWALE CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION CHECKLIST
Asset I.D. Inspected by:
Site: Date:
Time:
Constructed by: Weather:
Contact during site visit:
Items inspected
Checked Satisfactory
Items inspected
Checked Satisfactory
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION & ESTABLISHMENT
A. FUNCTIONAL INSTALLATION Structural components
Preliminary Works
15. Location and configuration of inflow
systems as designed
1. Erosion and sediment control plan adopted
16. Location and levels of overflow pits as
designed
2. Temporary traffic/safety control measures
17. Under-drainage connected to overflow
pits as designed
3. Location same as plans 18. Concrete and reinforcement as designed
4. Site protection from existing flows
19. Set down to correct level for flush kerbs
(streetscape applications only)
Earthworks and Filter Media 19. Kerb opening width as designed
5. Bed of swale correct shape and slope
6. Batter slopes as plans B. SEDIMENT & EROSION CONTROL (IF REQUIRED)
7. Dimensions of bioretention area as plans
20. Stabilisation immediately following
earthworks and planting of terrestrial
landscape around basin
8. Confirm surrounding soil type with design 21. Silt fences and traffic control in place
9. Confirm filter media specification in
accordance with Step 4
22. Temporary protection layers in place
9. Provision of liner (if required)
10. Under-drainage installed as designed C. OPERATIONAL ESTABLISHMENT
11. Drainage layer media as designed
23. Temporary protection layers and
associated silt removed
12. Transition layer media as designed (if
required)
Vegetation
14. Extended detention depth as designed
24. Planting as designed (species and
densities)
25. Weed removal and watering as required
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 6. Check for uneven settling of banks
2. Confirm structural element sizes 7. Under-drainage working
3. Check batter slopes 8. Inflow systems working
4. Vegetation as designed 9. Maintenance access provided
5. Bioretention filter media surface flat and free
of clogging
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED
1.
2.
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-32
6.4.4 Asset transfer checklist
BIORETENTION SWALE ASSET TRANSFER CHECKLIST
Asset I.D.:
Asset Location:
Construction by:
Defects and Liability Period:
TREATMENT Y N
System appears to be working as designed visually?
No obvious signs of under-performance?
MAINTENANCE Y N
Maintenance plans and indicative maintenance costs provided for each asset?
Vegetation establishment period completed (as per LGA requirements)?
Inspection and maintenance undertaken as per maintenance plan?
Inspection and maintenance forms provided?
ASSET INSPECTED FOR DEFECTS AND/OR MAINTENANCE ISSUES AT TIME OF ASSET TRANSFER
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter within swale?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures?
Traffic damage present?
Evidence of dumping (e.g. building waste)?
Vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds)?
Watering of vegetation required?
Replanting required?
Mowing/slashing required?
Clogging of drainage points (sediment or debris)?
Evidence of ponding?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Surface clogging visible?
Drainage system inspected?
COMMENTS/ACTIONS REQUIRED FOR ASSET TRANSFER
ASSET INFORMATION Y N
Design Assessment Checklist provided?
As constructed plans provided?
Copies of all required permits (both construction and operational) submitted?
Proprietary information provided (if applicable)?
Digital files (eg drawings, survey, models) provided?
Asset listed on asset register or database?
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-33
6.5 Maintenance Requirements
Bioretention swales have a flood conveyance role that needs to be maintained to
ensure adequate flood protection for local properties. In this regard, a key
maintenance requirement is ensuring that the shape of the swale is maintained and
that the swale is not subject to erosion or excessive deposition of debris that may
impede the passage of stormwater or increase its hydraulic roughness from that
assumed.
Vegetation plays a key role in maintaining the porosity of the soil media of the
bioretention system and a strong healthy growth of vegetation is critical to its
performance.
The most intensive period of maintenance is during the plant establishment period
(first two years) when weed removal and replanting may be required. It is also the time
when large loads of sediments could impact on plant growth, particularly in developing
catchments with an inadequate level of erosion and sediment control.
The potential for rilling and erosion down the swale component of the system needs to
be carefully monitored during establishment stages of the system. Other components
of the system that will require careful consideration are the inlet points (if the system
does not have distributed inflows) and surcharge pits, as these inlets can be prone to
scour and the buildup of litter and sediment. Bioretention swale field inlet pits also
require routine inspections to ensure structural integrity and that they are free of
blockages with debris. Debris removal is an ongoing maintenance requirement. Debris
can block inlets or outlets and can be unsightly, particularly in high visibility areas.
Inspection and removal of debris should be done regularly.
Typical maintenance of bioretention swale elements will involve:
Routine inspection of the swale profile to identify any areas of obvious
increased sediment deposition, scouring of the swale invert from storm flows,
rill erosion of the swale batters from lateral inflows, damage to the swale
profile from vehicles and clogging of the bioretention trench (evident by a
boggy swale invert).
Routine inspection of inlet points (if the swale does not have distributed
inflows), surcharge pits and field inlet pits to identify any areas of scour, litter
build up and blockages.
Removal of sediment where it is impeding the conveyance of the swale and/
or smothering the swale vegetation, and if necessary, reprofiling of the swale
and revegetating to original design specification.
Repairing any damage to the swale profile resulting from scour, rill erosion or
vehicle damage.
Tilling of the bioretention trench surface if there is evidence of clogging.
Clearing of blockages to inlet or outlets.
Regular watering/ irrigation of vegetation until plants are established and
actively growing (see section 6.4.2.11).
Mowing of turf or slashing of vegetation (if required) to preserve the optimal
design height for the vegetation.
Removal and management of invasive weeds.
Removal of plants that have died and replacement with plants of equivalent
size and species as detailed in the plant schedule.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-34
Pruning to remove dead or diseased vegetation material and to stimulate new
growth.
Litter and debris removal.
Vegetation pest monitoring and control.
Resetting (i.e. complete reconstruction) of bioretention elements will be required if the
available flow area of the overlying swale is reduced by 25 % (due to accumulation of
sediment) or if the bioretention trench fails to drain adequately after tilling of the
surface. Inspections are also recommended following large storm events to check for
scour.
All maintenance activities must be specified in a maintenance plan (and associated
maintenance inspection forms) to be developed as part of the design procedure.
Maintenance personnel and asset managers will use this plan to ensure the
bioretention swales continue to function as designed. The maintenance plans and
forms must address the following:
inspection frequency
maintenance frequency
data collection/ storage requirements (i.e. during inspections)
detailed cleanout procedures (main element of the plans) including:
equipment needs
maintenance techniques
occupational health and safety
public safety
environmental management considerations
disposal requirements (of material removed)
access issues
stakeholder notification requirements
data collection requirements (if any)
design details
An example operation and maintenance inspection form is included in the checking
tools provided in Section 6.5.1.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-35
6.5.1 Operation & Maintenance Inspection Form
The form below should be used whenever an inspection is conducted and kept as a
record on the asset condition and quantity of removed pollutants over time.
BIORETENTION SWALE MAINTENANCE CHECKLIST
Asset I.D.
Inspection Frequency: 1 to 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS Y N ACTION REQUIRED (DETAILS)
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter within swale?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures (eg crossovers)?
Traffic damage present?
Evidence of dumping (eg building waste)?
Vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Replanting required?
Mowing required?
Clogging of drainage points (sediment or debris)?
Evidence of ponding?
Set down from kerb still present?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Surface clogging visible?
Drainage system inspected?
Remulching of trees and shrubs required?
Soil additives or amendments required?
Pruning and/ or removal of dead or diseased vegetation required?
Resetting of system required?
COMMENTS
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-36
6.6 Bioretention swale worked
example
6.6.1 Worked Example Introduction
Modelling using MUSIC was undertaken in developing a stormwater quality treatment
system for a residential estate. This worked example describes the detailed design of
a grass swale and bioretention system located in a median separating an arterial road
and a local road within the residential estate. The layout of the catchment and
bioretention swale is shown in Figure 6.12. A photograph of a similar bioretention
swale in a median strip is shown in Figure 6.13 (although in that example the
vegetation cover of the swale and bioretention system is all grass).
Figure 6.12 Catchment area layout and section for worked example
Figure 6.13 Photograph of bioretention swale
6.6.1.1 Site Description
The site comprised of the arterial road and a service road separated by a median of
some 6m width. The median area offers the opportunity for a local treatment
Service Road
footpath
House lots
swale bioretention
30m
35m
13m
collector
service
verge
lot
4m
7m
Collector Road
Service Road
footpath
House lots
swale bioretention
3
collector
service
verge
lot
4m
7m
CELL A CELL B
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-37
measure. The area available is relatively large in relation to the catchment and is
elongated in shape. The catchment area for the swale and bioretention area includes
the road reserve and the adjoining allotment (of approximately 30m depth and with a
fraction impervious of 0.6).
Three crossings of the median are required and the raised access crossings can be
designed as the separation mounds between the swale and bioretention treatment
system, thus resulting in a two-cell system.
Each bioretention swale cell will treat its individual catchment area. Runoff from the
arterial road is conveyed by a conventional kerb and gutter system into a stormwater
pipe and discharged into the surface of the swale at the upstream end of each cell.
Runoff from the local street can enter the swale as distributed inflow (sheet flow) along
the length of the swale.
As runoff flows over the surface of the swale, it receives some pretreatment and
coarse to medium sized particles can be expected to be trapped by vegetation on the
swale surface. Stormwater inflow exceeding the filtration rate of the soil media in the
bioretention system will temporarily pond on the bioretention zone at the downstream
end of each cell. Filtered runoff is collected via a perforated pipe in the base of the
bioretention zone. Flows in excess of the capacity of the filtration medium overflow
into the piped drainage system at the downstream end of each bioretention cell.
Simulation using MUSIC found that the required area of bioretention system to meet a
desired target of 80% reduction in TSS and 45% reduction in TP and TN is
approximately 61 m
2
and 22 m
2
for Cell A and B respectively. The filtration medium
used is sandy loam with a notional saturated hydraulic conductivity of 180 mm/hr. The
required area of the filtration zone is distributed to the two cells according to their
catchment area.
6.6.1.2 Design Objectives
The design treatment objectives for the bioretention swale are as follows:-
To meet the desired target of 80%, 45% and 45% reductions of TSS, TP and
TN respectively
Sub-soil drainage pipe to be designed to ensure that the capacity of the pipe
exceeds the saturated infiltration capacity of the filtration media (both inlet and
flow capacity)
Design flows within up to 5-year ARI range are to be safely conveyed into a
piped drainage system without any inundation of the adjacent road.
The hydraulics for the swale need to be checked to confirm flow capacity for
the 5-year ARI peak flow.
The flow conditions are to attain acceptable safety and scouring behaviour for
100 year ARI peak flow.
6.6.1.3 Constraints and Concept Design Criteria
The constraints and design criteria are as follows:-
Depth of the bioretention filter layer shall be a maximum of 600mm
Maximum ponding depth (extended detention) allowable is 200mm
Width of median available for constructing the bioretention system is 6m
The filtration media available is a sandy loam with a saturated hydraulic
conductivity of 180mm/hour.
6.6.1.4 Site Characteristics
Key site characteristics are summarised as follows:-
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-38
Land use Urban, low density residential
Overland flow slopes Cell A and B =1.3%
Soil Clay
Catchment areas: Summarised in Table below
Allotments
Collector
road Local road Footpath Swale
Cell A 35m x 30m 35m x 7m 35m x 7m 35m x 4m 103m x 7.5m
Cell B 13m x 30m 13m x 7m 13m x 7m 13m x 4m 44m x 7.5m
Fraction impervious 0.60 (lots); 0.90 (roads); 0.50 (footpaths); 0.0 (Swale)
6.6.2 Step 1: Confirm Treatment Performance of Concept Design
Nominated bioretention areas for Cell A and Cell B are 61 m
2
and 22 m
2
respectively.
Interpretation of Figure 6.4 to Figure 6.6 with the input parameters below is used to
estimate the reduction performance of the bioretention system to ensure the design
will achieve target pollutant reductions.
200mm extended detention
treatment area to impervious area ratio:
Cell A - 61m
2
/ 1141 m
2
= 5.35%
Cell B - 22m
2
/ 423.8 m
2
= 5.19%
From the graphs, the expected pollutant reductions are 93%, 77% and 49% for TSS,
TP and TN respectively and exceed the design requirements of 80%, 45% and 45%.
6.6.3 Step 2: Estimate Design Flows for Swale Component
With a small catchment the Rational Method is considered an appropriate approach to
estimate the 5 and 100 year ARI peak flow rates. The steps in these calculations are
as follows:-
Time of concentration (t
c
)
Cell A and Cell B are effectively separate elements for the purpose of sizing the
swales for flow capacity and inlets to the piped drainage system for a 5 year ARI peak
flow event. Therefore, the t
c
are estimated separately for each cell.
Cell A the t
c
calculations include consideration of runoff from the allotments
as well as from gutter flow along the collector road. Comparison of these
travel times concluded the flow along the collector road was the longest and
was adopted for t
c
.
Cell B the t
c
calculations include overland flow across the lots and road and
swale/bioretention flow time.
The following t
c
values are estimated:
t
c
Cell A : 10 mins
t
c
Cell B: 8 mins
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-39
Design rainfall intensities
Adopted from IDF Chart for Singapore
Design ARI Cell A (10 min t
c
) Cell B (8 min t
c
)
5 166 mm/hr 173 mm/hr
100 275 mm/hr 283 mm/hr
Fraction impervious
Cell A: Area (m
2
) f
i
Impervious Area (m
2
)
Allotments
1050
0.6
630
Collector Road
245
0.9
220.5
Local Road
245
0.9
220.5
Footpath
140
0.5
70
Swale
773
0.0
0
TOTAL
1680
-
1141
Hence effective f
i
= 0.68
Cell B: Area (m
2
) f
i
Impervious Area (m
2
)
Allotments
390
0.6
234
Collector Road
91
0.9
81.9
Local Road
91
0.9
81.9
Footpath
52
0.5
26
Swale
330
0.0
0
TOTAL
624
-
423.8
Hence effective f
i
= 0.68
Runoff Coefficient
While the effective fraction impervious is 0.68, the runoff coefficients adopted were in
accordance to those for a densely built-up urban area, as outlined in Code of Practice
on Surface Water Drainage (Public Utilities Board 2006).
Design ARI Cell A Cell B
5 0.8 0.8
100 0.8 0.8
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-40
Design Flows
The design flows for the two cells, computed using the Rational Method (Q = 0.00278.
C.I.A) are summarised below:
Design ARI Cell A (m
3
/s) Cell B (m
3
/s)
5
0.06 0.02
100
0.10 0.04
6.6.4 Step 3: Dimensions of Swale
The swales need to be sized such that they can convey the 5 year ARI peak discharge
without water encroaching on the road. Mannings equation is used to compute the
discharge capacity of the swale.
In determining the dimensions of the swale, the depth of the swale were determined
by the requirement for it to enable allotment drainage to be discharged to the surface
of the swale. Given the cover requirements of the allotment drainage pipes as they
flow under the service road (600 mm minimum cover), it set the base of the
bioretention systems at 0.76m below road surface. The following are the
characteristics of the proposed swale:-
Base width of 1m with 1:3 side slopes, max depth of 0.76m
Grass vegetation mown to height of 0.1m (assume n = 0.045 for 5 year ARI
with flows above grass height)
1.3% longitudinal slope
The approach taken is to size the swale to accommodate flows in Cell A and then
adopt the same dimension for Cell B for aesthetic reasons (Cell B has lower flow
rates).
The maximum capacity of the swale (Q
cap
) is estimated adopting a 150mm freeboard
3
(i.e. maximum depth is 0.61m).
Q
cap
= 2.19 m
3
/s >> 0.10 m
3
/s
Therefore, there is adequate capacity given the relatively large dimensions of the
swale to accommodate allotment runoff connection.
With a base width of 1 m, the lengths of the bioretention system in Cells A and B will
need to be 61 m and 22 m respectively to attain the required areas to meet the water
quality objectives.
6.6.5 Step 4: Design of Swale Inlet
There are two mechanisms for flows to enter the system, firstly underground pipes
(either from the upstream collector road into Cell 1 or from allotment runoff) and
secondly direct runoff from road and footpaths.
Flush kerbs with a 60 mm set down are intended to be used to allow for sediment
accumulation from the road surfaces.
Grouted rock is to be used for scour protection for the pipe outlets into the system.
The intention of these is to reduce localised flow velocities to avoid erosion.
3
The Singapore Code of Practice for Surface Drainage would normally stipulate a freeboard of 15% of the depth of the
drain, ie. 0.15 x 760 = 110mm
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-41
6.6.6 Step 5: Design of bioretention component
6.6.6.1 Soil Media Specification
Three layers of soil media are to be used. A sandy loam filtration media (600mm), a
medium to coarse sand transition layer (100mm) and a gravel drainage layer
(200mm).
6.6.6.2 Filter Media Specifications
The filter media is to be a sandy loam with the following criteria (from FAWB 2007):
The material shall meet the geotechnical requirements set out below:
Hydraulic conductivity between 50-200 mm/hr
Particle sizes of between: clay 2 4 %, silt 4 8 %, sand < 85 %
Organic content between 3% and 10%
pH 5.5 7.5
6.6.6.3 Transition Layer Specifications
Transition layer material shall be coarse sand material. A typical particle size
distribution is provided below:
% passing 1.4 mm 100 %
1.0 mm 80 %
0.7 mm 44 %
0.5 mm 8.4 %
6.6.6.4 Drainage Layer Specifications
The drainage layer is to be 2 - 5 mm screenings.
6.6.6.5 Maximum Filtration Rate of Bioretention Media
The maximum filtration rate reaching the perforated pipe at the base of the soil media
is estimated by using the hydraulic conductivity of the media and the head above the
pipes and applying Darcys equation.
Saturated hydraulic conductivity = 180 mm/hr
Flow capacity of the filtration media = (1-) As k
h
d
d h
W L k Q
base
+
=
max
max
+
=
6 . 0
6 . 0 2 . 0
10 5
5
max base
W L Q
where:
k = hydraulic conductivity of the soil filter (m/s)
W
base
= base width of the filtration area (m) 1 m width adopted
L = length of the bioretention zone (m); 61 m (Cell A) and 22 m (Cell B)
h
max
= depth of pondage above the soil filter (m)
d = depth of filter media
Maximum filtration rate Cell A = 0.0041 m
3
/s
Maximum filtration rate Cell B = 0.0015 m
3
/s
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-42
6.6.6.6 Sizing of Slotted Collection Pipes
Estimate the inlet capacity of sub-surface drainage system (perforated pipe) to ensure
it is not a choke in the system. To build in conservatism, it is assumed that 50% of the
holes are blocked. A standard slotted pipe was selected that is widely available. To
estimate the flow rate an orifice equation is applied using the following parameters:
Assuming drainage layer is saturated, driving head is half the depth of the drainage
layer H = 0.1m
Assume sub-surface drains with half of all pipes blocked
Product specification Clear Opening = 2100 mm
2
/m
Assumed unblocked opening = 1050mm
2
/m
Slot Width = 1.5 mm
Slot Length = 7.5 mm
Diameter = 100 mm
Number of slots per metre = (1050)/(1.5x7.5) = 93.3
Assume orifice flow conditions Q = CA 2gh
C = 0.61 (Assume slot width acts as a sharp edged orifice).
Inlet capacity /m of pipe = [0.61x (0.0015 x 0.0075) x 2x9.81x0.1] x 93.3
= 0.0009 m
3
/s
Inlet capacity/m x total length =
Cell A = 0.0009 x 61 = 0.055 m
3
/s >> 0.0041 m
3
/s (max infiltration rate),
hence 61 m of pipe has sufficient perforation capacity to pass flows into the
perforated pipe.
Cell B = 0.0009 x 22 = 0.020 m
3
/s >> 0.0015 m
3
/s (max infiltration rate),
hence 22m of pipe is sufficient.
6.6.6.7 Slotted Pipe Capacity
The Colebrook-White equation is applied to estimate the flow rate in the perforated
pipe. A slope of 0.5%
4
is assumed and a 100mm perforated pipe (as above) was
used. Should the capacity not be sufficient, additional pipes would be required. The
capacity of this pipe needs to exceed the maximum filtration rate of the media.
Estimate applying the Colebrook-White Equation
Q = [-2(2gDS
f
)
0.5
log (k/3.7D + 2.51v/D(2gDS
f
)
0.5
)] x A
Adopt
D = pipe internal diameter (0.10m)
S
f
= slope (0.005m/m)
g = gravitational acceleration (9.81m
2
/s)
k = hydraulic roughness (0.007m)
v = velocity (1.007 x 10
-6
m/s)
Q
cap
= 0.01 m
3
/s
5
(for one pipe) > 0.004 m
3
/s (Cell 1); 0.001 m
3
/s (Cell 2), and hence 1
pipe is sufficient to convey the maximum infiltration rate for both Cell A and B.
4
A slope of 0.5% is adopted simply for convenience. In reality, the discharge capacity is reached when the soil is
saturated and water ponded to the full extended detention depth. Bioretention systems can operate equally effectively
with the underdrain laid at near-zero (but positive) slopes.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-43
Adopt 1 x 100 mm slotted pipe for the underdrainage system in both Cell A and Cell
B.
6.6.6.8 Drainage Layer Hydraulic Conductivity
Typically flexible perforated pipes are installed using fine gravel media to surround
them. In this case study, 2-5mm gravel is specified for the drainage layer. This media
is much coarser than the filtration media (sandy loam) therefore to reduce the risk of
washing the filtration layer into the perforated pipe, a transition layer is to be used.
This is to be 100 mm of coarse sand.
6.6.6.9 Impervious Liner Requirement
In this catchment the surrounding soils are clay to silty clays with a saturated hydraulic
conductivity of approximately 3.6 mm/hr. The sandy loam media that is proposed as
the filter media has a hydraulic conductivity of 50 - 200 mm/hr. Therefore the
conductivity of the filter media is > 10 times the conductivity of the surrounding soils
and an impervious liner is not required.
6.6.7 Step 6: Verification checks
6.6.7.1 Vegetation Scour Velocity Check
Assume Q
5
and Q
100
will be conveyed through the swale/bioretention system. Check
for scouring of the vegetation by checking that velocities are below 0.5m/s during Q
5
and 2.0 m/s for Q
100
.
Using Mannings equation to solve for depth for Q
5
and Q
100
gives the following
results:
Q
5
= 0.062 m
3
/s, depth = 0.12 (with n = 0.06), velocity = 0.38m/s < 0.5m/s
therefore, OK
Q
100
= 0.103 m
3
/s, depth = 0.14m (with n = 0.045), velocity = 0.52m/s <
2.0m/s therefore, OK
Hence, the swale and bioretention system can satisfactorily convey the peak 5 and
100-year ARI flood, with minimal risk of vegetation scour.
6.6.7.2 Safety Velocity Check
Check velocity depth product in Cell A during peak 100-year ARI flow for pedestrian
safety criteria.
V = 0.52m/s (calculated previously)
D = 0.14m
V.D = 0.52 x 0.14 = 0.07 < 0.6m
2
/s
Therefore, velocities and depths are OK.
6.6.8 Step 7: Overflow pit design
The overflow pits are required to convey 5 year ARI flows safely from above the
bioretention systems and into an underground pipe network. Grated pits are to be
used at the downstream end of each bioretention system.
There are standard pit sizes to accommodate connection to the underground
stormwater pipe. For a minimum underground pipe of 300 mm diameter, a 450 mm x
450 mm pit will be required for both Cell A and Cell B.
5
Per manufacturer data
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-44
To check the adequacy of this pit to convey the 5 year ARI peak discharge, two flow
conditions need to be check. The assumed water level above the crest of the pit is the
depth of water from the road surface, less freeboard and the extended detention (i.e.
0.76 (0.15 + 0.2) = 0.41m).
First check using a weir equation
Q
weir
= B.C.L.H
3/2
with B = 0.5, C = 1.7, L = 1.8 and H = 0.41
= 0.4 m
3
/s > 0.06 m
3
/s .OK
Now check for drowned conditions:
Q
orifice
= B.C.A 2gh with B = 0.5, C = 0.6, A = 0.20 and H = 0.41
= 0.17 m
3
/s > 0.06 m
3
/sOK
6.6.9 Step 8: Allowances to preclude traffic on swales
Traffic control is achieved by using traffic bollards.
6.6.10 Step 9: Vegetation specification
Consultation with the National Parks Board is required in determining the list of
suitable plant species for the proposed bioretention swale.
6.6.11 Step 10: Maintenance Plan
A maintenance plan for Swales 1 and 2 is to be prepared in accordance with the
requirements of the Public Utilities Board and the recommendations in Section 6.4.
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-45
6.6.12 Calculation summary
The sheet below summarises the results of the design calculations.
Bioretention Swales Bioretention Swales Bioretention Swales Bioretention Swales CALCULATION SUMMARY CALCULATION SUMMARY CALCULATION SUMMARY CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION TASK OUTCOME CHECK
1 11 1 Identify design criteria Identify design criteria Identify design criteria Identify design criteria
conveyance flow standard (ARI) 10 year
area of bioretention 61 and 22 m
2
maximum ponding depth 200 mm
Filter media type 180 mm/hr
2 22 2 Catchment characteristics Catchment characteristics Catchment characteristics Catchment characteristics
1680 m
2
624 m
2
slope 1.3 %
Fraction impervious Fraction impervious Fraction impervious Fraction impervious
Cell A 0.68
Cell B 0.68
3 33 3 Estimate design flow rates Estimate design flow rates Estimate design flow rates Estimate design flow rates
Time of concentration Time of concentration Time of concentration Time of concentration
estimate from flow path length and velocities Cell A - 10 minutes
Cell B - 8
Identify rainfall intensities Identify rainfall intensities Identify rainfall intensities Identify rainfall intensities
station used for IFD data: Singapore
major flood - 100 year ARI A - 275, B - 283 mm/hr
minor flood - 5 year ARI A - 166, B - 173 mm/hr
Peak design flows Peak design flows Peak design flows Peak design flows
Q
minor 0.06 (A), 0.02 (B) m
3
/s
Q
100 0.10 (A), 0.04 (B) m
3
/s
Q
infil
0.0041 (A)
0.0015 (B)
m
3
/s
3 33 3 Swale design Swale design Swale design Swale design
appropriate Manning's n used? yes
4 44 4 Inlet details Inlet details Inlet details Inlet details
adequate erosion and scour protection? rock pitching
5 55 5 Velocities over vegetation Velocities over vegetation Velocities over vegetation Velocities over vegetation
velocity for 5 year flow (<0.5m/s) 0.38 m/s
velocity for 100 year flow (<1.0m/s) 0.52 m/s
safety: Vel x Depth (<0.4) 0.07 m
2
/s
6 66 6 Slotted collection pipe capacity Slotted collection pipe capacity Slotted collection pipe capacity Slotted collection pipe capacity
pipe diameter 100 mm
number of pipes 1
pipe capacity 0.01 m
3
/s
capacity of perforations 0.055 (A); 0.020 (B) m
3
/s
soil media infiltration capacity 0.004, 0.001 m
3
/s
8 88 8 Overflow system Overflow system Overflow system Overflow system
system to convey minor floods
9 99 9 Surrounding soil check Surrounding soil check Surrounding soil check Surrounding soil check
soil hydraulic conductivity 3.6 mm/hr
filter media 180 mm/hr
MORE THAN 10 TIMES HIGHER THAN SOILS? yes
10 10 10 10 Filter media specification Filter media specification Filter media specification Filter media specification
filtration media sandy-loam
transition layer sand
drainage layer gravel
11 11 11 11 Plant selection Plant selection Plant selection Plant selection
turf
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-46
6.6.13 Construction drawings
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-47
Chapter 6 - Bioretention Swales
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 6-48
6.7 References
Barling, R. D., & Moore, I. D., 1993, The role of buffer strips in the management of
waterway pollution. Paper presented at the The role of buffer strips in the
management of waterway pollution from diffuse urban and rural sources, The
University of Melbourne
CRCCH (Cooperative Research Centre for Catchment Hydrology), 2003, Model for
Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC) User Guide, Version 2.0,
December
FAWB - Facility for Advancing Water Biofiltration (2007). Bioretention and Tree Pit
Media Specifications, http://www.monash.edu.au/fawb/products/.Update March 2007.
Engineers Australia, 2006, Australian Runoff Quality: A guide to Water Sensitive
Urban Design, Editor-in-Chief Wong, T H F, ISBN 0 85825 852 8, Engineers
Australia, Canberra, Australia, 2006
Institution of Engineers Australia 2001. Australian Rainfall and Runoff - A Guide to
Flood Estimation. Barton, ACT, Engineers Australia. Editor in Chief Pilgram, D.H.
Public Utilities Board (2006). Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage. Singapore.
50p.
Bioretention Basins
7
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
7
Chapter 7 Chapter 7 Chapter 7 Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins Bioretention Basins Bioretention Basins Bioretention Basins
7.1 Introduction 7-1
7.2 Key Design Configurations 7-2
7.2.1 Lined bioretention system 7-2
7.2.2 Unlined bioretention system 7-4
7.2.3 Unlined bio-infiltration system 7-5
7.3 Design Considerations for Bioretention Basins 7-6
7.3.1 Landscape Design 7-6
7.3.2 Hydraulic Design 7-6
7.3.3 Preventing Exfiltration to In-Situ Soils 7-7
7.3.4 Vegetation Specification 7-7
7.3.5 Bioretention Filter Media 7-7
7.3.6 Maintenance and Access 7-8
7.4 Design Process 7-9
7.4.1 Step 1: Confirm treatment treatment given in conceptual design 7-10
7.4.2 Step 2: Determine design flows 7-14
7.4.2.1 Design Flow 7-14
7.4.2.2 Design Flow Estimation 7-14
7.4.3 Step 3: Design Inflow System 7-14
7.4.3.1 Inlet Scour Protection 7-14
7.4.3.2 Coarse Sediment Forebay 7-15
7.4.3.3 Streetscape Applications 7-16
7.4.4 Step 4: Specify the bioretention media characteristics 7-16
7.4.4.1 Specify the Bioretention Filter Media Characteristics 7-16
7.4.5 Step 5: Under-drain design and capacity checks 7-19
7.4.5.1 Maximum filtration rate 7-19
7.4.5.2 Spacing of perforated pipes 7-20
7.4.5.3 Perforations inflow check 7-21
7.4.5.4 Perforated pipe capacity 7-21
7.4.6 Step 6: Check requirements for impermeable lining 7-22
7.4.7 Step 7: Size overflow pit 7-22
7.4.8 Step 8: Specify Vegetation 7-24
7.4.9 Step 9: Verification Checks 7-24
7.4.10 Design Calculation Summary 7-25
7.5 Checking Tools 7-26
7.5.1 Design Assessment Checklist 7-26
7.5.2 Construction Advice 7-26
7.5.2.1 Building Phase Damage 7-26
7.5.2.2 Traffic and Deliveries 7-26
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
7.5.2.3 Inlet Erosion Checks 7-28
7.5.2.4 Timing for Planting 7-28
7.5.2.5 Planting Strategy 7-28
7.5.2.6 Perforated Pipes 7-28
7.5.2.7 Inspection Openings 7-28
7.5.2.8 Clean Filter Media 7-28
7.5.2.9 Construction Inspection Checklist 7-28
7.5.3 Maintenance Requirements 7-30
7.5.3.1 Operation & Maintenance Inspection Form 7-30
7.6 Bioretention Basin Worked Example 7-32
7.6.1 Worked example introduction 7-32
7.6.2 Calculation Steps 7-34
7.6.3 Calculation summary 7-40
7.6.4 Construction drawings 7-41
7.7 References 7-42
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-1
7.1 Introduction
Bioretention basins use ponding above a bioretention surface to maximise the volume
of runoff treated through the filtration media. Their operation for treatment is in the
same way as for bioretention swales, but are predominantly detention systems with
flood flows bypassing the filtration surface or diverted into stormwater drains.
Bioretention basins operate by filtering stormwater runoff through densely planted
surface vegetation as a means of pre-treatment before they infiltrate/percolate through
a prescribed filter media. During percolation, pollutants are retained through fine
filtration, adsorption and some biological uptake. The vegetation in a bioretention
system is a vital functional element of the system both in terms of maintaining the
hydraulic conductivity of the filter media and the improving soil capacity for chemical
and biological removal of stormwater contaminants. Vegetation facilitates the
transport of oxygen to the soil and enhances soil microbial communities which
enhance biological transformation of pollutants.
Bioretention basins are generally not intended to be infiltration systems that
discharge from the filter media to surrounding in-situ soils. Rather, the typical design
intent is to recover stormwater at the base of the filter media in perforated under-
drains and discharge to receiving waterways or to storages for potential reuse. In
some circumstances however, where the in-situ soils allow and there is a particular
design intention to recharge local groundwater, it may be desirable to allow
stormwater to infiltrate from the base of a filter media to underlying in-situ soils.
Bioretention basins can be installed at various scales, ranging from planter boxes, to
streetscape raingardens integrated with traffic calming measures, to system contained
within retarding basins. In larger applications, it is considered good practice to have
pretreatment measures upstream of the basin to reduce the maintenance frequency of
the bioretention basin. For small system this is not required. Example applications
are given in Figure 7.1
This chapter describes the design, construction and maintenance of a bioretention
basins.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-2
Figure 7.1 Examples of bioretention basin integrated into a local
streetscape(R) and a car park (L)
7.2 Key Design Configurations
There are many possible design variations for bioretention systems and these may be
grouped into five core design configurations. The features of each of these
configurations are described below.
It is strongly recommended that bioretention systems which include submerged zones
should be used wherever possible. It has been shown that the treatment performance
of bioretention systems is significantly reduced after extended dry periods. The
presence of a submerged, permanent pool of water at the bottom of the systems acts
as a buffer against drying and helps maintain a healthy plant community throughout
long dry spells.
Illustrations in this section are for demonstration purposes only. Outlet structures may
be any combination of raised pits or more complex outflow structures as described in
chapter 7.4 Design Process.
7.2.1 Lined bioretention system
A standard lined bioretention system (Figure 7.2) prevents exfiltration and minimizes
losses through the system. This type of bioretention basin is optimal in the following
situations.
- Sites where exfiltration is not possible. This may arise where there is a
need to protect built infrastructure or whereby interactions with shallow
groundwater is undesirable.
- Climates that do not experience long dry spells.
- If systems are designed for NO
x
removal or if receiving waters are highly
sensitive to Cu or ZN.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-3
Figure 7.2 Lined standard bioretention system [source: FAWB, 2009]
A lined bioretention system may also be designed to include a submerged zone with
the submerged zone comprising of sand (Figure 7.3) or gravel. This type of
bioretention basin should be used for the following situations;
- Sites where exfiltration is not possible. This may arise where there is a
need to protect built infrastructure or whereby interactions with shallow
groundwater is undesirable.
- Climates that have very long dry spells. The submerged zone is able to
act as a water source for up to five weeks, supporting the plants and
microbial community.
- If systems are designed for NO
x
removal or if receiving waters are highly
sensitive to Cu or ZN.
Figure 7.3 Lined bioretention system with submerged zone comprised of
sand [source: FAWB, 2009]
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-4
7.2.2 Unlined bioretention system
A standard unlined bioretention system (Figure 7.4) is the simplest configuration of
bioretention system to design and build. These systems are suited for
- Sites where minimal infiltration is allowed. (The hydraulic conductivity of
the surrounding soils should be an order of magnitude lower than the filter
media to ensure minimal infiltration.
- Climates that do not experience long dry spells.
- Systems that are not designed for stormwater harvesting.
Figure 7.4 Unlined standard bioretention system [source: FAWB, 2009]
Unlined bioretention systems may also include a submerged zone (Figure 7.5). The
addition of a submerged zone is appropriate whereby exfiltration is permissible and
the local climate yields long dry spells. These systems have unlined sides, however
the submerged zone must be lined to maintain saturation.
Figure 7.5 Unlined bioretention system with submerged zone [source: FAWB,
2009]
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-5
7.2.3 Unlined bio-infiltration system
An unlined bioretention system is a hybrid system, combining a standard bioretention
system and an infiltration system, which is also referred to as a bio-infiltration system.
Unlined bioretention systems are recommended for;
- Sites where exfiltration is allowed
- Whereby both water quality improvements and runoff reduction is
required.
- Systems that are not designed for stormwater harvesting.
Unlined bioretention systems do not contain collection pipes in the drainage layer.
Where possible, unlined bioretention systems are preferable to standard, non
vegetated infiltration systems due to the increased nutrient removal and are therefore
highly recommended whereby appropriate.
Figure 7.6 A hybrid bioretention and infiltration system [source: FAWB, 2009]
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-6
7.3 Design Considerations for
Bioretention Basins
A typical design for a bioretention basin is given in Figure 7.7. Key to the design is the
hydraulic operation, the filter media, the vegetation and the interaction of the basin
within the urban space. These design considerations are discussed further in the
following sections. Design considerations are similar to that presented in Chapter 6
Bioretention Swales and are presented in both chapters for ease of reference.
Figure 7.7 Typical cross section of a bioretention basin
7.3.1 Landscape Design
Bioretention basins, sometimes referred to as bioretention pods and rain gardens, may
be located within parkland areas, easements, carparks or along roadway corridors as
standalone soil filtration systems. Landscape design of bioretention basins along the
road edge can assist in defining traffic islands and intersections as well as providing
landscape character and amenity. It is therefore important that the landscape design
of bioretention basins addresses stormwater quality objectives and accommodates
these other important landscape functions.
7.3.2 Hydraulic Design
The hydraulic design of bioretention basins is directed at ensuring effective stormwater
treatment performance; minimize damage by storm flows, and to protect the hydraulic
integrity and function of associated minor and major drainage systems. The following
aspects are of key importance:
The finished surface of the bioretention filter media must be horizontal (i.e.
flat) to ensure full engagement of the filter media by stormwater flows and to
prevent concentration of stormwater flows within depressions.
Temporary ponding or extended detention, typically of up to 0.3m depth over
the surface of the soil filter media created through the use of raised inlet pits
(overflow pits) can assist in increasing the overall volume of stormwater runoff
that can be treated by the bioretention filter media.
Where possible, the overflow pit or bypass pathway should be located near
the inflow zone to prevent high flows passing over the surface of the filter
1:4 max
Filter Media
Mass Planting
ground cover vegetation
Perforated under drain
(100mm dia 0.5% slope)
Outlet pipe
connected to
stormwater
drainage
Impervious Liner (if required)
Overflow pit
0.1m Transition Layer (if required)
0.30m Extended Detention Depth
0.3 1.0m
0.2m Drainage Layer
Filter Media
Typical Depths
Not to scale. Not for use
as design drawing
standard.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-7
media. If this is not possible, then velocities during the minor (5 year ARI) and
major (50-100 year ARI) floods should be maintained sufficiently low
(preferably below values of 0.5 m/s and not more than 2.0 m/s for major flood)
to avoid scouring of the filter media and vegetation.
Where the inlet to a bioretention system is required to convey the minor storm
flow (i.e. is part of the minor drainage system), the inlet must be designed to
avoid blockage, flow conveyance and public safety issues.
For streetscape applications, the design of the inflow to the bioretention basin
must ensure the kerb and channel flow requirements are preserved.
7.3.3 Preventing Exfiltration to In-Situ Soils
Bioretention basins can be designed to generally preclude exfiltration of treated
stormwater to the surrounding in-situ soils. The amount of water potentially lost from
bioretention trenches to surrounding in-situ soils is largely dependent on the
characteristics of the surrounding soils and the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the
bioretention filter media (see Section 7.3.5).
If the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the filter media is one to two orders of
magnitude (i.e. 10 to 100 times) greater than that of the insitu soil, the flow path of
stormwater percolation will be effectively contained within the bioretention filter media
and through to the drainage layer. As such, there will be little exfiltration to the
surrounding soils.
If the selected saturated hydraulic conductivity of the bioretention filter media is less
than 10 times that of the surrounding soils, it may be necessary to provide an
impermeable liner. Flexible membranes or a concrete casting are commonly used to
prevent excessive exfiltration.
A subsurface pipe is often used to prevent water intrusion into a road sub-base. This
practice is to continue as a precautionary measure to collect any water seepage from
bioretention swales located along roadways.
7.3.4 Vegetation Specification
Vegetation is a key component of a bioretention basin, servicing the following
processes:
Scour protection
Maintaining the porosity of filtration layer
Enhancing pollutant adsorption to biofilms in roots within the filter media
Generally, the greater the density and height of vegetation planted in a bioretention
basin the better will be the treatment especially when extended detention is provided
in the design. When the extended detention is engaged, the contact between
stormwater and vegetation results in enhanced sedimentation of suspended
sediments and some adsorption of associated pollutants.
Bioretention basins should be planted to cover the whole bioretention filter media
surface. Vegetation should be of sufficient density to prevent preferred flow paths,
scour and re-suspension of deposited sediments. Turf grasses should ideally be
avoided as these are shallow rooted systems with inadequate penetration to the full
depth of the filter media and the turf stems inadequately prevent clogging at the
surface of the filter media.
The National Parks Board of Singapore should be consulted in determining suitable
plantings for bioretention basins in Singapore.
7.3.5 Bioretention Filter Media
Selection of an appropriate bioretention filter media is a key design step that involves
consideration of the following three inter-related factors:
Saturated hydraulic conductivity of the filter media.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-8
Depth of extended detention provided above the filter media.
Suitability as a growing media to support vegetation (i.e. retains sufficient soil
moisture and organic content).
The high rainfall intensities experienced in Singapore is expected to result in
bioretention treatment areas being larger in Singapore than comparable systems
overseas in Australia and the United States. The area available for bioretention
basins in an urban layout is often constrained by factors such as the available area
within the footpaths of standard road reserves.
Selecting bioretention filter media for bioretention basin applications in Singapore will
often require careful consideration of saturated hydraulic conductivity and extended
detention depth to ensure the desired minimum volume of stormwater runoff receives
treatment. This must also be balanced with the requirement to also ensure the
saturated hydraulic conductivity does not become too high such that it can no longer
sustain healthy vegetation growth.
The maximum saturated hydraulic conductivity should not exceed 500 mm/hr (and
preferably be between 50 - 200 mm/hr) in order to sustain vegetation growth.
The concept design stage will have established the optimal combination of filter media
saturated hydraulic conductivity and extended detention depth using a continuous
simulation modeling approach (i.e. MUSIC). Any adjustment of either of these two
design parameters during the detailed design stage will require the continuous
simulation modeling to be re-run to assess the impact on the overall treatment
performance of the bioretention basin.
As shown in Figure 7.7, a bioretention system can consist of three layers. The filter
media is the primary soil layer consisting typically of sandy-loam material. In addition
to the filter media, a drainage layer is also required to convey treated water from the
base of the filter media to the outlet via a perforated under-drains, unless the design
intent is to allow the filtered water to discharge (exfiltrate) into insitu soil. The drainage
layer surrounds perforated under-drains and consists typically of fine gravel of 2-5 mm
particle size. In between the filter media layer and the drainage layer is the transition
layer consisting of clean sand (1mm) to prevent migration of the base filter media into
the drainage layer and into the perforated under-drains.
[Refer to the Bioretention Media Guidelines produced by FAWB
1
(2007) for more
information.]
7.3.6 Maintenance and Access
The performance of a bioretention system will be affected by impeded flow. Driving
over or storing construction material on the bioretention basin can cause the filter
media to become impacted (compacted) and the vegetation damaged. The design of
a bioretention system should consider means of preventing or discouraging the
bioretention basin as becoming a trafficable and/or storage area.
1
Facility for Advancing Water Biofiltration http://www.monash.edu.au/fawb/
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-9
7.4 Design Process
The following sections detail the design steps required for bioretention basins. Key
design steps following the site planning and concept development stages are:
1. Confirm treatment performance of concept design
2. Determine design flows
3. Design inflow systems
a. Inlet scour protection
b. Coarse sediment forebay
c. Streetscape bioretention application
4. Specify the bioretention filter media characteristics
a. Filter media
b. Drainage layer
c. Transition layer
5. Design under-drain and undertake capacity checks
6. Check requirement for impermeable lining
7. Size overflow pit
9. Undertake verification checks
a. Vegetation scour velocity check
b. Confirm treatment performance
8. Specify vegetation
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-10
7.4.1 Step 1: Confirm treatment size given in conceptual design
A conceptual design of a bioretention basin is normally typically undertaken prior to
detailed design. The performance of the concept design must be checked to ensure
that stormwater treatment objectives will be satisfied.
The treatment performance curves shown in Figure 7.3 to Figure 7.reflect the
treatment performance of the bioretention basin. The performance curves provide an
indication only of appropriate sizing and do not substitute the need for a thorough
conceptual design process. Nevertheless it is a useful visual guide to illustrate the
relationship of bioretention treatment performance to the ratio of bioretention treatment
area and contributing catchment area. The curves allow the designer to make a rapid
assessment as to whether the bioretention basin size falls within the optimal size
range.
The curves in Figure 7.8 to Figure 7.10 show the total suspended solid (TSS), total
phosphorus (TP) and total nitrogen (TN) removal performance for a typical
bioretention basin design with the following configurations:
Filter media saturated hydraulic conductivity (k) = 180 mm/hr and 360mm/hr or
0.5 x 10
-4
m/s and 1 x 10
-4
m/s
Filter Media average particle size = 0.5mm
Filter Media Depth = 0.6m
Extended Detention Depth = from 0 mm to 300 mm
The curves in Figure 7.8 toFigure 7.Figure 7.10 are generally applicable to
bioretention basin applications within residential, industrial and commercial land uses.
If the characteristics of the bioretention component of the bioretention swale concept
design are significantly different to that described above, then the curves in Figure 7.8
to Figure 7.10 may not provide an accurate indication of treatment performance. In
these cases, the detailed designer should use MUSIC to verify the performance of the
bioretention swale.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-11
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urface Area ( as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
S
S
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
= 360mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
B ioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area ( as % of Impervious C atc hment)
T
S
S
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 7.8 Bioretention system TSS removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-12
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
B ioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atc hment)
T
P
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
=360mm/hr
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
P
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 7.9 Bioretention system TP removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-13
k
s at
=180mm/hr
0%
5%
10%
15%
20%
25%
30%
35%
40%
45%
50%
55%
60%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tems S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
N
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
k
s at
=360mm/h
0%
5%
10%
15%
20%
25%
30%
35%
40%
45%
50%
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Bioretention S ys tem S urfac e Area (as % of Impervious C atchment)
T
N
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
No E xtended Detention
100mm E xtended Detention
200mm E xtended Detention
300mm E xtended Detention
Figure 7.10 Bioretention system TN removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-14
7.4.2 Step 2: Determine design flows
7.4.2.1 Design Flow
Two design flows are required for bioretention basins:
Minor (frequent) storm conditions (typically 5 year ARI) to size the overflows to
allow minor floods to be safely conveyed and not increase any flooding risk
compared to conventional stormwater systems
Major flood conditions (typically 100 year ARI) to check that flow velocities are
not too large in the bioretention system, which could potentially scour
pollutants or damage vegetation
7.4.2.2 Design Flow Estimation
A range of hydrologic methods can be applied to estimate design flows. With typical
catchment areas being relatively small, the Rational Method Design Procedure is
considered to be a suitable method for estimating design flows.
7.4.3 Step 3: Design Inflow System
The design of the inflow systems to bioretention basins needs to consider a number of
functions:
Scour protection In most bioretention applications stormwater flows will enter
the bioretention basin as concentrated flow (piped, channel or open channel)
and as such is it important to slow and spread flows using appropriate scour
(rock) protection.
Coarse sediment forebay Where stormwater runoff from the catchment is
delivered directly to the bioretention basin without any coarse sediment
management (through vegetated swale or buffer treatment) a coarse sediment
forebay is to be included in the design. The forebay is to remove coarse
sediment from stormwater to minimise the risk of sediment smothering the
vegetation in the bioretention basin.
Street hydraulics (streetscape applications only) In streetscape applications,
where stormwater is delivered directly from the kerb and channel to the
bioretention basin, it is important to ensure the location and width of the kerb
opening is designed such that flows enter the bioretention basin without
adversely affecting trafficability of the road.
Each of these functions and the appropriate design responses are described in the
following sections.
7.4.3.1 Inlet Scour Protection
Erosion protection should be provided for concentrated inflows to a bioretention basin.
Typically, flows will enter the bioretention basin from either a surface flow system (i.e.
roadside kerb, open channel) or a piped drainage system. Rock beaching is a simple
method for dissipating the energy of concentrated inflow. Where the bioretention
basin is receiving stormwater flows from a piped system (i.e. from larger catchments),
the use of impact type energy dissipation may be required to prevent scour of the filter
media. In most cases this can be achieved with rock protection and by placing several
large rocks in the flow path to reduce velocities and spread flows as depicted in Figure
7.11 (with the D representing the pipe diameter dimension). The rocks can form part
of the landscape design of the bioretention component.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-15
D
4D
D D
0.3D
0
.
7
5
D
1
4
150mm rock spalls rolled into
aggregate sub-base underlain
by geofabric
D
Voids to be planted with
rush/reed species (subject to
landscape design)
DD
4D
DD DD
0.3D
0
.
7
5
D
1
4
150mm rock spalls rolled into
aggregate sub-base underlain
by geofabric
DD
Voids to be planted with
rush/reed species (subject to
landscape design)
Figure 7.11 Typical Inlet Scour Protection Detail for Bioretention Basins
Receiving Piped Flows
7.4.3.2 Coarse Sediment Forebay
Coarse sediment may accumulate near the basin inflow where stormwater runoff from
the catchment is delivered directly to the bioretention basin without pre-treatment
(through vegetated swale or buffer treatment). To mitigate these effects, it is
recommended that a coarse sediment forebay be incorporated into the design of a
bioretention basin. The forebay should be designed to:
- Remove particles that are 1mm or greater in diameter from the 3 month ARI
storm event.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-16
- Provide appropriate storage for coarse sediment to ensure desilting is required
once every year.
The area of the sediment forebay (A
s
) is calculated by solving the following expression
(modified version of Fair and Geyer (1954)):
n
S
s
Q/A
v
n
R
-
1
1 1
(
+ =
Equation 7.1
Where
R = fraction of target sediment removed (adopt 80% or higher)
v
s
= settling velocity of target sediment (100 mm/s or 0.1 m/s for 1 mm particle)
Q = Design flow (3 month ARI peak discharge in the absence of any
hydrological information for Singapore, this discharge may be estimated as
corresponding to 50% of the 1 year ARI peak discharge (Engineers
Australia, 2006)
n = turbulence or short-circuiting parameter (adopt 0.5)
A
s
= The area of the sediment forebay
A catchment sediment loading rate (L
o
) of 3m
3
/ha/year for developed catchments in
Singapore may be used to estimate the total sediment loads entering the basin (see
Chapter 4 Sedimentation Basin). This volume represents the full range of sediment
sizes. In the absence of local sediment particle size distribution, it is not possible to
accurately estimate the volume captured at the forebay. A conservative approach is to
multiply the capture efficiency (R) by the sediment load estimated applying the
catchment loading rate (L
o
).
The coarse sediment forebays will contain large rocks for energy dissipation and be
underlain by filter material to promote drainage following storm events. The depth of
the forebay should not be greater than 0.3m below the surface of the filter media.
7.4.3.3 Streetscape Applications
As bioretention pods are not continuous systems, streetscape applications need to
carefully consider the locations of inlets to the bioretention pods so as not to increase
the width of channel flow along the street leading to the inflow to these systems.
7.4.4 Step 4: Specify the bioretention media characteristics
7.4.4.1 Specify the Bioretention Filter Media Characteristics
Generally three types of media are required in the bioretention component of
bioretention swales (refer Figure 7.1 and Figure 7.7).
Filter Media
The filter media layer provides the majority of the pollutant treatment
function, through fine filtration and also by supporting vegetation. The
vegetation enhances filtration, keeps the filter media porous, provides
substrate for biofilm formation that is important for the uptake and removal of
nutrients and other stormwater pollutants. As a minimum, the filter media is
required to have sufficient depth to support vegetation. Typical depths are
between 600-1000 mm with a minimum depth of 400mm accepted in depth
constrained situations. It is important to note that if deep rooted plants such
as trees are to be planted in bioretention swales, the filter media must have a
minimum depth of 800 mm to provide sufficient plant anchoring depth.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-17
Saturated hydraulic conductivity should remain between 50-200 mm/hr (and
should not be greater than 500 mm/hr. The following procedure is
recommended in determine the appropriate soil filter media to match the
design saturated hydraulic conductivity:
Identify available sources of a suitable base soil (i.e. topsoil) capable of
supporting vegetation growth such as a sandy loam or sandy clay loam.
In-situ topsoil should be considered first before importing soil. Any soil
found to contain high levels of salt (see last bullet point), extremely low
levels of organic carbon (< 3%), or other extremes considered retardant
to plant growth and microbial activity should be rejected. The base soil
must also be structurally sound and not prone to structural collapse as
this can result in a significant reduction in saturated hydraulic
conductivity. The risk of structural collapse can be reduced by ensuring
the soil has a well graded particle size distribution with a combined clay
and silt fraction of < 12%.
Using laboratory analysis, determine the saturated hydraulic conductivity
of the base soil using standard testing procedures. (In Australia,
reference is made to AS 4419-2003 Appendix H Soil Permeability). A
minimum of five samples of the base soil should be tested. Any
occurrence of structural collapse during laboratory testing must be noted
and an alternative base soil sourced.
To amend the base soil to achieve the desired design saturated
hydraulic conductivity either mix in a loose non-angular sand (to increase
saturated hydraulic conductivity) or conversely a loose loam (to reduce
saturated hydraulic conductivity).
The required content of sand or clay (by weight) to be mixed to the base
soil will need to be established in the laboratory by incrementally
increasing the content of sand or clay until the desired saturated
hydraulic conductivity is achieved. The sand or clay content (by weight)
that achieves the desired saturated hydraulic conductivity should then be
adopted on-site. A minimum of five samples of the selected base soil
and sand (or clay) content mix must be tested in the laboratory to ensure
saturated hydraulic conductivity is consistent across all samples. If the
average saturated hydraulic conductivity of the final filter media mix is
within 20% of the design saturated hydraulic conductivity then the filter
media can be adopted and installed in the bioretention system.
Otherwise, further amendment of the filter media must occur through the
addition of sand (or clay) and retested until the design saturated
hydraulic conductivity is achieved.
The base soil must have sufficient organic content to establish
vegetation on the surface of the bioretention system. If the proportion of
base soil in the final mix is less than 3%, it may be necessary to add
organic material. This should not result in more than 10% organic
content and should not alter the saturated hydraulic conductivity of the
final filter media mix.
The pH of the final filter media is to be amended (if required) to between
5.5 and 7.5. If the filter media mix is being prepared off-site, this
amendment should be undertaken before delivery to the site.
The salt content of the final filter media (as measured by EC1:5) must be
less than 0.63 dS/m for low clay content soils like sandy loam. (EC1:5 is
the electrical conductivity of a 1:5 soil/ water suspension).
Testing of this soil property should be undertaken prior to their
placement during construction. It should also be noted that soil hydraulic
conductivity will vary after placement and is expected to initially
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-18
decrease due to hydraulic compaction during operation. With maturity of
plant growth, the soil hydraulic conductivty canbe expected to recover to
asymptote to an equilibrium level comparable to its original value.
FAWBs Guidelines for Filter Media in Biofiltration Systems, Appendix C,
Version 3.01 2009 provides the most recent criteria with which to select a
suitable filter media.
Transition Layer
The particle size difference between the filter media and the underlying
drainage layer should be not more than one order of magnitude to avoid the
filter media being washed through the voids of the drainage layer. Therefore,
with fine gravels being used for the drainage layer (which will be at least two
orders of magnitude coarser than the likely average particle size of the filter
media), a transition layer is recommended to prevent the filter media from
washing into the perforated pipes. The material for the transition layer is
sand/coarse sand. An example particle size distribution (% passing) is
provided below (typical specification only):
1.4 mm 100 %
1.0 mm 80 %
0.7 mm 44 %
0.5 mm 8.4 %
The transition layer is recommended to be 100 mm thick.
The addition of a transition layer increases the overall depth of the
bioretention system and may be an important consideration for some sites
where total depth of the bioretention system may be constrained. In such
cases, two options are available to reduce the overall depth of the system,
ie.
the use of a sand drainage layer and/or perforated pipes with smaller
slot sized may need to be considered.
use a geotextile layer with a mesh size specified to be between 0.7
to 1mm. (This option should be an option of last resort as the risk of
installing inappropriate liner is high).
Drainage Layer
The drainage layer is used to convey treated flows to the outlet via a
perforated under-drainage system. The composition of the drainage layer is
to be considered in conjunction with the selection and design of the
perforated under-drainage system (refer to Section 7.4.5) as the slot sizes in
the perforated pipes may determine the minimum drainage layer particle size
to avoid washout of the drainage layer into the perforated pipe system.
Gravel is the preferred media for the drainage layer to match with the typical
slot size of typical perforated or slotted under-drains.
However, there may be circumstances where site conditions constraint the
depth of the bioretention system. In such cases, it may be possible to use
sand as the drainage layer media to avoid having to provide a transition layer
between the filter media and the drainage layer. The drainage layer is to be
a minimum of 200 mm thick and it is advisable that the drainage media is
washed prior to placement in bioretention system to remove any fines.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-19
Submerged Zone
The submerged zone should be comprised of a mix of medium to coarse
sand and carbon, or a mix of fine gravel and carbon. The carbon source
should be a mix of 5% mulch and 5% hardwood chips, by volume.
A depth of 450mm has been shown to be optimal (Zinger et al., 2007),
however the feasibility of this will be determined by site conditions. A
minimum of 300mm is required for this zone to be effective. A submerged
zone of 300mm will protect against drying for up to five weeks of continuous
null inflow. In climates where dry periods are likely to exceed five weeks, the
submerged zone should be increased in depth bby 120mm for every
additional week of expected zero inflows. It is also important to note that a
50mm transition layer should separate the filter media and submerged zone.
This will prevent the leaching of pollutant and nutrients by ensuring that the
filter media does not become permanently saturated.
7.4.5 Step 5: Under-drain design and capacity checks
The slotted collection pipes at the base of bioretention filter media collect treated water
for conveyance downstream. The collection pipes are sized to ensure flow through
the filter media is not choked (or impeded) by the collection system.
The recommended maximum diameter of the perforated pipes is 100 mm to minimise
the required thickness of the drainage layer. Either flexible perforated pipe (e.g.
agricultural pipe) or slotted PVC pipes can be used, however care needs to be taken
to ensure that the slots in the pipes are not too large that sediment would freely flow
into the pipes from the drainage layer.
To ensure slotted or perforated pipes are of adequate size, several checks are
required:
Ensure the perforations are adequate to pass the maximum filtration rate of
the media
Ensure the pipe itself has sufficient capacity to convey the design flow (ie. the
maximum filtration rate multiplied by the surface area).
Ensure that the material in the drainage layer will not be washed into the
perforated pipes.
7.4.5.1 Maximum filtration rate
The maximum filtration rate represents the design flow for the underdrainage system
(i.e. the slotted pipes at the base of the filter media). The capacity of the underdrains
needs to be greater than the maximum filtration rate to ensure the filter media drains
freely and does not choke the system.
A maximum infiltration rate (Q
max
) can be estimated by applying Darcys equation:
d
d h
W L k Q
base b
+
=
max
max
Equation 7.2
Where
k = hydraulic conductivity of the soil filter (m/hr)
W
base
= average width of the ponded cross section above the soil filter (m)
L
b
= length of the bioretention zone (m)
h
max
= depth of pondage above the sand filter (m)
d = depth of filter media (m)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-20
There are two possible configurations for an underdrain in a bioretention
system with a submerged zone:
1. Perforated collection pipe with riser outlet
In this configuration, the collection pipe(s) is placed in the drainage layer with
an elbow to create a riser outlet to raise the invert. The collection pipe(s) does
not need to be sloped as the outlet is elevated. Slotted PVC pipes are
preferable to flexible perforated ag-pipe, as they are easier to clean and ribbed
pipes are likely to retain moisture which may attract plant roots into pipes,
however this necessitates a drainage layer to ensure that finer material from
the filter media and transition layers are not washed into the collection pipe(s).
The upstream end of the collection pipe should extend to the surface to allow
inspection and maintenance; the vertical section(s) of the pipe should be
unperforated and capped. Where more than one collection pipe is required,
these should be spaced no further than 1.5 m apart.
The following need to be checked:
a) Perforations in pipe are adequate to pass the maximum infiltration rate.
b) Pipe has sufficient capacity to convey the treated water; this
component should be oversized to ensure it does not become a choke
in the system.
c) Material in the drainage layer will not wash into the perforated pipes.
2. Riser outlet only (no perforated pipe)
A collection pipe is not strictly necessary in a bioretention system with a
submerged zone; inclusion of a riser outlet confines exit flow to be via this path
and the drainage layer can act as a surrogate drainage layer transition layer filter
media perforated pipe inspection well (unperforated pipe) sand + carbon OR gravel +
carbon 51 collection pipe. The riser outlet should extend to the surface to allow
inspection and maintenance.
The following need to be checked:
a) Pipe has sufficient capacity to convey the treated water; this
component should be oversized to ensure it does not become a choke
in the system.
b) Material in the drainage layer will not wash into the riser outlet.
7.4.5.2 Spacing of perforated pipes
Spacing of perforated pipes should be sufficiently close together to ensure effective
drainage of the bioretention system. With a smaller aspect ratio associated with
bioretention basins compared with bioretention swales, the maximum spacing of the
perforated pipes can be increased to 2.5 3 m, especially for large bioretention basins
(> 100 m
2
).
Where possible the perforated pipes are to grade at a minimum of 0.5% towards the
overflow pit to ensure effective drainage. A slope of 0.5% is adopted simply for
convenience. In reality, the discharge capacity of the perforated pipe is not dependent
on this slope since maximum discharge condition is reached when the soil is saturated
and water ponded to the full extended detention depth. Bioretention systems can
operate equally effectively with the underdrain laid at near-zero (but positive) slope.
Grading the base of the bioretention system towards the pit and placing the perforated
pipes (and the drainage layer) on this grade is a recommended approach to ensuring
that the pipes are laid on a positive slope.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-21
Perforated pipes should not use a geofabric wrapping, as this is a potential location for
blockage and would require a complete resetting of the bioretention system. Where
perforated pipes are supplied with geofabric wrapping, it is to be removed before
installation.
7.4.5.3 Perforations inflow check
To ensure the perforated under-drainage system has sufficient capacity to collect and
convey the maximum filtration rate, it is necessary to determine the capacity for flows
to enter the under-drainage system via the perforations in the pipes. If the capacity of
the drainage system is unable to collect the maximum filtration rate additional under-
drains will be required.
To calculate the flow through the perforations, orifice flow can be assumed and the
sharp edged orifice equation used as given in the following equation.
h g Ao C B Q
d perf
= 2
Equation 7.3
Where
Q
perf
= Flow rate through perforations (m
3
/s)
B = Blockage factor (= 0.5)
C
d
= Orifice discharge coefficient (= 0.6)
A
o
= Total area of the orifices (m
2
)
h
w
= Maximum driving head (m)
The total area of the orifice (A
o
) is a function of the number of perforations in the pipe.
This information is typically provided in the manufacturers specifications. The
maximum driving head is equal to the depth of the filter media plus the extended
detention depth, if extended detention is provided.
It is conservative, but reasonable to use a blockage factor to account for partial
blockage of the perforations by the drainage layer media. A blockage factor of 0.5 is
considered adequate.
7.4.5.4 Perforated pipe capacity
After confirming the capacity of the under-drainage system to collect the maximum
filtration rate, it is necessary to confirm the conveyance capacity of the under-drainage
system is sufficient to convey the collected runoff. The Colebrook-White equation can
be applied to estimate the flow rate in the perforated pipe.
( )
( ) (
(
|
|
\
|
+ =
5 . 0
5 . 0
2
51 . 2
7 . 3
log 2 2
f
f p p pipe
gDS D
v
D
k
S gD A Q
Equation 7.4
Where
Q
pipe
= Flow rate through the perforated pipe (m
3
/s)
A
p
= Pipe cross sectional area (m
2
)
D
p
= Pipe diameter (m)
S
f
= Hydraulic gradient (m/m)
k = Hydraulic roughness
= Kinematic viscosity of water (m
2
/s)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-22
One end of the under-drains should be extended vertically to the surface of the
bioretention system to allow inspection and maintenance when required. The vertical
section of the under-drain should be a non-perforated or slotted pipe and capped to
avoid short-circuiting of flows directly to the drain.
7.4.6 Step 6: Check requirements for impermeable lining
The saturated hydraulic conductivity of the natural soil profile surrounding the
bioretention system should be tested together with depth to groundwater, chemical
composition and proximity to structures and other infrastructure. This is to establish if
an impermeable liner is required at the base (only for systems designed to preclude
ex-filtration to in-situ soils) and/or sides of the bioretention basin. If the saturated
hydraulic conductivity of the filter media in the bioretention system is more than one
order of magnitude (10 times) greater than that of the surrounding in-situ soil profile,
no impermeable lining is required.
It is important to note that for unlined bioretention systems with submerged zones, the
bottom and sides of the submerged zone will need to be lined in order to maintain a
permanent pool of water.
7.4.7 Step 7: Size overflow pit
The intention of the high flow design is to convey safely the minor floods (eg. 5-year
ARI flows) with the same level of protection that a conventional stormwater system
provides. Bioretention basins are typically served with either grated overflow pits or
conventional side entry pits (located downstream of an inlet) to transfer flows into an
underground pipe network (the same pipe network that collects treated flows).
The location of the overflow pit is variable but it is desirable that flows do not pass
through extensive section of the bioretention basin enroute to the overflow pit. Grated
pits can be located near the inlet to minimize the flow path length for above design
flows. A level of conservatism should be built into the design grated overflow pits by
placing the crest of the pit at least 100 mm below the invert of the street gutter. This
allows the overflow pit to convey a minor flood prior to any afflux effects in the street
gutter. The overflow pit should be sized to pass a five year ARI storm with the
available head below the gutter invert (i.e. 100 mm).
Overflow pits can also be located external to bioretention basins, potentially in the
form of convention side entry pits associated with the street kerb and gutter
immediately downstream of the inlet to the basin. In this way the overflow pit can
operate in the same way as a conventional drainage system, with flows entering the
pit only when the bioretention system is at maximum ponding depth. This is illustrated
in Figure 7.12.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-23
Figure 7.12 A conventional side entry pit for overflow from Bioretention Pod.
Once inundated to street level, stormwater will no longer enter the
bioretention raingarden but will instead be conveyed to the
adjoining side entry pit.
A grated overflow pit is sized based on the governing flow condition; weir flow or
submerged flow conditions. A weir equation can be used to determine the length of
weir required (assuming free overfall conditions). An orifice equation is used to
estimate the required area between openings in the grate cover (assuming drowned
outlet conditions). The larger of the resulting required dimensions to accommodate
the two flow conditions should be adopted. In sizing the overflow pit for both drowned
and free flowing conditions, it is recommended that a blockage factor that assumes the
orifice is 50% blocked be used.
The weir equation for free flowing conditions is given by:
2 / 3
min w w weir or
h L C B Q Q = =
Equation 7.5
Where
Q
weir
= Flow over weir pit (m
3
/s)
B = Blocked factor (assumed to be 50%)
C
w
= Weir coefficient (adopt 1.7)
L = Length of weir (m)
h
w
= Flow depth above weir (m)
A standard sized pit can be selected with a perimeter at least the same length as the
required weir length.
The orifice equation for drowned outlet conditions is given by:
w grate d grate or
gh A C B Q Q 2 . .
min
= =
Equation 7.6
Where
Q
grate
= Flow rate under drowned conditions (m
3
/s)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-24
A
grate
= Area of perforations in inlet grate (m
2
)
h
w
= Flow depth above weir (m)
7.4.8 Step 8: Specify Vegetation
Advice from the National Parks Board should be sought in determining the lists of
plants suitable for bioretention basins. Consultation with landscape architects is
recommended when selecting vegetation, to ensure the treatment system
compliments the landscape of the area.
7.4.9 Step 9: Verification Checks
Once the detailed design is complete, a final check should be undertaken to confirm
that vegetation will be protected from scour during flood events and that the final
design will achieve the required treatment performance.
Scour velocities over the vegetation are checked through the bioretention basin by
assuming the system flows at a depth equal to the ponding depth across the full width
of the system. Dividing the design flow rate by the cross sectional area, an estimate of
flow velocity can be made. It is a conservative approach to assume that all flows pass
through the bioretention basin (particularly for a 100 year ARI) however this will ensure
the integrity of the vegetation.
Velocities should be kept below 0.5 m/s for flows up to the 5-year ARI peak discharges
and less than 1.0 m/s for events from the 5-year ARI to the 100-year ARI discharges
If the design of the bioretention basin (i.e. the treatment area) changes to ensure the
above criteria are met, the performance of the bioretention system given the new
treatment area should be checked against the sizing curves given in Figure 7.8 to
Figure 7.10.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-25
7.4.10 Design Calculation Summary
A summary of the key design elements of a bioretention basin are presented in the
following table.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-26
7.5 Checking Tools
The following sections provide a number of checking aids for designers and referral
authorities. Additional advice on construction and maintenance is provided.
Checklists have been provided for:
- Design assessments
- Construction (during and post)
- Operation and maintenance inspections
7.5.1 Design Assessment Checklist
The checklist below presents the key design features that should be reviewed when
assessing a design of a bioretention basin. These considerations include
configuration, safety, maintenance and operational issues that should be addressed
during the design phase.
Where an item results in an N when reviewing the design, referral should be made
back to the design procedure to determine the impact of the omission or error.
In addition to the checklist, a proposed design should have all necessary permits for
its installations. The referral agency should ensure that all relevant permits are in
place. These can include permits to clear vegetation, to dredge, create a waterbody,
divert flows or disturb downstream aquatic habitats.
7.5.2 Construction Advice
This section provides general advice for the construction of bioretention basins. It is
based on observations from construction projects around Australia.
7.5.2.1 Building Phase Damage
Protection of filtration media and vegetation is important during the building phase.
Uncontrolled building site runoff is likely to cause excessive sedimentation, introduce
weeds and litter and require replanting following the building phase.
To minimise the impact of construction activities on the site, it is recommended that
the bioretention system be installed in stages. For example, temporary protection of a
bioretention basin can be achieved by using a temporary arrangement of a suitable
geofabric covered with shallow topsoil (e.g. 25mm) and instant turf (laid perpendicular
to flow path) (Leinster, 2006). Such a system will provide erosion and sediment
control. At the completion of construction activities, the temporary protection can be
removed (along with the collected sediment) and the system planted in accordance
with the planting schedule.
It is also recommended that a silt fence be installed around the periphery of the basin
to exclude silt and restrict access. The silt fence is removed once construction is
completed.
7.5.2.2 Traffic and Deliveries
It is important to ensure traffic and deliveries do not access bioretention basins during
construction. Traffic can compact the filter media and cause preferential flow paths,
while deliveries can block filtration media (if placed above media). Washdown wastes
(eg. concrete) can also cause blockages in the filtration media.
Bioretention areas should be fenced off during building phase and controls
implemented to avoid washdown wastes.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-27
Checklist 1: Bioretention basin design assessment checklist
BIORETENTION BASIN DESIGN ASSESSMENT CHECKLIST
Basin Location:
Hydraulics: Minor Flood (m
3
/s): Major Flood (m
3
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Bioretention Area (ha):
TREATMENT Y N
Treatment performance verified from curves?
BIORETENTION MEDIA AND UNDER-DRAINAGE Y N
Design documents bioretention area and extended detention depth as defined by treatment performance requirements.
Overall flow conveyance system sufficient for design flood event(s)?
Where required, bypass sufficient for conveyance of design flood event?
Where required scour protection provided at inflow point to bioretention?
Bioretention media specification includes details of filter media, drainage layer and transition layer (if required)?
Design saturated hydraulic conductivity included in specification?
Transition layer provided where drainage layer consists of gravel (rather than coarse sand)?
Perforated pipe capacity > infiltration capacity of filter media?
Selected filter media hydraulic conductivity > 10 x hydraulic conductivity of surrounding soil?
Liner provided if selected filter media hydraulic conductivity < 10 x hydraulic conductivity of surrounding soil?
Maximum spacing of collection pipes <1.5m?
Collection pipes extended to surface to allow inspection and flushing?
Maximum upstream flood conveyance complies with Singapore surface water drainage requirements?
BASIN Y N
Bioretention area and extended detention depth documented to satisfy treatment requirements?
Overflow pit crest set at top of extended detention?
Maximum ponding depth will not impact on public safety?
Maintenance access provided to surface of bioretention system (for larger systems)?
Protection from coarse sediments provided (where required) with a sediment forebay?
Protection from gross pollutants provided (where required)?
LANDSCAPE Y N
Plant species selected can tolerate periodic inundation and design velocities?
Bioretention design and plant species selected integrate with surrounding landscape or built environment design?
COMMENTS
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-28
7.5.2.3 Inlet Erosion Checks
It is good practice to check the operation of inlet erosion protection measures following
the first few rainfall events to ensure the system would not be affected by scour.
Should problems occur in these events the erosion protection should be enhanced.
7.5.2.4 Timing for Planting
Timing of vegetation is dependent on a suitable time of year (and potential irrigation
requirements) as well as timing in relation to the phases of development. For
example, temporary planting during construction for sediment control (eg. with turf)
were removed and plant out with long term vegetation.
7.5.2.5 Planting Strategy
A planting strategy for a development will depend on the timing of construction phases
as well as marketing pressure. For example, it may be desirable to plant out several
entrance bioretention systems to demonstrate long term landscape values, and use
the remainder of bioretention systems as building phase sediment control facilities (to
be planted out following building).
7.5.2.6 Perforated Pipes
Perforated pipes can be either a PVC pipe with slots cut into the length of it or a
flexible ribbed pipe with smaller holes distributed across its surface (an AG pipe).
Both are suitable, though PVC pipes have the advantage of being stiffer with less
surface roughness providing a greater flow capacity. Stiff PVC pipes are also easier
to maintain (simple plumbing equipment is adequate for all maintenance needs). The
main disadvantage of stiff PVC pipes is the larger slot sizes, which may allow filter
media or drainage layer particles to enter the pipe.
7.5.2.7 Inspection Openings
It is good design practice to have inspection openings at the end of the perforated
pipes. The pipes should be brought to the surface and have a sealed capping. This
allows inspection of sediment buildup and water level fluctuations when required and
easy access for maintenance. The vertical component of the pipe should not be
perforated otherwise short circuiting can occur.
7.5.2.8 Clean Filter Media
Ensure drainage media is washed prior to placement to remove fines.
7.5.2.9 Construction Inspection Checklist
The following checklist presents the key items to be reviewed when inspecting the
bioretention basin during and at the completion of construction. The checklist is to be
used by Construction Site Supervisors and local authority Compliance Inspectors to
ensure all the elements of the bioretention basin have been constructed in accordance
with the design. If an item is ticked as unsatisfactory, appropriate actions must be
specified and delivered to rectify the construction issue before final inspection sign-off
is given.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-29
Checklist 2: Construction Inspection Checklist
BIORETENTION BASIN CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION CHECKLIST
Site:
Date:
Time:
Constructed By:
Weather:
Contact During Visit:
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION & ESTABLISHMENT
Preliminary Works Structural components
1. Erosion and sediment control plan
adopted
15. Location and configuration of inflow systems as
designed
2. Temporary traffic/safety control measures 16. Location and levels of overflow pits as designed
3. Location same as plans
17. Under-drainage connected to overflow pits as
designed
4. Site protection from existing flows 18. Concrete and reinforcement as designed
Earthworks and Filter Media
19. Set down to correct level for flush kerbs
(streetscape applications only)
5. Bed of basin correct shape and slope 20. Kerb opening width as designed
6. Batter slopes as plans
7. Dimensions of bioretention area as per
plans
Vegetation
8. Confirm surrounding soil type with design 21. Planting as designed (species and densities)
9. Confirm filter media specification in
accordance with guidelines (Step 4)
22. Weed removal and watering as required
9. Provision of liner (if required)
23. Stabilisation immediately following earthworks
and planting of terrestrial landscape around basin
10. Under-drainage installed as designed
11. Drainage layer media as designed Sediment & Erosion Control (If Required)
12. Transition layer media as designed (if
required)
24. Silt fences and traffic control in place
14. Extended detention depth as designed 25. Temporary protection layers in place
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 6. Check for uneven settling of banks
2. Confirm structural element sizes 7. Under-drainage working
3. Check batter slopes 8. Inflow systems working
4. Vegetation as designed 9. Maintenance access provided
5. Bioretention filter media surface flat and
free of clogging
10. Construction generated sediment removed
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-30
7.5.3 Maintenance Requirements
Bioretention basins treat runoff by filtering it through vegetation and then passing the
runoff vertically through a filtration media which filters the runoff. Besides vegetative
filtration, treatment relies upon infiltration of runoff into an underdrain. Vegetation
plays a key role in maintaining the porosity of the surface of the filter media and a
strong healthy growth of vegetation is critical to its performance.
The most intensive period of maintenance is during the plant establishment period
(first two years) when weed removal and replanting may be required. It is also the
time when large loads of sediments could impact on plant growth particularly in
developing catchments with poor building controls.
Maintenance is primarily concerned with:
- Maintenance of flow to and through the bioretention basin
- Maintaining vegetation
- Preventing undesired overgrowth vegetation from taking over the bioretention
basin
- Removal of accumulated sediments
- Litter and debris removal
Vegetation maintenance will include:
- Fertilising plants
- Removal of noxious plants or weeds
- Re-establishment of plants that die
Sediments accumulation at the inlets needs to be monitored. Depending on the
catchment activities (e.g. building phase) the deposition of sediment can tend to
smother plants and reduce the ponding volume available. Should excessive sediment
build up it will impact on plant health and require removal before it reduces the
infiltration rate of the filter media.
Similar to other types of practices, debris removal is an ongoing maintenance function.
Debris, if not removed, can block inlets or outlets, and can be unsightly if located in a
visible location. Inspection and removal of debris should be done regularly, but debris
should be removed whenever it is observed on the site.
7.5.3.1 Operation & Maintenance Inspection Form
The form below should be used whenever an inspection is conducted and kept as a
record on the asset condition and quantity of removed pollutants over time.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-31
Checklist 3: Bioretention basin maintenance checklist
BIORETENTION BASIN MAINTENANCE CHECKLIST
Inspection
Frequency:
1 to 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS: Y N Action Required (details)
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter within basin?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures?
Traffic damage present?
Evidence of dumping (e.g. building waste)?
Vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Watering of vegetation required?
Replanting required?
Mowing/slashing required?
Clogging of drainage points (sediment or debris)?
Evidence of ponding?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Surface clogging visible?
Drainage system inspected?
Resetting of system required?
COMMENTS
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-32
7.6 Bioretention Basin Worked
Example
7.6.1 Worked example introduction
A series of bioretention basins (pods), designed as street traffic parking out-stands is
to be retrofitted into a local street to treat road runoff. The local street is in Singapore.
A proposed layout of the bioretention system is shown in Figure 7.8 and an image of a
similar system to that proposed is shown in Figure 7.9.
Road Pavement
Footpath
Footpath
Road Pavement
Inlet through kerb Inlet through kerb
Figure 7.13 Layout of proposed bioretention system
Figure 7.14 Example of a retrofitted bioretention system in a street (Australia)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-33
Catchment Description
Each of the individual bioretention basins (pods) has a contributing catchment of
100m
2
road and footpath pavement and 300m
2
of adjoining properties. Runoff from
adjoining properties (approx. 60% impervious) is discharged into the road gutter and,
together with road runoff, is conveyed along a conventional roadside gutter to the
bioretention pod.
Table 7.1: Catchment properties
Catchment Land Uses Area (m
2
) % Impervious
Car Park 100 0.9
Allotment 300 0.6
Total 400 0.68
Design Objectives
The aim of the design is to facilitate effective treatment of stormwater runoff while
maintaining a level of flood protection for the local street during frequent storm events
up to the 5yr ARI event. Effective stormwater quality treatment is described in terms
of pollutant load reductions for total suspended solids (TSS), total phosphorous (TP)
and total nitrogen (TN).
The key design elements for effective operation of the bioretention basins are:
road and channel details to convey water into the basins
detailing inlet conditions to provide for erosion protection
configuring and designing a system for above design operation that will
provide the required 5year ARI flood protection for the local street
detailing of the bioretention under-drainage system
specification of the soil filter medium
landscape layout and details of vegetation.
Constraints and Concept Design Criteria
The proposed site for the bioretention basin has the following characteristics:
Overland flow slope: 1% typical
Soil: clay
A preliminary design was completed for the site. The specifications for the
bioretention basins were determined as follows:
- A bioretention basin area of 14m
2
(minimum) is required to achieve the
stipulated water quality objectives for this worked example (pollutant load
reductions of 80%, 45% and 45% for TSS, TN and TP respectively)
- The maximum width of the bioretention basin is to be 2m.
- The extended detention depth is 200 mm.
- Filter media shall be a sandy loam.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-34
7.6.2 Calculation Steps
The design of a bioretention system has been divided into the following 9 calculations
steps:
Step 1 Confirm treatment size given in conceptual design
Step 2 Determine design flows
Step 3 Design inflow system
Step 4 Specify the bioretention media characteristics
Step 5 Under-drain design and capacity checks
Step 6 Check requirements for impermeable lining
Step 7 High flow route and by-pass design
Step 8 Vegetation Specification
Step 9 Verification checks
Details for each calculation step are provided below. A design calculation summary
has been completed for the worked example and is given at the conclusion of the
calculation steps.
Step 1 Confirm treatment size given in conceptual design
The sizing of the bioretention system determined during conceptual design was
verified using the sizing curves given in Figure 7.8 to Figure 7.10. The sizing curves,
developed for Singapore conditions, give an estimate of the pollutant load reduction
for a given treatment size (defined in terms of impervious treatment area). Verification
using the sizing curves requires the following information:
The extended detention depth (200mm)
The ratio of treatment area to impervious area =
( ) ( ) [ ]
% 5
300 6 . 0 100 9 . 0
14
2
=
+
m
The expected pollutant reductions given in the sizing curves for the above criteria are
93%, 77% and 49% for TSS, TP and TN respectively and exceed the design
requirements of 80%, 45% and 45%.
Step 2 Determine design flows
Minor and major flood estimation
With a small catchment, the Rational Method is considered an appropriate approach to
estimate the 5 and 100 year ARI peak flow rates. The calculation steps are given
below.
a. Time of concentration (t
c
)
The time of concentration is associated with overland flow and kerb and gutter
travel times. In this worked example, the time of concentration is estimated to
be approximately 10 minutes.
b. Design rainfall intensities
The rainfall intensity for the 5 year and 100 year ARI event is calculated from
the Singapore IDF curve. Data for the 1year flow is extrapolated from the
curve. Rainfall intensities for the 100year, 5year and 1year ARI event for
10min storm duration are given below.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-35
100yr 5yr 1yr
Intensity (mm/hr) 271 166 106
c. Design runoff coefficient
The runoff coefficients are taken from the Singapore Code of Practice on
Surface Water Drainage (PUB, 2000). A runoff coefficient of 0.65 and 1.0 is
recommended for an urban and road catchment, respectively. The weighted
average for the catchment given the two land uses is 0.74.
d. Peak Design flows
Apply the Rational Method to determine the peak flows for 5year and 100year
ARI events:
s m
Q
s m
Q
CIA
Q
/ 02 . 0
360
10 400 271 74 . 0
/ 01 . 0
360
10 400 166 74 . 0
360
3
4
100
3
4
5
=
=
=
=
=
The critical design flow rate for a bioretention system is defined to be the 3
month ARI storm event. The 3 month ARI flow is calculated assuming:
yr mth
Q Q
1 3
5 . 0 = (ref. Engineers Australia, 2006)
s m
Q
mth
/ 004 . 0
360
10 400 106 74 . 0
5 . 0
3
4
3
=
(
Maximum filtration rate
The maximum filtration rate, or the flow reaching the perforated pipe in the drainage
layer, is estimated by applying Darcys equation (Equation 7.2) at the saturated
hydraulic conductivity of the filter media (assuming no blockage of the media) and the
head above the base of the filter media:
d
d h
W L k Q
base b
+
=
max
max
= 3.4 m
3
/hr or 0.0009 m
3
/s
Given
k = hydraulic conductivity of the soil filter (0.18m/hr)
L
b
W
base
= average area of the ponded section above the sand filter (14m
2
)
h
max
= depth of pondage above the sand filter (0.2m)
d = Filter media depth (0.6m)
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-36
Step 3 Design inflow system
Inlet Scour Protection
Rock beaching is to be provided in the bioretention basins to manage flow velocities
entering from the kerb opening.
Coarse Sediment Forebay
A bioretention system such as the one proposed here should incorporate a coarse
sediment forebay to remove coarse sediment from stormwater prior to flowing across
the surface of the filter media. The forebay should be designed to:
- Remove particles that are 1mm or greater in diameter from the 3mth ARI
storm event.
- Provide appropriate storage for coarse sediment to ensure desilting is required
once every year.
The size of the sediment forebay (A
s
) is determined by solving Equation 7.1 for a
capture efficiency of 80%, i.e.
( ) [ ] 1 1
1
=
n
s
s
R
V
nQ
A
Where
R = fraction of target sediment removed (adopt 80% or higher)
V
s
= settling velocity of target sediment (100 mm/s or 0.1 m/s for 1 mm
particle)
Q = Design flow (3 month ARI peak discharge in the absence of any
hydrological information for Singapore, this discharge may be
estimated as corresponding to 50% of the 1 year ARI peak
discharge (Engineers Australia, 2006)
n = turbulence or short-circuiting parameter (adopt 0.5)
A
s
= The area of the sediment forebay
( ) [ ]
2 5 . 0 1
48 . 0 1 8 . 0 1
1 . 0
) 004 . 0 )( 5 . 0 (
m A
s
= =
The volume of the sediment forebay is calculated by adopting a mean depth of 0.3 m,
ie.
3
14 . 0 3 . 0 48 . 0 m V
s
= =
Adopting a sediment loading rate of 3 m
3
/ha/yr, the clean-out frequency of the
sediment forebay is estimated to be 0.14/(3 x 0.04) = 1.2 years. Therefore the
frequency of maintenance of the sediment forebay is once a year.
Step 4 Specify the bioretention media characteristics
The bioretention system will have three layers:
- Sandy loam layer as the filter media (600mm)
- Coarse sand transition layer (100mm)
- Fine gravel drainage layer (200mm)
Filter Media Specifications
The filter media shall have the following properties:
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-37
- saturated hydraulic conductivity of approximately 180 mm/hr
- particle sizes ranging between: clay 5 15 %, silt <30 %, sand 50 70 %
- between 5% and 10% organic content
- pH neutral
Transition layer specifications
The transition layer material shall be a coarse sand material such as Unimin 16/30 FG
sand grading or equivalent. A typical particle size distribution is provided below:
Particle Size %Passing
1.4mm 100%
1.0mm 80%
0.7mm 44%
0.5mm 8.4%
Drainage layer specifications
The drainage layer is to be 200mm deep of 5mm screenings graded at 0.5% towards
the overflow pit.
Step 5 Under-drain design and capacity checks
A single under-drain is to be installed in the drainage layer. The perforated pipe is to
be laid on the base of the bioretention system which grades at 0.5 % towards the
overflow pit. A standard perforated pipe has the following specifications:
Openings per metre of pipe = 2100mm
2
Slot (opening) width = 1.5mm
Slot length = 7.5mm
No. of rows = 6
Pipe diameter = 100mm
Number of perforations (n) = 186
The flow capacity of the perforations and the pipe need to be checked against the
maximum filtration rate (0.0009 m
3
/s determined in Step 2) to ensure the flow
through the media is not impeded by the drainage system.
Perforations inflow check
The inlet capacity of a sub-surface drainage system (perforated pipe) is estimated to
ensure it is not a choke in the system. To build in conservatism, it is assumed that
50% of the holes are blocked.
The flow capacity of the perforations is calculated using equation 7.3
gh nA C B Q
d perf
2 . . =
When
C
d
= Discharge coefficient (0.6)
h = Assuming drainage layer is saturated, driving head is half the depth of
the drainage layer H = 0.1m
A = 1.125x10
-5
m
2
/hole
B
n
=
=
Blockage factor (adopt 0.5)
Numbers of holes
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-38
pipe of metre s m
Q
perf
/ / 0009 . 0
1 . 0 81 . 9 2 10 125 . 1 186 6 . 0 5 . 0
3
5
=
=
Given the perforated pipe will be 3m in length, the perforated flow for the pipe system
is 0.0027 m
3
/s. As the perforation flow capacity of the pipe is greater than the
maximum filtration rate the perforated pipe, it is adequate in transferring flows from the
media.
Perforated pipe capacity
The Colebrook-White equation is applied to estimate the flow rate in the perforated
pipe. A slope of 0.5% is assumed
2
and a 100mm perforated pipe (as above) was
used. The capacity of this pipe needs to exceed the maximum infiltration rate.
Applying the Colebrook-White Equation (Equation 7.4) to calculate the capacity of the
perforated pipe
( )
( ) (
(
|
|
\
|
+ =
5 . 0
5 . 0
2
51 . 2
7 . 3
log 2 2
f
f p
gDpS Dp
v
Dp
k
gDpS A Q
Where
D
p
= 0.10m
S
f
= 0.005m/m
g = 9.81m
2
/s
k = 0.007m
v = 1.007 x 10
-6
A
p
=
0.009m
2
The flow capacity of the pipe is 0.003 m
3
/s, which is greater than the infiltration rate.
Hence, the perforated pipe specified is adequate for the under-drainage system.
Step 6 Check requirements for impermeable lining
The soils found in Singapore are typically clay with the saturated hydraulic conductivity
expected to be ~3.6mm/hr. The sandy loam media that is proposed as the filter media
has a hydraulic conductivity of approximately 180 mm/hr. Therefore the conductivity
of the filter media is > 10times the conductivity of the surrounding soils and an
impervious liner is not considered to be required.
Step 7 High flow route and by-pass design
The overflow pit is required to convey 5 year ARI flows safely from above the
bioretention system into an underground pipe network. Grated pits are to be used at
the upstream end of the bioretention system. There are standard pit sizes to
accommodate connection to the underground stormwater pipe.
For the existing 450 mm diameter stormwater pipe, 600 x 600 mm pit
3
will be required.
The size of the pit necessary to convey the overflow is computed assuming both free
overfall weir flow and submerged flow conditions. For the free overflow condition, a
weir equation is used with the maximum headwater depth (h) above the weir being set
by the level difference between the crest of the overflow pit and the invert level of the
inflow kerb opening (i.e. 100mm).
2
A slope of 0.5% is adopted simply for convenience. In reality, the discharge capacity is reached when the soil is
saturated and water ponded to the full extended detention depth. Bioretention systems can operate equally effectively
with the underdrain laid at near-zero (but positive) slope.
3
Size of overflow pit should match the pipes connected to it. It should be sized to facilitate ease of maintenance.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-39
The weir equation is
2 / 3
min w w weir or
h L C B Q Q = =
For the 5year ARI event, assuming a blockage factor (B) and weir coefficient (C) of 0.5
and 1.7, respectively, the weir length is
m
H C B
Q
L
W
or
05 . 0
1 . 0 7 . 1 5 . 0
01 . 0
. .
2
3
2
3
min
=
= =
A 0.05m weir length is equivalent to a 130mm by 130mm pit smaller than the
standard 600 mm by 600 mm pit.
For drowned outlet conditions, the orifice equation is used:
gh A C B Q
d
2 . . =
For the minor flow event, given a discharge coefficient of 0.6, the required area of the
pit is
2
03 . 0
1 . 0 81 . 9 2 6 . 0 5 . 0
01 . 0
m
A
=
=
The equivalent pit dimensions for the drowned outlet condition are 180mm by 180mm
smaller than the standard 600 mm by 600 mm pit.
Hence, the 600mm by 600mm pit is to be adopted.
Step 8 Vegetation Specification
Consultation with the National Parks Board is required in determining the list of
suitable plant species for the proposed bioretention basin.
Step 9 Verification Checks
Flows for the 5yr ARI (Q
5
) and 100yr ARI (Q
100
) storm events may be conveyed
through the bioretention system. A check for vegetation scouring is completed by
checking that velocities through the bioretention system are below 0.5m/s and 1.0 m/s
for the 5yr ARI and 100yr ARI event, respectively. The scour check is performed
using Equation 7.6.
Given the width of the basin is 2m and the extended detention is 0.2m, the susceptible
flow area is 0.4m
2
. Hence,
s m s m
A
Q
v
year
/ 5 . 0 / 03 . 0
5
5
< = =
s m s m
A
Q
v
year
/ 0 . 1 / 05 . 0
100
100
< = =
Hence, bioretention system can satisfactorily convey the peak 5yr and 100yr ARI
flood, minimising the potential for scour.
Chapter 7 Bioretention Basins
Engineering procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 7-40
7.6.3 Calculation summary
The sheet below shows the results of the design calculations.
Bioretention basins
CALCULATION TASK
Catchment Characteristics
- Land Uses
Residential 300 m
2
Commercial 0 m
2
Roads 100 m
2
- Fraction Impervious
Residential 0.6 -
Commercial 0 -
Roads 0.9 -
Weighted average 0.74
Conceptual Design
Basin Area 14 m
2
Maximum width 2 m
maximum ponding depth (extended detention) 0.2 m
Filter media type (hydraulic conductivity) 180 mm/hr
Identify design criteria
Minor flood 5 year ARI
Major flood 100 year ARI
1. Confirm treatment performance and concept design
Reduction in TSS 93 %
Reduction in TP 77 %
Reduction in TN 49 %
2. Estimate design flow rates
Time of concentration
estimate from flow path length and velocities 10 minutes
Identify rainfall intensities
station used for IFD data: Singapore
Design Rainfall Intensity for minor flow 166 mm/hr
Design Rainfall Intensity for major flow 271 mm/hr
Design Rainfall Intensity for 1yr ARI storm event 106 mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient -
(refer to the Singapore Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage(2000)) 0.74
Peak design flows
Qminor 0.01 m
3
/s
Qmajor 0.022 m
3
/s
Q infil 0.0009 m
3
/s
3. Design inflow system
Adequate erosion and scour protection? yes y/n
Coarse Sediment Forebay Required? yes
Volume (Vs) 0.14 m
3
Area (As) 0.48 m
2
Depth (D) 0.5 m
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage81
8.1 INTRODUCTION
GeneralDescriptionofCleansingBiotopeSystems
Cleansingbiotopesareaformofartificiallyconstructedwetlands.Theyconsistofnutrientpoor
substrates that are planted with wetland plants which are known for their water cleansing
capacity.Becauseofthehighperformancepotentialofsuchnaturalcleansingsystemstheycan
beimplementedinavarietyofsituations,suchastherevitalizationoflakesandthecleansing
of urban waterbodies. Water bodies that are only slightlypolluted can be treated especially
efficientlywiththistypeofsystem.
Inspiredbynature,cleansingbiotopesoffereffectivewatertreatmentwithasoftandnatural
aesthetic.Maintenancerequirementsarelowandeasytocarryout.Thesepracticalandvisual
aspectscombined withtheir cleansingpotential make theman attractive elementofa water
system.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage82
Theycanbeimplementedinavarietyofsituations:
outdoorareas,suchasparks,openfields,pondsandlakes
rooftopgardens,wintergardensinbuildinginteriors,openplazasnexttobuildingsor
evenunderelevatedstructures
subdivided into smaller areas (such as small skygardens and planters) that work
togetherinsequenceforincrementalcleaning.
BENEFITS
canbeconstructedsimply
completelyflexibleinformcanbesubdividedintosmallerbiotopeareas
8.2 DESIGNPROCESS
This segment outlines the general steps for determining the overall design of a cleansing
biotope, highlighting the different factors that has to be taken into considerations. Land
availability,sitetopography,landuseandurbanplanningparameterswouldpresentlimitsand
opportunities for locating and sizing the cleansing biotope. On the other hand, the primary
motivationforcleansingthewater,whetheritisforonsitereuseortoaidinachievinggreater
national stormwater management efficiency, would determine the desired level of water
purificationand,subsequently,thehydraulicflow,detentiontime,pipingsystem,aswellasthe
typesofsubstrateandvegetationtobeused.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage83
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage84
8.2.1 LANDSCAPEDESIGNCONSIDERATION
8.2.1.1 SiteSurvey
Adetailedlandsurveyofthesiteshouldbeundertakentoidentifyexistingsiteconditionsthat
maypresentconstraintsaswellasnaturallyconduciveopportunitiesfortheoptimumlocation
andsizeofthecleansingbiotope:
TopographyNaturaldepression,existingslopesandchangesinlevelsthatwould
advantagethedesiredflowofwater,particularlyinmultitieredcleansingbiotope
systems.
Soil content availability of material suitable for substrate (refer to substrate
specification). Variations totechniquesof soilcompacting.Plasticity ofsoil would
determine the types and rigidity of structures, such as concrete foundations,
berms,tobedesignedasedges.
Vegetation Determine existing vegetations whichcanbe transplanted foruse in
the cleansing biotope. Where comparable, indigenous plants are preferred over
introducingnewspeciesintothesite.Thiscouldbeseenasaneffortinconserving
the ecological heritage of the site. More practically, this would minimize any
adjustmentsthattherestofthelocalfloraandfaunahavetomake,thusensuring
acontinuityoftheecology.Diversityofplantsratherthanmonoculture.
Immediate Surrounding area future changes possible expansion. Existing elements
(streams,reservoirsetc.)
8.2.1.2 Determineurbanplanningparameters
Precise information of the following must also be obtained from relevant governmental
authorities,andverifiedagainstthesitesurvey:
Locationsofthesiteboundary
Locationsofanydrainagereservesandexistingdrains,includingtheirculvertlevels
and required hydraulic capacity. This is especially important for designing the
hydraulic flow of the cleansing biotope, particularly in its interface with the
existingsystem(inflowanddischargepoints).
Locationsofanyroadreservesandsetbackswherethedevelopmentisadjacent
to a road, care must be taken to ensure that no structures are within any road
reservesandsetbacks.
Athoroughunderstandingof,andadherenceto,thebasicauthorityrequirementsiscitical.
It is imperative that the relevantauthorities are consultedduring the commencement of
thedesignprocess.Theseinclude,butarenotlimitedto,thefollowing:
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage85
ObtainingplanningapprovalfromtheUrbanRedevelopmentAuthority(URA),
Environmental protection consultation with the National Environment Agency
(NEA)
8.2.1.3 ConfirmTreatmentPerformance
Thefollowingliststhetypesofpollutantsthatcanberemovedusingcleansingbiotopes
OrganicLoad:
Cleansingbiotopesareveryefficientatbreakingdownbothparticulateanddissolvedorganic
materials. The degradation of organic carbon composites occurswith the help of oxygenfed
microorganisms.Microfauna live in symbiosiswithplant roots in the virtuallyinfinitely large
surfaceofthesubstratematrix.Thenecessaryoxygeninputintothesystemoccursthroughthe
waterthatistobetreated.Theplantscontributesignificantlytotheoxygenloadthroughtheir
rootsystems.Carbonisextrudedfromthesysteminformofcarbondioxide.
Phosphate:
Aspecificchemicalcompositionofthesoilmatrixcanbeachievedthroughacontrolledmixing
of substrates. Depending on the chemical composition of the soil matrix a good phosphate
bondingcharacteristiccanbeachieved.Theadditionofmetallicoxidesorredlavarockwithan
ironcontentofupto15%cansignificantlyincreasethephosphatebindingcapability.Theyear
round input of oxygen into the system prevents the rerelease of phosphates. An effective
bindingcapacityofthesoilmatrixcanbeassumedformanyyears.
Nitrogencomposites:
In the presence of oxygen bacteria nitrify ammonium. The following bacterial denitrification
canonlyoccurtoaverysmallextentinaerobicconditions.Theplantswillpartiallyfeedoffof
thenitrates.
PathogenicBacteria:
Pathogenscannotreproducethemselvesoutsideofhumanoranimalorganisms.Toisolateand
remove them effectively, it is hence important that the water is retained in the cleansing
biotopeforasufficientlylongtime.Inaddition,thetransitionbetweenaerobicandanaerobic
zonesprovidesahighlevelofbacteriadestruction.
WATERQUALITYSTANDARDS
Therearevariousreasonsforwantingtoincludeacleansingbiotopeinadevelopment.
Itcouldbe motivatedbysocialresponsibility: the desire tocontribute totheefficiency of the
national stormwater management system and PUBs ABC strategy of diversification (refer to
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage86
ABCWatersGuidelines).Insuchacircumstance,thecleansedwaterfromthecleansingbiotope
isintendedtobedischargedimmediatelyintothepublicstormwaterinfrastructure,andwould
thus require a lower level of water purification. Nevertheless, it is recommended that a
sufficientlevel ofpurificationis accomplished toenhance thehealthy growth ofdownstream
ecology.
In some cases, the cleansing biotopes are meant to recycle the water for reuse onsite.
Commonly, these local uses include irrigation and the flushing of toilets, or to supply and
replenishthewaterinaestheticpondsandwaterfeatures.Thepossibilityofhumaninteraction
(butnotconsumption)necessitatesahigherlevelofpurification.
Cleansing biotopes have also been successfully implemented to purify water for water
playgrounds,wherechildrenarelikelytounintentionallyconsumemouthfulsofwater.Amore
stringentstandardofwaterpurificationwould,insuchsituations,havetobekept.
Asexplainedabove,standardsofwaterqualityaretypicallysetaccordingtoitsintendeduse.
These different standards include benchmarks for different types ofcontaminantsand water
qualityindicators.
Theseincludes:
For drinking water colour, alkalinity, dissolved metals, salts and organics matters, heavy
metals
ForenvironmentalwaterpHlevel,salinity,dissolvedoxygen,pesticides
ISOStandards
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) has established standards of water
quality for various uses and situations, including potable water, industrial discharge and
sewagewater.ThesearespecificallycoveredinsectionICS13.060.
http://www.iso.org/iso/iso_catalogue/catalogue_ics/catalogue_ics_browse.htm?ICS1=13&ICS
2=060
LocalStandards
The following provides local standards that have been set by the National Environment
Agency:
NEAFrequentlyAskedQuestions(FAQ)onWaterQuality
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/category_sub.asp?cid=38
NEAEnvironmentalPollutionAct
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/category_sub.asp?cid=189
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage87
PipedDrinkingWaterUnit
http://app2.nea.gov.sg/topics_dwu.aspx
NEAWaterQualityStandardsforSwimmingPool
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/article.asp?pid=2934
RecreationalWaterQualityGuidelinesForRecreationalBeachesAndFreshWaterBodies
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/article.asp?pid=3039
NEA Allowable Limits for Trade Effluent Discharge to Sewer / Watercourse / Controlled
Watercourse
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/article.asp?pid=1644
NEANewTradeEffluentStandardsforDischargeintoWatercourseandControlled
Watercourse
http://app.nea.gov.sg/cms/htdocs/article.asp?pid=2538
Onceadesiredlevelofwaterpurificationisdecided,theotherfactorsthatcontributetoitcan
thenberesolved.Thesevariablesincludethehydraulicflow,detentiontime,pipingsystem,as
wellasthetypesofsubstrateandvegetationtobeused.Differentcombinationsofeachcould
be employed to achieve the desired water purification level, and it is recommended that a
landscape architect and hydrology specialist be engaged to determine the most suitable
combination.
8.2.2 HYDRAULICDESIGNCONSIDERATIONS
8.2.2.1 DetermineDetentionTime
As explained above, the detention time withina cleansingbiotope has immediate effects on
thelevelofwaterpurification.
Detention time is a measure of how long a particular molecule of water stays within a
cleansingbiotopefromthetimethatitwasintroducedtothetimethatitisdischarged.Thisis
commonly measuredusing the Plugflow method, which assumes constant velocity of water
flowacrossanycrosssection.Itisthusassumedthatthefirstmoleculeenteringthecleansing
biotopewouldalsobethefirstmoleculeexitingfromit.
As a general gauge, wastewater that is highlypolluted requires about 23 days of detention
time,whereaswaterthatismoderatelypolluted(equivalenttolakewater)wouldonlyrequire
about12hrs.
Ahydrologistshouldbeengagedtodeterminethespecificamount of detentiontime needed
toachievetheminimumdesiredlevelofwaterpurification.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage88
8.2.2.2 SizeCleansingBiotopeandDetermineDesignFlows
Detention time is proportional to the size of the cleansing biotope. As such, the most direct
way of achieving a higher level of purification would be to increase the detention time by
increasingthesizeofthecleansingbiotope.
Q=flowrate(m
3
/hr)
V=Volumeofwaterincleansingbiotope(m
3
)
T=detentiontime(hr)
V=Volumeofwaterincleansingbiotope(m
3
)
A=filtersurface/cleansingbiotopearea(m
2
)
H=depthofwaterincleansingbiotope(m)
Wherespaceisplentiful,thecleansingbiotopecanbesizedtoachievethenecessarydetention
time. Where there is insufficient space to implement the required size of cleansing biotope,
othervariables,suchasfilterdepthandfiltermaterial,couldalsobeadjustedaccordingly.
A=filtersurface
Q=flowrate
k
f
=saturatedhydraulicconductivity
H=waterdepth
s=filterdepth
dh=leveldeviation
D=permanentwaterlevel
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage89
8.2.2.3 ShapeofCleansingBiotope
A constant and evenlydistributed flow of water in the biotope is necessary for optimum
cleansingeffectiveness.Segmentinga cleansingbiotope intoseveral(usuallythree)areashas
thebenefitofextendingitslifecycle.Runningthesegmentsinturnallowseachtoconsistently
haveaperiod of regeneration thatguaranteesthelong termpermeabilityof the top layer of
the filter substrate. For example, water could be fed to each area for a period of 4 days
followedbyabreakof2days.Assuch,inathreesegmentsystem,twoareasareinoperation
whilethethirdisregenerating.
8.2.2.4 DetermineDesignFlow
8.2.2.4.1 DesignInflow
Regulatingwatervolume
In specific instances, the velocityof inflow isfixed.Forexample,acleansingbiotopefedbya
stream that has a bypass channel or flume would not have to worry about variable water
inflow. In other cases where water level is susceptible to fluctuations, cleansing biotopes
wouldhavetobeimplementedincombinationwithregulatingdevices,suchasholdingponds
or weirs, inorderto maintainaneven inflowof water.This is toensureaconstantdetention
timethathasadirecteffectonthelevelofwaterpurification.
Inflowloading
Dependingonvariousfactors,polluted
water can be introduced into the
cleansingbiotopesin2generalways:
topflow water is introduced from
the top of the bed, either as an
overflow from the higher terraces, or
usingdistributionplates.Ashallowfilm
of water is visible above the biotope
bed which then percolates down
throughthesubstrate.
Distributionplate
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage810
Sideflowwaterispipedintothecleansingbiotopesfromoneendofthesideofthebed,
such that the pipes are submerged in the substrate. In this case, the polluted water flows
throughthesubstrateataslowerrateandisnotvisibleonthesurfaceofthecleansingbiotope
aswaterleveldoesnotriseaboveit.Thisisespeciallyeffectivefortreatingblackwater.
8.2.2.4.2. DesignDischarge
In the topflow model, water is collected using perforated pipes at the bottom of the
substrate,andisthenconveyedtoitsdesiredlocation.Itsfinaldestinationcanbemoderately
far away, up to several hundred metres or several kilometres, as long as there is sufficient
pressureforitsconveyance.
8.2.3 SPECIFICATIONS
8.2.3.1 MultiLayeredLiner
MultiLayeredLineristobecomprisedofthefollowing:
1. Anchors:Formembranesecurement;steelrod,6mmdia.
2. Stabilisationmat:10mmthick,nondecaying,forstabilisingslopes
3. Waterproofingmembrane.
4. Geotextilemat:levellingandprotectivelayer.
5. Wiremeshblankets:Protectionagainstrodents,plasticcoatedagainstcorrosionmesh
8.2.3.2 Pipes
PressurePipes
PressurePipesaretohavethefollowingcharacteristics:
a) Comesinaroll
b) Material:Polyethylene(PE)
Pressurepipesshouldbeconnectedtogetherwithelectrical
weldedfittings.Theycanbeflushedthroughwithhighflow
pressurizedwaterfromthecontrolroomandallpipesareto
beaccessible.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage811
DrainagePipes
Drainage Pipes on the floor of the cleansing
biotope are to have the following
Characteristics:
a) Perforated Pipe with perforations <
3mmdia.allaround
b) Material:Polyethylene(PE)
8.2.3.3 FilterSubstrate
Cleansing Biotope substrates contributes to the purification process through multiple micro
functions:
On theonehand, they trap and filter solid particlesas water pass through their fine
texture.
Secondly,theysupportbacterialgrowth
Theyalsoremovecontaminantsthroughaprocessofsurfaceabsorptionandcomplexation.In
thisparticularprocess,thereisaninverserelationshipbetweenthesizeoftheparticlesandits
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage812
purification effectiveness. As particle size decreases, total surface area increases, which
effectivelyincreasessurfaceabsorptionrates.
This,however,hastobebalancedwithhydraulicconductivity,whichhasadirectrelationship
with the size of the substrate particle. As particle size decreases, the less permeable the
substrateandtheslowertheflowofwaterthroughit.
Asaruleofthumb,themostsuitablesubstratewouldbecomprisedofthesmallestparticle
thatcanstillmeettheminimumhydraulicconductivity.Empirically,coarsetomediumsized(1
3mmdiameter)sandhasproventobeveryeffectiveinachievingthisbalance.Thechemical
makeupofthesubstratemustalsobetakenintoconsideration.
Depending on availability, various combinations of materials can be used to achieve similar
results.The following 3 formulasdefine the relationshipbetween the flow rate ofthewater,
permeabilityandparticlesizeofthesubstrate.
ThefollowingisanexampleofwhathasbeenspecifiedfortheKallangRiverBishanParkcase
study. This is just one example of what would be suitable for Singapore. Each site would
present different requirements and a specialist should be engaged to determine the
appropriatesubstratecomposition.
The Filter substrate is to be mixed offsite and brought onto site and should consist of the
following:
a) Sand
i) particlesize13mm
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage813
ii) chalkcontent020%
b) Lava
i) particlesize24mm
ii) ironcontent010%
TheFiltersubstrateisnottobecompactedduringconstructionstageorpostconstruction.
8.2.3.4 Plants
Itisimportantthatthefiltersubstrateisthoroughlywashedbeforelayingtopreventanystray
foreignparticlesfromcloggingup/affectingthechemicalcompositionofthesubstrate.Filter
substrateshouldalsonotbecompactedduringconstructionoraftercompletion.
Planting
The planting of the cleansing biotope is an important element of the overall system and
ensures the longterm performance and the infiltration capacity of the substrate. Depending
onsiteconditionsandplantrequirements,nearlyallwetlandplantscanbeused.Thecommon
reed(Phragmitesaustralis)isthemostcommonlyusedplant.
In water bodies with low nutrient loads the planting should be relatively dense and potted
plantsshouldbeplantedsoastobalanceouttheinitiallownutrientlevelsandcompensatefor
any related loss of plant material. The planting needs little maintenance. The chief task is to
removedeadandcutplantmaterial.
PlantSpecies
Diversityispreferredovermonoculture
Wherepossible,indigenousplantshouldbeincluded
Wetlandspeciesthatarecapableforadaptingtofluctuatingwaterlevelshasahigher
chanceofsurvivalandrobustgrowth
Plantswithdeeprootswillaidinsupportingthesubstrate
The Kallang River Bishan Park project is the pilot implementation of a cleansing biotope in
Singapore.RefertoKallangRiverBishanPark(KRBP)casestudyforalistofsuggestedspecies.
KRBP is the pilot implementation of a cleansing biotope in Singapore, and is currently
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage814
undergoing construction. As such, the plants are currently being tested for suitability to
Singapore climate. Other aquatic plants may also be appropriate, but would have to be
verified.AconsultationwithNParksisrecommendedtodetermineanyothersuitablespecies.
8.3 CONSTRUCTIONPROCESS
Constructionofterraces
Layingofliner
Layingofpipes
Addingfirstlayerofsubstrate
Leveling
Addingsecondlayerofsubstrateand
topsoil
Preparationforplanting
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage815
8.4 MAINTENANCEREQUIREMENTS
Cleansing biotopes perform best when there are no suspended solids in the inflow, as they
tend to clog the substrate. The polluted water can be passed through a settling tank or a
skimmertoremovethesuspendedsolidsbeforebeingfedintothecleansingbiotope.
Ageneralmanagementregimethatincludesthefollowingsteps:
8.4.1 Waterqualityandquantitymonitoring
Maintenance regime should include periodic water quality checks to ensure that water stays
within the set criteria. Water samples for analysis may benecessary. Water quantity control
devices, such as weirs and valves, may have to be adjusted to ensure a constant velocity of
flowintothecleansingbiotope.
8.4.2 SubstrateMaintenance
The upper most layer of the filter substrate is particularlyactive during thebiological break
down process. No exterior influences should disturb this process. Cleansing biotope systems
generally function increasingly well over the years, as the biological systemgets established.
Unlike traditionalsand filter systems, replacingthe substrate or removingtheupper layers is
generallynotnecessary.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage816
8.4.3 Plantmaintenance
Plant maintenance is minimal, and generally involves basic regimes, such as inspection for
signsofinsectdamageorinfestation,theremovalofdeadplantsandpruning.
Fertilizing,bothduringandafterplantestablishment,isnotnecessary.
8.4.4 MosquitoControl
In both models of cleansing biotopes, mosquito control is not necessary as there are no
stagnantwaterformosquitobreeding.Inthetopflowmodel,waterisconstantlyinmotion
and percolating to the bottomof the substrate. In the sideflow model, water is contained
beneath the surface of the cleansing biotope, such that neither mosquito, not algae growth
couldoccur.
8.5 WORKEDEXAMPLEBishanPark,Singapore
8.5.1 Introduction
The decision to includea cleansingbiotope in the new designof the Bishan Park reflects the
philosophy of educating the public on both water conservation as well as ecological
conservation/sustainability.
Onthemorepragmaticsideofthings,thedesiretofacilitateincreasedrecreationalactivities,
such as kayaking, fishing and even just wadding in the river would require the water to be
constantlycleansedinamannerthatiscostefficientandrequireslowmaintenance.
ThecleansingbiotopefacilitywillbelocatedupstreaminBishanPark1,beforetheareaswhere
the bulk of the recreational activities will take place. It is about 5400m2 in area, and is
comprisedof4terracesofcleansingbiotopes.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage817
8.5.2 DesignFlow
8.5.2.1 DesignInflow
Watertothecleansingbiotopeismainlyfedfromthepond,throughapumproom.Water
fromtheendofthepondisalsorecirculatedbacktothecleansingbiotope.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage818
8.5.2.2 DesignOutflow
The cleansing biotope at Bishan Park is aimed at improving the quality of the water in
threedifferentlocations:
Waterplayground
Locatedtotheeastsideofthecleansingbiotope,thewaterplaygroundisintendedfor
kidsofallages.Assuch,thequalityofthewatermustmeetpotabledrinkingstandards.
Ponds
The pondsarehome to many of the aquatic fauna found in BishanPark. The water in
the lake should therefore meet environmentalhealth standards. Theseriesofponds is
alsodesigned toend ina water cascade/overflow thatwillgive visual prominence to
moving water as part of a wider water recirculation system, thus potentially attract
humanpeopletowadeandplayinit.Assuch,alevelofwaterqualitysufficientforsafe
humaninteractionisalsonecessary.
KallangRiver
Water discharged to the Kallang River would eventually flow downstream towards
Marina Barrage, passing through channels and streams where diverse wildlife and
ecologythrive.Itisthereforedesignedtoalsomeetenvironmentalhealthstandards.
Chapter8CleansingBiotopes
EngineeringProceduresforABCWatersDesignFeaturesPage819
8.5.3 PlantingScheme
GROUP BOTANICALNAME COMMONNAME
Group1 Pontederiacordata PickerelWeed
Typhaminima SingaporePink
Cyperushaspanvar.vivipurus
Group2 Trimeziamartinicensis TigerEyeIris
Pontederiacordata PickerelWeed
Thaliadealbata Thalia
Group3 Acrostichumspeciosum MangroveFern
Lycopodiumcernuum CreepingClubMoss
Thaliadealbata Thalia
Group4 Cyperushaspanvar.vivipurus
Lycopodiumcernuum CreepingClubMoss
Trimeziamartinicensis TigerEyeIris
Typhonodorumlindleyanum
Thefollowingarepossibleedgeconstructionfortheterraces.
Bio-engineering
9
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-1
Chapter 9 8|o-eng|neer|ng
9.1 INTRODUCTION
9.2 DESIGN PROCESS
9.2.1 Determine Application
9.2.1.1 Suitable Conditions
9.2.1.2 Micro-functions
9.2.1.3 Community Enhancement
9.2.2 Site Survey
9.2.2.1 Topography
9.2.2.2 Geology
9.2.2.3 Wind / Hydraulic Condition
9.2.2.4 Existing Vegetation
9.2.3 Determine Required Parameter
9.2.3.1 N-values
9.2.3.2 Slope and Rigidity
9.2.4 Determine Techniques
9.2.5 Specifications
9.2.6 Maintenance
9.3 TECHNIQUES
9.3.1 Log Cribwall with Brush Layers
9.3.2 Rip Rap with Cuttings
9.3.3 Brush Mattress with Live Fascine
9.3.4 Geotextile-wrapped soil lift
9.3.5 Fascine with Geotextile
9.3.6 Multiple Fascines
9.3.7 Reed Roll
9.3.8 Stone Wall with Cuttings
9.3.9 Gabions with Brush Layers
9.3.10 Vegetated Reinforced Soil
9.3.11 Tree Stumps with Cutting
9.3.12 Rock Gabion Mat
9.3.13 Rock Sill
9.4 CASE STUDY: KALLANG RIVER BISHAN PARK
9.5 REFERENCES
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-2
9.1 IN1kCDUC1ICN
8loenglneerlng refers Lo Lhe use of vegeLaLlon and lnerL sLrucLures, such as geoLexLlles, as a way of
formlng and malnLalnlng land forms. As a fleld, bloenglneerlng sLraddles Lhe dlsclpllnes of clvll
englneerlng, boLany and landscape archlLecLure. lL seeks Lo harness Lhe lnherenL quallLles and
capablllLles of organlc maLLer (planLs, seeds, branches, rooLs eLc.) for Lhe purpose of sLrucLural
lnLegrlLy, be lL ln a naLural envlronmenL (such as sLablllzlng a rlver embankmenL) or a consLrucLed
space (reLalnlng walls supporLlng roads and bulldlngs). 8loenglneerlng asplres Lo come as close as
posslble Lo naLure noL only ln Lhe use of maLerlals buL also ln Lhe meLhods of consLrucLlon.
8loenglneerlng Lechnlques can be employed Lo replace LradlLlonal clvll englneerlng appllcaLlons, buL
more ofLen Lhan noL, Lhey are used ln comblnaLlon as a complemenL Lo each oLher.
1hese could be broken down lnLo varlous processes and Lechnlques almed aL achlevlng varlous
goals: resLoraLlon, reclamaLlon, remedlaLlon and proLecLlon from degradaLlon.
ln order Lo accuraLely apply Lhe knowledge of blo-englneerlng, one needs Lo undersLand Lhe
fundamenLals of land movemenLs and mechanlcs, as well as relaLed eroslons caused by varlous
naLural elemenLs, such as waLer and wlnd. lL ls also lmporLanL Lo know Lhe baslc characLerlsLlcs
(reslllence, hydrologlcal afflnlLy, rooL sLrucLure, maLure slze and growLh perlod eLc.) of dlfferenL
Lypes of planLs Lo approprlaLely use Lhem ln Lhe deslgn of sLrucLures for blo-englneerlng purposes.
Chapter 9 Bio-engineering
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 9-3
9.2 DESIGNPROCESS
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-4
9.2.1 DL1LkMINL ALICA1ICN
9.2.1.1 Su|tab|e Cond|t|ons
Slnce bloenglneerlng can only be applled ln reglons where planLs can grow easlly and abundanLly,
Lhey are ofLen llmlLed Lo only Lroplcal, subLroplcal and LemperaLe cllmaLes. Whlle frosLy and arld
cllmaLes are equally hosLlle Lo ecologlcal growLh, Lhe use of lrrlgaLlon may compensaLe Lhe laLLer. As
a general rule of Lhumb, Lhe more ecologlcal dlverslLy Lhere ls ln a reglon, Lhe more sulLable lL wlll
be for Lhe employmenL of bloenglneerlng.
8loenglneerlng ls commonly applled for slope and bank sLablllzaLlon.
9.2.1.2 M|cro-funct|ons
1he general alm of soll-sLablllzaLlon can be broken down lnLo more speclflc funcLlons LhaL work
hand-ln-hand and can be achleved Lhrough a comblnaLlon of bloenglneerlng Lechnlques. 1hese
funcLlons lnclude:
1echnlcal
roLecLlng Lhe soll surface from eroslon caused by cllmacLlc elemenLs (snow, raln, flowlng waLer,
wlnd)
8educe Lhe veloclLy of waLer flow
laclllLaLlng seLLlemenL and deposlLlon of sand and sedlmenLs
MalnLalnlng soll LexLure as a prevenLlon of landslldes
Lcologlcal
ModeraLlon of molsLure level and LemperaLure of Lhe soll and lLs mlcro-reglon
LnhancemenL of soll ferLlllLy Lhrough Lhe reLenLlon of nuLrlenLs
nolse barrler
8eauLlflcaLlon and camouflage of unpleasanL sLrucLures
lncreaslng soll lnLegrlLy Lhrough rooL neLworks
lmprovemenL of alr quallLy
9.2.1.3 Commun|ty Lnhancement
8loenglneerlng also has added advanLages Lhanks Lo lLs ecologlcal naLure. leasanL and healLhy
green envlronmenLs are creaLed for Lhe en[oymenL of Lhe communlLy and long-Lerm susLalnablllLy of
ecosysLem.
Soclal lnLeracLlon ls also enhanced ln a beauLlful and clean envlronmenL, creaLlng communlLles LhaL
are vlbranL and acLlve.
9.2.2 S|te Survey
lL ls lmporLanL LhaL a Lhorough slLe survey ls carrled ouL prlor Lo consLrucLlon commencemenL, as
Lhe lnformaLlon LhaL ls gaLhered would affecL Lhe declslons made durlng Lhe deslgn process. lL
would also hlghllghL Lhe opporLunlLles and resLrlcLlons lnherenL ln Lhe slLe:
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-3
9.2.2.1 1opography
8loenglneerlng Lechnlques can be employed Lo sLablllze new earLh formaLlons, buL
more ofLen, lL ls used Lo enhance exlsLlng land forms. AccuraLe lnformaLlon on Lhe
gradlenL of Lhese slopes, banks and depresslons, as well as Lhelr exlsLlng condlLlon
(Lo whaL degree Lhey are vegeLaLed and lf Lhere are exlsLlng supporL sLrucLures),
musL be obLalned.
9.2.2.2 Geo|ogy
A soll survey should be carrled ouL Lo deLermlne Lhe make-up of Lhe soll on varlous
parLs of Lhe slLe. 1hls would help Lo ldenLlfy area LhaL are rocky and lmpervlous, as
well as Lhe general plasLlclLy and poroslLy of Lhe soll. 1hls would have effecL on Lhe
general sLablllLy of Lhe slopes, Lhe level of sLablllzaLlon LhaL ls needed, as well as Lhe
sulLablllLy of proposed new planL specles.
9.2.2.3 W|nd ] nydrau||c Cond|t|on
AccuraLe measuremenLs of Lhe prlmary cllmacLlc elemenL LhaL causes eroslon, such
as waLer, snow or wlnd ls necessary Lo deLermlne Lhe exLenL and Lype of
bloenglneerlng Lechnlques Lo be employed.
9.2.2.4 Lx|st|ng Vegetat|on
An lnvenLory of Lhe planLs and llvlng" consLrucLlon maLerlals (lncludlng branches,
cuLLlngs, shooLs, specles of grass and shrubs) LhaL exlsLs on slLe should be complled.
SulLable maLerlal can be reused for Lhe consLrucLlon. Some may have Lo be removed
and sLored Lemporarlly before belng LransplanLed back. Lndemlc specles are
preferred because Lhey are adapLed Lo Lhe slLe and have a hlgher change of
propagaLlon and a have a beLLer llkellhood of supporLlng exlsLlng fauna
communlLles.
9.2.3 Determ|ne kequ|red arameter
9.2.3.1 N-va|ues
1he Cauckler-Mannlng formula ls commonly used for esLlmaLlng waLer flow veloclLy
ln an open channel, and sLaLes LhaL:
where:
ls Lhe cross-secLlonal average veloclLy (m/s)
ls a converslon consLanL equal Lo 1.0
ls Lhe Cauckler-Mannlng coefflclenL
ls Lhe hydraullc radlus (m)
ls Lhe slope of Lhe waLer surface or Lhe llnear hydraullc head loss (m/m)
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-6
1he Gauck|er-Mann|ng coeff|c|ent, ofLen denoLed as n, ls an emplrlcally derlved
coefflclenL and ls lnversely proporLlonaLe Lo Lhe veloclLy of Lhe waLer flow.
1he followlng are some Lyplcal n-values for varlous Lypes of channels:
1ype of channe| and descr|pt|on M|n|mum Norma| Max|mum
llood plalns (pasLure, shorL grass) 0.023 0.030 0.033
Mlnor sLreams (clean, sLralghL, no rlfLs) 0.023 0.030 0.033
LxcavaLed channel
(sLony boLLom, weedy banks)
0.023 0.033 0.040
Lach speclflc bloenglneerlng Lechnlque would have a correspondlng n-value and
would affecL Lhe flow of waLer dlfferenLly. n-va|ues are a funcLlon of boLh Lhe
speclflc bloenglneerlng Lechnlques deployed and Lhe Lype of vegeLaLlon used.
9.2.3.2 S|ope and r|g|d|ty
8loenglneerlng Lechnlques have varylng rlgldlLles and sLablllzaLlon capablllLles. 1he
followlng ls a rough grouplng of Lhe Lechnlques shown ln Lhls chapLer, accordlng Lo
Lhelr sulLablllLy ln sLablllzlng slopes of varylng gradlenLs.
k|ver 8ed
8ock gablon maL
1ree sLumps wlLh cuLLlng
8ock slll
Gent|e S|ope
egged geo-LexLlle wlLh fasclnes
egged geo-LexLlle wlLh reed roll
Moderate S|ope
8rush MaLLress
SLone-wall / 8lp-rap wlLh cuLLlng
Wrapped soll llfL
Steep S|ope
Log crlb wall
vegeLaLed relnforced soll
Cablon wall
lasclnes and reed rolls are deslgned Lo be applled Lo Lhe lnLerface beLween Lhe
embankmenL and Lhe waLer. 1hey prevenL Lurbulence aL Lhese edges and Lhus
proLecL Lhe slope from eroslon. 1hey are Lyplcally used ln comblnaLlons wlLh geo-
LexLlle and brush maLLresses.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-7
9.2.4 Determ|ne 1echn|ques
8efer Lo SecLlon 9.3 for a deLalled consLrucLlon sequence of dlfferenL Lechnlques.
9.2.S Spec|f|cat|ons
8efer Lo SecLlon 9.3 for elemenLs and maLerlal needed for speclflc Lechnlques.
9.2.6 Ma|ntenance
As long as approprlaLe condlLlons for planL growLh ls malnLalned, bloenglneerlng
appllcaLlons are dynamlcally susLalned, self-regulaLed, and enhanced wlLhouL Lhe need
for excesslve malnLenance. 1he deepenlng of Lhe rooLs over Llme lmproves soll
sLablllzaLlon, and Lhe lnLenslflcaLlon of planL growLh adds soll coverage and shade.
unllke hard sLrucLures, however, bloenglneered waLerways comprlse of llve, dynamlc
and loose elemenLs. 8edrock movemenLs (e.g. sLones and pebbles moved and carrled
along by hlgh waLer veloclLy) and sedlmenLaLlon (debrls and sllLs generaLed from eroded
rocks, planL damage and degeneraLlon) ls a naLural parL of Lhe rlver. erlodlcally buL
lnfrequenLly, mlnor malnLenance (replacemenL of dlsplaced rocks, Lrlmmlng of planLs Lo
prevenL breakage eLc.) ls necessary. MalnLenance reglme should lnclude Lhe followlng:
|ant estab||shment per|od:
lL ls lmporLanL LhaL cuLLlngs are kepL shorL ln Lhe beglnnlng so LhaL lL does noL
geL uprooLed and washed away by sLrong rlver flows. Accompanylng sLrucLures
could also be damaged ln Lhe process.
WaLerlng of Lrees and shrubs lmmedlaLely afLer planLlng. 1hey should conLlnue
Lo be waLered aL leasL once a day for aL leasL four Lo elghL weeks, or unLll Lhe
planLs are well esLabllshed. erlodlc waLerlng afLer LhaL may be necessary.
LrecLlon of Lemporary fenclng, guards, barrlcades, supporLs and neLLlng as
necessary Lo proLecL Lhe planLs / Lrees / Lurf.
After p|ant estab||shment:
WaLerlng and replacemenL of dead, unhealLhy, undeslrable planLs, Lrees,
sapllngs, shrubs and Lurf
8eplacemenL of planL guards / sLakes lf any.
roper prunlng, Lrlmmlng, weedlng and clearlng of unwanLed growLh as requlred
In the un||ke|y event of s|ope fa||ure:
Survey and analyze reason for fallure
ueLermlne a more sulLable / more rlgld bloenglneerlng Lechnlque
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-8
Apply Lroslon ConLrol Measures (LCM) Lo cordon off affecLed area lf Lhere ls a
LhreaL of furLher eroslon
Apply necessary slLe remedlaLlon
8emove LCM
9.3 1LCnNIULS
9.3.1 LCG CkI8WALL WI1n 8kUSn LALkS
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
Logs
o Specles: hardwood and sofLwood
o unLreaLed
o 13-23 cm dlameLer (round or square)
o arallel logs: 80-100 cm long, basal ends
o olnLed logs: 30-80 cm long, one polnLed end
cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (40-100 cm), ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
llve brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m)
rooLed, woody planLs
o Specles:
llll
Cravel
lasLeners
sLeel nalls and rods
cramp lron
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-9
Insta||at|on:
1. lace a layer of branches (sloplng back agalnsL Lhe sLream edge and proLrudlng ouL lnLo Lhe
waLer) aL Lhe Loe of Lhe crlb wall. 1hls has Lo be [usL below mean hlgh waLer level. 1hls layer
ls for prevenLlng scours aL Lhe sLream edge.
2. urlve a llne of polnLed logs almosL verLlcally along Lhe sLream bed edge, sllghLly lncllned
Lowards Lhe slope.
3. Lay a layer of logs perpendlcular Lo and leanlng agalnsL Lhe flrsL layer of polnLed logs,
parallel Lo Lhe sLream flow. 1hls layer should be submerged aL mean waLer level.
4. urlve anoLher layer of polnLed logs lnLo Lhe slope, Lhls Llme sloplng Lowards Lhe sLream aL a
13-30 degrees angle. 1hese cuLLlngs should resL on Lhe logs runnlng parallel Lo Lhe sLream,
and are spaced aL abouL 2m aparL. 1hls can be expedlLed wlLh an excavaLor.
3. arallel logs can be noLched Lo help lnLerlocklng. Ad[acenL layers of logs are Lhen flxed uslng
fasLeners.
6. ack Lhe remnanL spaces beLween Lhe lnLerlocklng logs wlLh cuLLlngs, llve brush, rooLed
planLs (approx. 13-20 sLems per llnear meLre) and flll compacLed Lo approx. 83 procLor
denslLy.
7. 8epeaL sLep 2-3 unLll Lhe deslred helghL.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-10
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-11
9.3.2 kI kA WI1n CU11INGS
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (80-100 cm), and dlameLer (3-10 cm)
o ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
o Specles:
SLones
naLural sLone or concreLe rubble (average dlameLer 13 - 30 cm)
lllLer maLerlal under and ln beLween sLone layer: sand-gravel mlxLure (0-200 mm)
Insta||at|on:
1. Crade Lhe slope smooLhly Lo deslred angle, as shown ln slLe plan and/or secLlon.
2. Spread an even layer of fllLer maLerlal (approx. 20 cm) on graded slope.
3. lace sLones on Lhe fllLer layer. Ad[usL sLones by hand Lo ensure dense lnLerlocklng. Layer of
sLones musL be aL leasL 30cm Lhlck.
4. SlmulLaneously drlve Lhe cuLLlngs lnLo Lhe ground as sLones are ad[usLed and lald, maklng
sure LhaL Lhey are securely locked ln beLween Lhe sLones. Approx. 3 cuLLlngs should be
drlven every m
2
of sLone. CuLLlngs should noL proLrude more Lhan 10 cm above Lhe sLone
layer.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-12
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-13
9.3.3 8kUSn MA11kLSS WI1n LIVL IASCINL
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
llve brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m) and dlameLer (??)
long wooden poles for presslng down and aLLachlng branches Lo Lhe slope
lasLeners
wlre
long, wooden sLakes
llll
SulLable flll or excavaLed soll
Insta||at|on of Iasc|ne:
1. CaLher and arrange llve brush such LhaL Lhey are allgned ln Lhe same dlrecLlon.
AL every 80-100 cm, Lle wlres around Lhem Lo creaLe bundles of approx. 30-40
cm dlameLer. Lnsure LhaL Lhese llve fasclnes are dense and LlghLly bound and
LhaL Lhe ends Laper.
2. ulg a Lrench along Lhe boLLom of Lhe brush maLLress appllcaLlon. 1hls should be
aL Lhe mean waLer level. Lnsure LhaL Lhere ls a gradual LranslLlon beLween Lhe
slope and Lhe Lrench by Laperlng off Lhe upper secLlon of Lhe Lrench. 1he Lrench
should also be locaLed and angled ln such a way LhaL Lhe fasclne placed ln lL wlll
evenLually be half covered wlLh waLer and half wlLh soll.
3. lace a layer of dead brush ln Lhe Lrench, proLrudlng approx. 20-30 cm lnLo Lhe
waLer Lo prevenL scour aL Lhe Loe of Lhe appllcaLlon.
4. lace Lhe fasclne on Lop of Lhls layer of dead brush and secure lL ln place by
drlvlng long wooden sLakes ln a sLaggered paLLern. 1hls would prevenL lL from
floaLlng.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-14
Insta||at|on of 8rush Mattress:
3. Crade Lhe slope Lo deslred angle.
6. lace llve brush along Lhe slope, wlLh Lhe boLLom end polnLlng Lowards Lhe sLream and
Lucked under Lhe fasclnes ln Lhe Lrench, whlle Lhe Llp ls polnLlng up-slope. 1hese should
be arranged aL a denslLy of approx. 20-30 sLems per llnear meLre.
7. urlve long wooden sLakes ln a grld paLLern across Lhe enLlre area of lald llve bush, wlLh
rows runnlng parallel Lo Lhe sLream. 1he rows should sLarL 1 m above Lhe llve fasclne
and conLlnue aL 1 m lnLervals beLween each row.
8. Lay long wooden poles parallel Lo Lhe sLream agalnsL Lhese sLakes, formlng rows of
poles for presslng down Lhe llve bush.
9. Secure Lhe poles and sLakes Lo Lhe ground by wlrlng lL down. 1hls ls done by Lylng one
end of Lhe wlre Lo Lhe boLLom of a sLake, weavlng Lhe wlre above and below Lhe llve
brush, and Lhen Lylng Lhe oLher end of Lhe wlre Lo Lhe boLLom of anoLher sLake. Cnce
Lhe wlre ls secured, Lhe sLake ls drlven anoLher 2-3 cm lnLo Lhe ground Lo ensure LhaL lL
ls LauL.
10. Cnce all Lhe poles and sLakes are wlred down, spread a Lhln layer of fllm over Lhe enLlre
maLLress, lncludlng Lhe fasclne. Powever, ensure LhaL Lhe LreaLmenL ls noL excesslvely
covered. 1hls ls Lo prevenL Lhe brush from drylng ouL, buL should noL sLlfle lL.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-13
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-16
9.3.4 GLC1Lk1ILL-WkALD SCIL LII1
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
llve brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m)
rooLed, woody planLs
o Specles:
CeoLexLlle
CoconuL flbre maLs, 700-900 g/m
2
lasLeners
ShorL sLakes
o hard wood specles
o ulmenslons: 2-4 cm dlameLer (round or square), 30-30 cm long
o Cne end polnLed for easy drlvlng
llll
SulLable flll and gravel
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-17
Insta||at|on:
1. LxcavaLe a lengLh of shelf of approx. wldLh 1 m along Lhe boLLom of Lhe sLream wall. Lnsure
LhaL lL ls sloped sllghL back Lowards Lhe slope.
2. lace a layer of branches (sloplng back agalnsL Lhe sLream edge and proLrudlng approx. 20-
30 cm ouL lnLo Lhe waLer) aL Lhe Loe of Lhe soll-llfL appllcaLlon. 1hls has Lo be [usL below
mean hlgh waLer level. 1hls layer ls for prevenLlng scours aL Lhe sLream edge.
3. Secure geoLexLlle along Lhe enLlre lengLh of Lhls shelf uslng shorL sLakes drlven Lhrough Lhe
geoLexLlle and lnLo Lhe ground aL Lhe edge of Lhls excavaLlon. Lnsure LhaL Lhere ls a
mlnlmum of 20 cm of overlap beLween ad[olnlng sLrlps of geoLexLlle and LhaL a sufflclenL
lengLh of each geoLexLlle sLrlp overhangs Lo laLer wrap over Lhe soll-llfL.
4. lace and moderaLely compacL flll maLerlals (soll-gravel-mlx), Lo a helghL of approx. 30-70
cm, on Lop of Lhe geoLexLlle.
3. ull Lhe overhanglng geoLexLlle and wrap lL over Lhe flll maLerlal, securlng lL aL Lhe Lop by
drlvlng shorL wooden sLakes Lhrough Lhe back end of Lhe fabrlc and lnLo Lhe compacLed flll,
formlng a c-proflled soll-llfL.
6. lace llve brush and rooLed planLs densely (approx. 20 sLems per llnear meLre) on Lhe soll
llfL, before coverlng lL wlLh a layer of soll maLerlal (approx. 20 cm). uo noL lnclude any gravel
ln Lhls layer.
7. 8epeaL sLeps 3-6, bulldlng up layers of soll llfL, unLll Lhe deslred helghL ls achleved.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-18
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-19
9.3.S IASCINL WI1n GLC1Lk1ILL
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
Llve buL non-sprouLlng brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m)
CeoLexLlle
A varleLy of coconuL flbre and [uLe maLs (400-900 g)
lasLeners
Wlre
Long and shorL wooden sLakes
llll
SulLable flll or excavaLed soll
Insta||at|on of Iasc|ne:
1. CaLher and arrange llve and dead brush such LhaL Lhey are allgned ln Lhe same
dlrecLlon. AL every 80-100 cm, Lle wlres around Lhem Lo creaLe bundles of
approx. 30-40 cm dlameLer and no less Lhan 4 m long. Lnsure LhaL Lhese llve
fasclnes are dense and LlghLly bound, and LhaL Lhe ends Laper.
2. ulg a Lrench along Lhe edge of Lhe sLream, aL Lhe mean waLer level. Lnsure LhaL
Lhere ls a gradual LranslLlon beLween Lhe slope and Lhe Lrench by Laperlng off
Lhe upper secLlon of Lhe Lrench. 1he Lrench should also be locaLed and angled ln
such a way LhaL Lhe fasclne placed ln lL wlll evenLually be half covered wlLh waLer
and half wlLh soll.
3. CpLlonal: place a layer of dead brush ln Lhe Lrench, proLrudlng approx. 20-30 cm
lnLo Lhe waLer Lo prevenL scour aL Lhe Loe of Lhe appllcaLlon.
4. lace Lhe fasclne on Lop of Lhls layer of dead brush and secure lL ln place by
drlvlng long wooden sLakes ln a sLaggered paLLern. 1hls would prevenL lL from
floaLlng.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-20
Insta||at|on of Geotext||e:
3. Crade Lhe slope Lo deslred angle. repare Lhe soll and scaLLer Lhe seeds.
6. Secure Lhe Lop edge by sLaklng lL lnLo a Lrench (of approx. 13 x 13 cm), afLer whlch lL ls
back-fllled and compacLed. use 3 small wooden sLakes per meLre run or accordlng Lo
Lhe manufacLurer's recommendaLlon.
7. Secure Lhe boLLom edge elLher by slmllarly anchorlng lL Lo a Lrench, or by Lucklng lL
under Lhe fasclne.
8. Lay eroslon conLrol fabrlcs over Lhe enLlre appllcaLlon, ensurlng a 10-13 cm overlap
beLween ad[acenL sLrlps of fabrlc. AL 30 cm lnLervals along Lhe overlapplng seams, sLake
boLh layers of fabrlc lnLo Lhe ground uslng shorL wooden sLakes, or accordlng Lo Lhe
manufacLurer's recommendaLlon.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-21
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-22
9.3.6 MUL1ILL IASCINLS
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
Llve and/or dead brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m)
CeoLexLlle
A varleLy of coconuL flbre and [uLe maLs
lasLeners
Wlre
Long and shorL wooden sLakes
llll
SulLable soll or excavaLed soll
Insta||at|on of Iasc|ne:
1. CaLher and arrange llve and dead brush such LhaL Lhey are allgned ln Lhe same
dlrecLlon. AL every 80-100 cm, Lle wlres around Lhem Lo creaLe bundles of
approx. 30-40 cm dlameLer and no less Lhan 4 m long. Lnsure LhaL Lhese llve
fasclnes are dense and LlghLly bound, and LhaL Lhe ends Laper.
2. ulg a Lrench along Lhe edge of Lhe sLream, aL Lhe mean waLer level. Lnsure LhaL
Lhere ls a gradual LranslLlon beLween Lhe slope and Lhe Lrench by Laperlng off
Lhe upper secLlon of Lhe Lrench. 1he Lrench should also be locaLed and angled ln
such a way LhaL Lhe fasclne placed ln lL wlll evenLually be half covered wlLh waLer
and half wlLh soll.
3. CpLlonal: place a layer of dead brush ln Lhe Lrench, proLrudlng approx. 20-30 cm
lnLo Lhe waLer Lo prevenL scour aL Lhe Loe of Lhe appllcaLlon.
4. lace Lhe fasclne on Lop of Lhls layer of dead brush and secure lL ln place by
drlvlng long wooden sLakes ln a sLaggered paLLern. 1hls would prevenL lL from
floaLlng.
3. Cover Lhese fasclnes wlLh a layer of flll Lo form a sllghLly backward-sloplng shelf
of approx. WldLh 70-100 cm.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-23
6. Lay a layer of llve brush densely (approx. 20 sLems per llnear meLre) ln a crlss-
cross paLLern on Lhls sLep.
7. SLake Lhe nexL level of fasclnes on Lhls layer of brush Lo form Lhe deslred slope
for Lhe sLream edge.
8. 8epeaL sLeps 3-7 unLll Lhe deslred helghL and slope ls achleved.
Insta||at|on of Geotext||e:
1. Cover Lhe remalnlng areas of slope wlLh geoLexLlle, accordlng Lo Lhe lnsLrucLlons
speclfled ln lASClnL Wl1P CLC1Lx1lLL."
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-24
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-23
9.3.7 kLLD kCLL
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
Perbaceous plugs
o Specles:
CeoLexLlle
CoconuL llbre maLs (700 g/m
2
)
lasLeners
ShorL and long wooden sLakes
llll
SulLable soll or excavaLed soll
Insta||at|on:
1. ulg a Lrench of approx. 30 x 30 cm along Lhe sLream edge.
2. urlve long, wooden sLakes along Lhe sLream edge of Lhls Lrench. 1hese wlll
form Lhe edge of Lhe reed roll, and should be drlven Lwo-Lhlrds of Lhelr
lengLhs verLlcally lnLo Lhe ground, spaced aL 100-120 cm lnLervals.
3. Lay one end of Lhe geoLexLlle ln Lhe Lrench, wlLh Lhe long slde faclng Lhe
sLream. 1hen flll Lhe Lrench Lo half lLs depLh wlLh flll maLerlal.
4. lace planL plugs and/or sod ln Lhe Lrench aL a spaclng of 3-3 planLs per llnear
meLre (dependlng on specles slze).
3. lold Lhe geoLexLlle over Lhls llne of planLs plugs Lo form a roll of approx. 30-
80 cm dlameLer. Secure lL ln place uslng shorL wooden sLakes.
6. lanL plugs and/or sod aL remalnlng area on Lhe slope aL approx. 4-3 planLs /
m
2
.
7. LxLend Lhe geoLexLlle LhaL ls sLlll aLLached Lo Lhe reed roll over Lhe slope Lo
cover Lhe enLlre planLed area. Secure lL ln place uslng shorL sLakes aL approx.
4 sLakes /m
2
, ensurlng LhaL Lhere ls a mlnlmum of 20-30 cm overlap beLween
ad[acenL sLrlps of geoLexLlle. ulg Lhe loose end of Lhe geoLexLlle lnLo Lhe
ground aL Lhe Lop of Lhe slope.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-26
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-27
9.3.8 S1CNL WALL WI1n CU11INGS
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
10 cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (80-100 cm), and dlameLer (3-10 cm)
10.3 ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
10.4 Specles:
SLones
naLural sLone or concreLe rubble (average dlameLer 30- 60 cm)
lllLer maLerlal under and behlnd sLone wall: sand-gravel mlxLure (0-200 mm)
llll
SulLable flll and gravel
Insta||at|on:
1. Spread and compacL an even layer of fllLer maLerlal (approx. 20 cm) on graded slope.
2. lace sLones on Lhe fllLer layer, formlng a sllghLly back-lncllned wall (Lowards Lhe slope).
Ad[usL sLones by hand Lo ensure dense lnLerlocklng buL avoldlng cross-[olnLs.
3. SlmulLaneously place cuLLlngs ln Lhe gaps beLween Lhe sLones as Lhey are belng lald and
ad[usLed, maklng sure LhaL Lhey are sllghLly angled back lnLo Lhe slope and, aL Lhe same
Llme, securely locked ln beLween Lhe sLones. Approx. 3 cuLLlngs should be drlven every m
2
of sLone. CuLLlngs should noL proLrude more Lhan 10 cm beyond Lhe sLone layer.
4. llll Lhe gaps beLween Lhe sLones wlLh flll maLerlal.
3. 8ackflll Lhe wall wlLh gravel and fllLer maLerlal Lo faclllLaLe dralnage.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-28
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-29
9.3.9 GA8ICNS WI1n 8kUSn LALkS
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
Cablons
Cublc wlre mesh conLalners
ulmenslons: 100 cm (W) x 100 cm (L) x 100 cm (P)
Wlre mesh - galvanlzed sLeel wlre, spoL-welded, 4-3 mm dlameLer, 430n/m Lenslle
sLrengLh, mesh openlng 10 x 10 cm
Sub[ecL Lo SuperlnLendlng Cfflcer's approval
lanLs
10 cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (40-100 cm) , ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
11 llve brush of approprlaLe lengLh (2-3 m)
12 rooLed, woody planLs
12.3 Specles:
SLones
Cablon flller: naLural sLone or concreLe rubble (average dlameLer 13 - 20 cm)
lllLer maLerlal under and behlnd gablon: sand-gravel mlxLure (0-200 mm)
lllLer fabrlc
polypropylene geo-LexLlle, non-woven needle-punched
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-30
Insta||at|on:
1. Crade Lhe slope of Lhe sLream edge wlLh levels of sLeps / shelves of abouL 100 cm
hlgh and 40-80 cm wlde each. 1hese should be sllghLly sloplng backwards, away
from Lhe rlver, and Lhe flrsL sLep should sLarL below Lhe sLream bed level.
2. Lvenly spread a 13-20 cm layer of fllLer maLerlal (sand gravel mlxLure) on Lhe
sLepped proflle. CompacL Lhls layer of fllLer maLerlal before laylng fllLer fabrlc on
Lop, ensurlng a 10-13 cm overlap beLween ad[acenL lengLhs of fllLer fabrlc.
3. lace each wlre mesh baskeL LlghLly nexL Lo each oLher on Lhe lowermosL level, buL
malnLalnlng a 3-10 cm gap from Lhe back, away from Lhe graded sLream edge. 8ack-
flll Lhe gap behlnd wlLh fllLer maLerlal.
4. Spread a 20 cm layer of soll maLerlal on Lop of Lhls level of gablon and pack planL
maLerlal densely Lo form a brush layer on Lop. ConsLrucL Lhe nexL level of gablon on
Lop of Lhe Lhls brush layer (accordlng Lo sLep 3), sllghLly sLepped back and ensurlng
LhaL Lhe planL maLerlal sLlll proLrudes ouL from ln beLween Lhe 2 levels of gablon.
3. 8epeaL sLep 4 unLll Lhe gablon wall reaches Lhe sLream bank.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-31
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-32
9.3.10 VLGL1A1LD kLINICkCLD SCIL
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
8elnforclng Cage
SLeel mesh cage
ulmenslons: 60 cm hlgh x 60 cm wlde, angled on sLream-faclng edge Lo deslred
proflle
SLeel braces aL varlous polnLs for relnforcemenL
L.g. 1exLomur sysLem or equlvalenL
CeoLexLlles
Soll-reLalnlng
o Ceo-synLheLlc fabrlc
o Llne Lhe lnslde face of sLeel mesh Lo reLaln flll wlLhln relnforclng cage
8elnforclng fllLer fabrlc
o SeparaLlng layer beLween sLeel meshes
Seeded blo-degradable geoLexLlle
o AlLernaLlve for hydro-seedlng
o naLlve seek mlx embedded lnLo Lhe LexLlle
lanLs
naLlve seed mlx (scaLLered ln Lhe soll mlx or embedded ln geoLexLlle)
cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (80-100 cm), and dlameLer (3-10 cm)
o ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
lasLeners
SLeel securlng plns (accordlng Lo manufacLurer's recommendaLlon)
llll
SulLable flll
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-33
Insta||at|on:
1. Crade a sLep of approx. 60 cm wlde aL Lhe sLream edge, rlghL below Lhe bed level.
2. Lay Lhe fllLer fabrlc on Lhls sLep
3. lnsLall Lhe relnforclng cages on Lhe sLep uslng securlng plns aL approx. 4 plns / m
2
.
4. Llne Lhe lnner face of Lhe sLeel mesh relnforclng cage wlLh geosynLheLlc fabrlc,
ensurlng LhaL Lhere ls an overlap of 10-20 cm beLween ad[acenL sLrlps of fabrlc, and
LhaL each sLrlp lap over Lhe Lop of Lhe mesh.
3. llx Lhe sLeel braces ln place Lo supporL Lhe cage durlng soll fllllng and compacLlon.
(refer Lo manufacLurer's lnsLrucLlons for brace lnsLallaLlon)
6. Layer flll maLerlals on Lhe slop slde of Lhe cage, compacLlng lL aL every level, unLll Lhe
soll llfL reaches a helghL of approx. 30 cm.
7. lold Lhe fabrlc LhaL ls lapplng aL Lhe Lop of Lhe cage over Lhls 30 cm soll llfL.
8. 8epeaL sLeps 2-7 unLll Lhe deslred embankmenL helghL ls achleved. 1here should be
an overlap of approx. 10 cm beLween each level of relnforclng cage.
9. urlve cuLLlngs lnLo Lhe relnforced soll llfLs, and hydro-seed Lhe surface of Lhe
geoLexLlle. AlLernaLlvely a seeded blodegradable geoLexLlle could have been
lnsLalled as a layer beLween Lhe sLeel mesh cage and Lhe geosynLheLlc fabrlc.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-34
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-33
9.3.11 1kLL S1UMS WI1n CU11ING
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
1ree sLumps
o varylng specles
o varylng slzes
CuLLlngs / llve poles
o Approx. 100-200 cm long
SLone
naLural sLone or concreLe rubble
o Approx. 300-600 mm dlameLer
lasLeners
Wlre
Long wooden sLakes
Insta||at|on:
1. Lay a layer of sLone along Lhe Loe of Lhe sLream bank, rlghL below Lhe mean waLer
level.
2. urlve Lhe Lree sLumps sllghLly lncllned upslde-down lnLo Lhe banks, so LhaL Lhe rooL
wads cover Lhe slope, unLll approx. 80 of Lhe slope area ls covered by rooL wads.
3. urlve long sLakes and cuLLlngs / llve poles ln beLween Lhe rooLs Lo secure Lhe rooL
wads lnLo Lhe ground.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-36
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-37
CCk GA8ICN MA1
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
Cablon MaL
Cublc wlre mesh conLalners
ulmenslons: 100 cm (W) x 30 cm (L) x 30 cm (P)
Wlre mesh - galvanlzed sLeel wlre, spoL-welded, 4-3 mm dlameLer, 430n/m Lenslle
sLrengLh, mesh openlng 10 x 10 cm
Sub[ecL Lo SuperlnLendlng Cfflcer's approval
SLone
naLural sLone or concreLe rubble
o Approx. 130-300 mm dlameLer
lasLeners
Calvanlzed Wlre (accordlng Lo manufacLurer's recommendaLlon)
SLeel plns (accordlng Lo necesslLy)
Insta||at|on:
1. Crade Lhe sLream bed Lo deslred proflle. 1hen excavaLe aL exLra 30 cm below
deslred bed level Lo accommodaLe gablon maLs.
2. lnsLall wlre mesh conLalners slde by slde and ln rows Lo flll Lhe graded surface,
ensurlng mlnlmum gap beLween Lhem.
3. llll Lhe wlre mesh conLalners wlLh sLone and close Lhem securely uslng galvanlzed
wlre or accordlng Lo manufacLurer's recommendaLlon.
4. Secure Lhe Lop row of gablon maL Lo Lhe lower ones by weavlng galvanlzed wlres
beLween Lhem.
3. SLake Lhe gablon maL Lo Lhe ground uslng sLeel plns for added sLablllLy lf necessary.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-38
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-39
9.3.13 kCCk SILL
L|ements ] Mater|a|s:
lanLs
13 cuLLlngs of approprlaLe lengLh (80-100 cm), and dlameLer (3-10 cm)
13.3 ends polnLed for easy drlvlng
SLones
naLural sLone (average dlameLer 30-80 cm)
lllLer maLerlal under rock slll:
o sand-gravel mlxLure (0-200 mm)
o alLernaLlve: concreLe C12 / 13
Cap-flller beLween sLones:
o sand-gravel mlxLure (0-200 mm)
llll
SulLable flll
Insta||at|on:
1. Lay a layer of approx. 20 cm Lhlck of fllLer maLerlal ln an arch shape (arched
agalnsL Lhe sLream flow dlrecLlon) aL a deslred locaLlon crosslng Lhe sLream. 1he
wldLh of Lhe arch should be approx. 130 - 200 cm.
2. lace large sLones uprlghL on Lop of Lhls layer of fllLer maLerlal, followlng Lhe arch
shape and wldLh, ensurlng LhaL Lhey form a sLable, lnLerlocklng sLrucLure.
3. 1hls arch of sLones musL proLrude ouL lnLo elLher banks by aL leasL 30 cm. 1hls
proLrudlng parL should be compleLely embedded ln Lhe bank.
4. urlve planL cuLLlngs ln beLween Lhe sLones around Lhe LranslLlon areas beLween
Lhe sLream bed and banks.
3. llll Lhe remalnlng gaps beLween Lhe sLones wlLh gravel. llll Lhe exposed sLones aL
banks wlLh flll.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-40
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-41
9. 4 CASL S1UD: kALLANG kIVLk 8ISnAN Akk
Cver Lhe years, Slngapore has developed a neLwork of waLer bodles Lo fulfll Lhe funcLlonal
needs of caLchmenL, dlsLrlbuLlon and purlflcaLlon. 1he longesL rlver ln Slngapore, Lhe 10-km
long kallang 8lver plays a cruclal role ln Lhls pervaslve neLwork of 14 reservolrs, 32 ma[or
rlvers, and more Lhan 7,000 kllomeLres of canals and dralns.
lor a sLreLch of abouL 3 km, Lhls rlver passes Lhrough 8lshan ark, one of Lhe blggesL and
mosL popular reglonal parks ln Slngapore. lL has Lhe same number of dally vlslLors as Lhe
8oLanlcal Cardens of Slngapore, buL Lhe poLenLlal for Lhe rlver Lo be beLLer-uLlllzed for
recreaLlonal acLlvlLles ls currenLly noL meL as lL ls hldden from vlew and Lakes Lhe form of a
hard concreLe canal wlLh fences on one slde of Lhe park. As Lhls canal ls locaLed
downsLream of Lhe overflow of Lwo large reservolrs, Lhe waLer level can drasLlcally change
wlLhln a shorL perlod of Llme, parLlcularly ln Slngapore's Lroplcal cllmaLe wlLh lLs exLreme
sLorm evenLs. Pence, lL has, up unLll mosL recenLly, been consldered dangerous and
lnapproprlaLe for recreaLlonal acLlvlLles.
ln 2007, a Leam of consulLanLs, comprlslng of ALeller urelselLl, CP2M Plll, CelLz & arLner
C88 were employed by Lhe Slngapore naLlonal arks 8oard (narks) and ubllc uLllllLles
8oard (u8) Lo propose, and evenLually lmplemenL, a new deslgn for Lhe park LhaL would
faclllLaLe Lhe lnLeracLlon of Lhe publlc wlLh Lhe rlver.
1he lnvolvemenL of Lhe varlous consulLanLs, wlLh Lhelr many years of experlence and
experLlse, has afflrmed LhaL Lhe LransformaLlon of Lhls concreLe canal lnLo a naLural rlver
wlLh landscaped bank could lmprove Lhe quallLy of Lhe sLream on varlous levels, of whlch
safe accesslblllLy and ecologlcal-susLalnablllLy are buL some of many beneflLs.
As a general sLraLegy, planLs acL as reLenLlon sysLem LhaL slows down Lhe waLer flow. AL Lhe
wldesL polnL of Lhe park, Lhe course of Lhe sLream ls meandered / dlverLed Lo slow down
Lhe flow of Lhe rlver. lL ls also aL Lhls polnL LhaL Lhe rlver ls wldened and Lhe banks made
much more genLle Lo allow Lhe publlc Lo walk down Lhe banks and en[oy Lhe slow, wlndlng
sLream.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-42
1he deslgn of Lhls sLream employs mlnlmal, lf any, hardscape. 1he banks of Lhe rlver ls
compleLely relnforced uslng varlous Lechnlques of blo-englneerlng, dependlng on Lhe slope
of Lhe banks, Lhe planLlng scheme, as well as Lhe Lype and lnLenslLy of recreaLlonal acLlvlLles
ad[acenL Lo lL.
rlor Lo Lhe consLrucLlon of Lhe maln rlver, a LesL reach was consLrucLed Lo LesL ouL Lhe
varlous bloenglneerlng Lechnlques whlch would evenLually be employed all over Lhe park.
As a general sLraLegy, planLs acL as reLenLlon sysLem LhaL slows down Lhe waLer flow. AL Lhe
wldesL polnL of Lhe park, Lhe course of Lhe sLream ls meandered / dlverLed Lo slow down
Lhe flow of Lhe rlver. lL ls also aL Lhls polnL LhaL Lhe rlver ls wldened and Lhe banks made
much more genLle Lo allow Lhe publlc Lo walk down Lhe banks and en[oy Lhe slow, wlndlng
sLream.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-43
ArLlsL's lmpresslons above are LhaL of kallang 8lver-8lshan ark, showlng Lhe lnLegraLlon of
Lhe naLurallsed canal wlLh Lhe park. WlLh Lhe LransformaLlon of Lhe concreLe canal Lo a
naLural rlver, new waLerfronL communlLy and recreaLlonal spaces are creaLed for Lhe publlc
Lo en[oy.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-44
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-43
A deLalled slLe survey was conducLed, and landscape speclallsLs were engaged Lo ldenLlfy
exlsLlng planLs specles, glve speclflc advlce on LransplanLlng and conservaLlons durlng Lhe
consLrucLlon phase, as well as recommend approprlaLe specles for new planLlngs. (8efer Lo
planL llsL for specles speclflc Lo bloenglneerlng).
ulscusslons wlLh Lhe bloenglneer and clvll englneer ylelded an approprlaLe meLhod of
LranslLlonlng beLween Lhe concreLe channel Lo Lhe naLurallzed rlver, as shown ln Lhe
dlagram below.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-46
Mode||ng & s|mu|at|on tests
ueLalled calculaLlon and modellng was carrled ouL Lo ensure LhaL Lhe rlver proflles and
hydraullc deslgn of Lhe rlver would meeL Lhe safeLy sLandards and Lhe carrylng capaclLy as
requlred by governmenL agencles. LocaLlons of hydraullc sLresses are also ldenLlfled, as
lnpuL for Lhe appllcaLlon of bloenglneerlng deslgn.
1he waLer flow and waLer levels correspondlng Lo dlfferenL n-values were graphed ouL ln
order Lo deLermlne Lhe opLlmal n-value Lo be used ln Lhe rlver proflles. ApproprlaLe
bloenglneerlng Lechnlques and planL specles are Lhen selecLed, Laklng Lhelr roughness
coefflclenLs and slope-sLablllzaLlon capablllLles lnLo conslderaLlon.
Chart showing simulation of river flow and water levels in relation to different n-values for
the existing and proposed Kallang River.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-47
1est keach Imp|ementat|on
A LesL reach was consLrucLed on-slLe Lo LesL ouL Lhe varlous bloenglneerlng Lechnlques
whlch would evenLually be employed ln Lhe kallang 8lver / 8lshan ark redevelopmenL
pro[ecL. 1he followlng plan and secLlons show Lhe varlous Lechnlques belng lmplemenLed ln
Lhe LesL reach.
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-48
SecLlon A-A
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-49
SecLlon 8-8
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-30
SecLlon C-C
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-31
Sect|on D-D
Sect|on L-L
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-32
SecLlon l-l
SecLlon C-C
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-33
1est keach - Se|ect|on of p|ant mater|a|
1he planLs for Lhe LesL bed are selecLed carefully. 1he followlng parameLer was lmporLanL
for Lhe selecLlon of Lhe planLs:
CooJ sptootloq cbotoctetlstlcs ftom cottloqs boseJ oo lltetotote tecotJ ot petsoool
expetleoce
wotet-lovloq, wotetloq-toletoot ooJ tlvet/coostol ploots
Avolloblllty ftom Nlotks
Notlve ploot
Cood sprouLlng characLerlsLlc from cuLLlng ls essenLlal as Lhe planLs should fulflll Lhe
funcLlon of slope sLablllzaLlon uslng Lhelr rooL sysLem. 1he use of cuLLlng ls a more cosL
effecLlve for lmplemenLaLlon compared Lo use of whole planL ln such a large scale pro[ecL.
WaLer-lovlng, waLerlog-reslsLanL and rlver/coasLal planLs are more llkely Lo survlve and do
well ln prolong or perlodlc floodlng condlLlon, a condlLlon LhaL ls expecLed of Lhe LesL bed
and Lhe real lmplemenLaLlon slLe. Cn Lhe dryer slde of Lhe LesL reach, less waLerlog-LoleranL
specles can be used.
As mosL of Lhe specles selecLed are noL common commerclally avallable, boLh ln Lerms of
Lhe large quanLlLy and slze requlred, only Lhose wlLh avallablllLy from narks have been
chosen.
Spec|es
1he followlng Lable shows Lhe specles whlch are lnsLalled ln Lhe dlfferenL LesL areas and are
selecLed based on Lhe crlLerla earller descrlbed.
llcus sp. Plblscus Llllaceus
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-34
Scaveola Laccada uollchandrone spaLhacea
Leucaena leucocephala Lugenla olelna
Ardlsla elllpLlca Csmoxylon llneare
ulllenla lndlca LryLhrlna fusca
Macaranga sp
ongamla plnnaLa
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-33
1est keach - Mon|tor|ng
A LesL reach was consLrucLed ln early 2009 Lo LesL how Lhe planLs used, ln comblnaLlon wlLh
Lhe dlfferenL bloenglneerlng consLrucLlon meLhods, were able Lo qulckly esLabllsh and
rellably proLecL Lhe sLream banks of Lhe kallang 8lver aL 8lshan ark from eroslon caused by
sLormwaLer flow and surface waLer runoff.
MonlLorlng of Lhe LesL reach was carrled ouL for 6 monLhs from Mar 2009 Lo Aug 2009.
1esL reach under consLrucLlon ln 8lshan ark 2 (leb 2009)
CompleLed LesL reach ln 8lshan ark 2 (!un 2009)
ChapLer 9 - 8lo-englneerlng
Lnglneerlng rocedures for A8C WaLers ueslgn leaLures age 9-36
MonlLorlng of Lhe LesL reach lllusLraLed LhaL all Lhe dlfferenL Lechnlques LesLed (refer Lo
page 9-47 for Lhe Lechnlques) were feaslble Lo be employed ln Slngapore cllmaLe. 8esulLs
also showed LhaL slope sLablllLy was esLabllshed well, and all Lhe planLs specles LesLed have
grown well. 1he flndlngs obLalned have been used Lo flneLune Lhe deslgn of Lhe maln rlver,
whlch was under consLrucLlon and would be compleLed by end 2011.
9. 6 kLILkLNCLS
8ooks
1) ulcLlonary of Soll 8loenglneerlng (1996)
SocleLy for Soll 8loenglneerlng
lS8n 978-3-7281-3033-6
2007, vdf Pochschulverlag AC an der L1P Zurlch
2) Soll 8loenglneerlng: ConsLrucLlon 1ype Manual
Pelgard Zeh
1993 - Luropean lederaLlon for Soll 8loenglneerlng
(SwlLzerland, Cermany, AusLrla, lLaly, Spaln)
Constructed Wetlands
10
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
10
Chapter 10 Constructed Wetlands
10.1 Introduction.................................................................................................... 10-1
10.2 Design Considerations ..................................................................................... 10-2
10.2.1 Hydrodynamic Design ..................................................................................................... 10-2
10.2.2 Detention Time and Hydrologic Effectiveness .................................................................... 10-4
10.2.3 Inlet Zone Design Considerations ..................................................................................... 10-5
10.2.4 Macrophyte Zone Design Considerations .......................................................................... 10-5
10.2.5 Wetlands Constructed within Flood Detention Basins ......................................................... 10-6
10.2.6 Landscape Design .......................................................................................................... 10-6
10.2.7 Vegetation Types ............................................................................................................ 10-6
10.2.8 Designing to Avoid Mosquitoes ........................................................................................ 10-6
10.2.9 Designing for Maintenance Access ................................................................................... 10-7
10.3 Design Process ............................................................................................... 10-8
10.3.1 Step 1: Confirm treatment size ........................................................................................ 10-8
10.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows .................................................................................... 10-11
10.3.2.1 Design Discharges ................................................................................................................... 10-11
10.3.2.2 Design Flow Estimation ............................................................................................................ 10-11
10.3.3 Step 3: Design Inlet Zone .............................................................................................. 10-11
10.3.4 Step 4: Designing the Macrophyte Zone .......................................................................... 10-13
10.3.4.1 Length to Width Ratio and Hydraulic Efficiency ............................................................................ 10-13
10.3.4.2 Designing the Macrophyte Zone Bathymetry ................................................................................ 10-14
10.3.4.3 Macrophyte Zone Edge Design for Safety ................................................................................... 10-15
10.3.4.4 Macrophyte Zone Soil Testing ................................................................................................... 10-16
10.3.5 Step 5: Design Macrophyte Zone Outlet .......................................................................... 10-16
10.3.5.1 Riser Outlet Size and Location of Orifices ................................................................................. 10-16
10.3.5.2 Maintenance Drain ................................................................................................................... 10-17
10.3.5.3 Discharge Pipe ........................................................................................................................ 10-17
10.3.6 Step 6: Design High Flow Bypass Channel ...................................................................... 10-18
10.3.7 Step 7: Verify Design .................................................................................................... 10-18
10.3.7.1 Macrophyte Zone Re-suspension Protection ................................................................................ 10-18
10.3.7.2 Confirm Treatment Performance ................................................................................................ 10-19
10.3.8 Step 8: Specify Vegetation ............................................................................................. 10-19
10.3.9 Step 9: Consider Maintenance Requirements .................................................................. 10-19
10.3.10 Design Calculation Summary ..................................................................................... 10-19
10.4 Checking tools .............................................................................................. 10-21
10.4.1 Design assessment checklist ......................................................................................... 10-21
10.5 Construction advice ....................................................................................... 10-23
10.5.1.1 Protection from existing flows .................................................................................................... 10-23
10.5.1.2 High flow contingencies ............................................................................................................ 10-23
10.5.1.3 Erosion control ........................................................................................................................ 10-23
10.5.1.4 Inlet erosion checks .................................................................................................................. 10-23
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features
10.5.1.5 Tolerances .............................................................................................................................. 10-23
10.5.1.6 Transitions .............................................................................................................................. 10-23
10.5.1.7 Inlet zone access ..................................................................................................................... 10-24
10.5.1.8 Inlet zone base ........................................................................................................................ 10-24
10.5.1.9 Dewatering collected sediments ................................................................................................. 10-24
10.5.1.10 Timing for planting................................................................................................................ 10-24
10.5.1.11 Vegetation establishment ...................................................................................................... 10-24
10.5.1.12 Bird protection ..................................................................................................................... 10-24
10.5.2 Construction Inspection Checklist ................................................................................... 10-24
10.6 Maintenance requirements .............................................................................. 10-26
10.6.1 Operation & maintenance inspection form ....................................................................... 10-26
10.7 Worked example ........................................................................................... 10-28
10.7.1 Worked example introduction ......................................................................................... 10-28
10.7.2 Calculation Steps .......................................................................................................... 10-29
10.7.3 Design Calculation Summary ......................................................................................... 10-38
10.8 References .................................................................................................. 10-39
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-1
10.1 Introduction
The use of constructed wetlands for urban stormwater quality improvement is widely
adopted in many urban environments, many of which have been successfully
incorporated into the urban landscape. Design considerations include the interaction
between the wetland hydrology and hydrodynamic behaviour with the various physical,
chemical and biological treatment processes. The operating conditions of these
systems are stochastic in nature, with intermittent and highly variable hydraulic and
pollutant loading.
Constructed wetland systems are shallow extensively vegetated water bodies that use
enhanced sedimentation, fine filtration and pollutant uptake processes to remove
pollutants from stormwater.
Wetlands generally consist of an inlet zone (sedimentation basin to remove coarse
sediments see Chapter 4 Sedimentation Basins), a macrophyte zone (a shallow
heavily vegetated area to remove fine particulates and uptake of soluble pollutants)
and a high flow bypass channel (to protect the macrophyte zone). They are designed
primarily to remove stormwater pollutants associated with fine to colloidal particulates
and dissolved contaminants. Figure 10.1 shows an example layout of a wetland
system.
Figure 10.1 Layout of a constructed wetland system
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-2
10.2 Design Considerations
The major elements of constructed wetland systems are shown in the figure below.
Design considerations include hydrologic and hydrodynamic factors aimed at
optimizing the performance of these systems. In addition to these factors, design
considerations of stormwater treatment wetland need to also include the botanical
structure and layout of the wetland and the hydrologic regime necessary to sustain the
botanical structure. Wetland macrophytes support a number very important pollutant
removal mechanism, including the removal of fine suspended solids and associated
contaminants (e.g. nutrients, metals, organic contaminants and hydrocarbons).
Wetlands provide four key operational functions in a treatment train:
Promote sedimentation of particles larger than 125m in the inlet zone.
Discharge water from the inlet zone into the macrophyte zone for removal of
fine particulates and dissolved contaminants through the processes of
enhanced sedimentation, filtration, adhesion and biological uptake.
Ensure that the required detention period is achieved for all flow though the
wetland system through the incorporation of a riser outlet system.
Ensure adequate flood protection of the macrophyte zone from scouring
during above-design conditions by designing for by-pass operation when
inundation in the macrophyte zone reaches the design maximum extended
detention depth.
The level of treatment achievable by a wetland system can be maximized by
optimising the relationship between detention time, wetland volume and the hydrologic
effectiveness. The relationship between detention time and pollutant removal
efficiency is largely influenced by the settling velocity of the target particulate.
Figure 10.2 presents an overview of key design elements of a constructed wetland.
10.2.1 Hydrodynamic Design
The performance of constructed wetland in the removal of stormwater pollutants is
affected by many factors. The hydrodynamic behaviour of a constructed wetland
system is determined by the hydrologic and hydraulic design of the system.
Stormwater wetlands are subjected to extended periods of no inflow followed by
events of high hydraulic loading and pollutant loads. Flow attenuation can be
significant as the detention storage of the wetland fills and drains during these events.
Hydrodynamic flow patterns within the wetland can vary at different stages of wetland
inundation and thus, the detention period of stormwater inflow for each individual
event can be highly variable.
Poor wetland hydrodynamics and lack of appreciation of the stormwater treatment
chain are often identified as major contributors to wetland management problems. A
summary of desired hydrodynamic characteristics and design elements is presented in
Table 10.1.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-3
Inlet pool Outlet pool
GPT
Riser outlet
By-pass
Channel
Extended detention
Permanent
pool
Wetland section
Inlet Zone Macrophyte Zone
Wetland Outlet
Inlet Zone-Macrophyte Zone
Connection
Bypass Spillway
Figure Figure Figure Figure 10 10 10 10. .. .2 22 2 Design elements of a constructed wetland Design elements of a constructed wetland Design elements of a constructed wetland Design elements of a constructed wetland
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-4
Table 10.1: Desired Wetland Hydrodynamic Characteristics and Design Elements
Hydrodynamic Characteristics Design Issues Remarks
Uniform distribution of flow velocity Wetland shape, inlet and outlet placement
and morphological design of wetland to
eliminate short-circuit flow paths and dead
zones.
Poor flow pattern within a wetland will lead
to zones of stagnant pools which promotes
the accumulation of litter, oil and scum as
well as potentially supporting mosquito
breeding. Short circuit flow paths of high
velocities will lead to the wetland being
ineffective in water quality improvement.
Inundation depth, wetness
gradient, base flow and hydrologic
regime
Selection of wetland size and design of
outlet control to ensure compatibility with
the hydrology and size of the catchment
draining into the wetland.
Morphological and outlet control design to
match botanical layout design and the
hydrology of the wetland.
Regular flow throughput in the wetland
would promote flushing of the system thus
maintaining a dynamic system and
avoiding problems associated with
stagnant water, e.g. algal blooms, mosquito
breeding, oil and scum accumulation etc.
Inadequate attention to the inundation
depth, wetness gradient of the wetland and
the frequency of inundation at various
depth ranges would lead to dominance of
certain plant species especially weed
species over time, which results in a
deviation from the intended botanical layout
of the wetland.
Recent research findings indicate that
regular wetting and drying of the substrata
of the wetland can prevent releases of
phosphorus from the sediment deposited in
the wetland.
Uniform vertical velocity profile Selection of plant species and location of
inlet and outlet structures to promote
uniform velocity profile
Preliminary research findings have
indicated that certain plant species have a
tendency to promote stratification of flow
conditions within a wetland leading to
ineffective water pollution control and
increase the potential for algal bloom.
Scour protection Design of inlet structures and erosion
protection of banks
Owing to the highly dynamic nature of
stormwater inflow, measures are to be
taken to protect the wetland from erosion
during periods of high inflow rates.
10.2.2 Detention Time and Hydrologic Effectiveness
Detention time is the time taken for an idealized parcel of water entering the wetland
to travel through the macrophyte zone assuming plug flow conditions. Simulations
using computer models, are often required to optimize, for a given site area, the
relationship between wetland detention time
1
and wetland hydrologic effectiveness to
ensure treatment performance is maximised. Hydrologic effectiveness is a term used
to quantify the mean annual volume of stormwater runoff captured and treated within
the wetland and is expressed as a percentage of the mean annual runoff volume
generated from the contributing catchment. For well-designed wetlands without any
site constraints, the hydrologic effectiveness of constructed wetlands should be
greater than 80%.
The relationship between notional detention time and pollutant removal efficiency is
largely influenced by the settling velocity of the target particulates, although defining
the settling velocity of fine to colloidal particulates is not a straight forward exercise.
Standard equations for settling velocities often do not apply for fine particulates owing
to the influence of external factors such as wind and water turbulence. It is therefore
recommended that a notional detention time should preferably be 48 - 72 hours (and
not less than 48 hours) to remove nutrients effectively from urban stormwater.
1 It should be noted that detention time is rarely a constant and the term notional detention time is used
throughout this chapter to provide a point of reference in modelling and determining the design criteria for
riser outlet structures.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-5
10.2.3 Inlet Zone Design Considerations
The inlet zone of a constructed stormwater wetland is designed as a sedimentation
basin (see Chapter 4 Sedimentation Basins) and has two key functional roles, i.e. as a
pre-treatment for, and to control and regulate flow into, the downstream macrophyte
zone.
The primary role of the inlet zone is to remove coarse to medium sized sediment (i.e.
125m or larger) prior to flows entering the macrophyte zone. This ensures the
vegetation in the macrophyte zone is not smothered by coarse sediment and allows
the macrophyte zone to target finer particulates, nutrients and other pollutants. It also
meant that maintenance practice are generally focused at the inlet zone for regular
desilting (generally from annually to once every 5 years), leaving the downstream
macrophyte zone to have a more passive maintenance regime mainly directed at
botanical maintenance.
The second role of the inlet zone is the control and regulation of flows entering the
macrophyte zone and bypass of flows during above design flow conditions. The
outlet structures from the inlet zone (i.e. sedimentation basin) are designed such that
flows up to the design flow (typically the 1 year ARI) enter the macrophyte zone
whereas when the macrophyte zone is at its top of extended detention level,
catchment inflows are bypassed around the macrophyte zone. In providing this
function, the sedimentation basin protects the vegetation in the macrophyte zone
against scour during high flows.
Chapter 4 (Sedimentation Basins) presents the range of issues that should be
considered when designing an inlet zone.
As a pre-treatment component of a wetland, it should be borne in mind that even when
the available space for a constructed wetland system is constrained, the size of the
inlet zone (i.e. sedimentation basin) should not be reduced as it is determined to target
the medium to coarse particles.
This ensures the larger sediments are effectively trapped and prevented from
smothering the macrophyte zone. When the site constrains the size of the constructed
wetland, it is the macrophyte zone of the wetland that should be reduced accordingly.
10.2.4 Macrophyte Zone Design Considerations
The layout of the macrophyte zone needs to be configured such that system hydraulic
efficiency is optimised and healthy vegetation sustained. Design considerations
include:
The preferred extended detention depth is 0.5 m. Deeper extended detention
depths up to a maximum of 0.75 m may be acceptable where the wetland
hydrologic effectiveness is greater than 80% and where the botanic design
uses plant species tolerant to greater depths of inundation.
The bathymetry of the macrophyte zone should be designed to promote a
sequence of ephemeral, shallow marsh, marsh and deep marsh zones in
addition to small open water zones. The relative proportion of each zone will
be dependent on the target pollutant and the wetland hydrologic effectiveness.
The macrophyte zone is required to retain water permanently and therefore
the base must be of suitable material to retain water (e.g. clay). If in-situ soils
are unsuitable for water retention, a clay liner (e.g. 300mm thick compacted
clay) must be used to ensure there will be permanent water for vegetation and
habitat.
The bathymetry of the macrophyte zone should be designed so that all marsh
zones are connected to a deeper open water zone to allow mosquito
predators to seek refuge in the deeper open water zones during periods of
extended dry weather.
Particular attention should be given to the placement of the inlet and outlet
structures, the length to width ratio of the macrophyte zone and flow control
features to promote a high hydraulic efficiency within the macrophyte zone.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-6
Provision to drain the macrophyte zone for water level management during the
plant establishment phase should also be considered.
The macrophyte zone outlet structure needs to be designed to provide a
notional detention time (usually 48 to 72 hours) for a wide range of flow
depths. The outlet structure should also include measures to exclude debris
to prevent clogging.
10.2.5 Wetlands Constructed within Flood Detention Basins
In many urban applications, wetlands can be constructed in the base of flood detention
basins, thus reducing the land required for stormwater treatment. In these situations,
wetland systems will occasionally become inundated to greater depths than the
extended detention depth; however, the inundation duration is usually relatively short
(hours) and is unlikely to affect the wetland vegetation provided there is a safe
pathway to drain the wetland following flood events which avoids scour of the wetland
vegetation and banks.
When designing a wetland within a detention basin, the wetland system should be
located at the upstream end of the basin. By pass of the macrophyte zone during
large flow events would commence to inundate the basin from the downstream end of
the basin away from the wetland. This ensures that flooding of the wetland during the
flood detention operation is by backwater inundation across the wetland thus
protecting the macrophyte vegetation from scour by high velocity flows.
10.2.6 Landscape Design
Constructed wetlands are often located within accessible open space areas and can
become interesting community features. Landscape design aims to ensure that marsh
planting fulfils the intended stormwater treatment function as well as integrating with
their surrounds. Opportunities to enhance public amenity and safety with viewing
areas, pathway links, picnic nodes and other elements should be exploited.
Community education through signage and public art can also be explored. It is
important that the landscape of constructed wetlands addresses stormwater quality
objectives whilst being sensitive to these other important landscape aims.
10.2.7 Vegetation Types
Vegetation planted in the macrophyte zone has an important functional role in treating
stormwater flows, as well as adding aesthetic value. Dense planting of the littoral
zone will inhibit public access to the macrophyte zone, minimising potential damage to
wetland plants and reducing the safety risks posed by water bodies.
Plant species for the wetland area will be selected based on the hydrologic regime,
microclimate and soil types of the region, and the life histories, physiological and
structural characteristics, natural distribution, and community groups of the wetland
plants. A list of suggested plant species suitable for constructed wetland systems in
Singapore will be developed in consultation with Singapores National Parks and form
and appendix to these guidelines. The planting densities recommended in the list
should ensure that 70 - 80 % cover is achieved within two growing seasons (2 years).
The distribution of the species within the wetland will relate to their structure, function,
relationship and compatibility with other species.
10.2.8 Designing to Avoid Mosquitoes
To reduce the risk of high numbers of mosquitoes, there are a number of design
features that can be considered. Not all of these will be feasible in any one situation,
but they include:
Providing access for mosquito predators, such as fish and predatory insects,
to all parts of the water body (avoid stagnant isolated areas of water).
Providing a deep sump of permanent water (for long dry periods or for when
water levels are artificially lowered) so that mosquito predators can seek
refuge and maintain a presence in the wetland.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-7
Maintaining natural water level fluctuations that disturb the breeding cycle of
some mosquito species, but be aware that this may suit other mosquito
species.
Where possible, incorporating a steep slope into the water, preferably greater
than 30 or 3:1 horizontal to vertical. Note that steep edges may be
unacceptable for public safety reasons, and a slope of up to 8:1 horizontal to
vertical is generally used.
Wave action from wind over open water will discourage mosquito egg laying
and disrupt the ability of larvae to breathe.
Providing a bathymetry such that regular wetting and drying is achieved and
water draws down evenly so isolated pools are avoided.
Providing sufficient gross pollutant control at the inlet such that human derived
litter does not accumulate and provide breeding habitat.
Providing ready access for field operators to monitor and treat mosquito
larvae.
Ensuring maintenance procedures do not result in wheel rut and other
localised depressions that create isolated pools when water levels fall.
Ensuring overflow channels dont have depressions that will hold water after a
storm event.
Each case has to be considered on its own merits. It may be possible that a well
established constructed wetland will have no significant mosquito breeding associated
with it; however, changes in climatic and vegetation conditions could change that
situation rapidly. Maintaining awareness for mosquito problems and regular
monitoring for mosquito activity should be considered as a component of the
management of these sites. Effective and environmentally sound control products are
available for control of mosquito larvae in these situations.
10.2.9 Designing for Maintenance Access
Access to all areas of a constructed wetland is required for maintenance. In particular,
inlet zones and gross pollutant traps require a track suitable for heavy machinery for
removal of debris and desilting as well as an area for dewatering removed sediments
(refer to Chapter 4 Sedimentation Basins). The track should be permanent and have
a maximum slope 1:10.
To aid maintenance, it is recommended that the inlet zone is constructed with a hard
(i.e. rock) bottom. This is important if maintenance is performed by driving into the
basin. It also serves an important role by allowing excavator operators to detect when
they have reached the base of the inlet zone during desilting operations.
Macrophyte zones require access to the areas for weeding and replanting as well as
regular inspections. Commonly, these access tracks can be incorporated with walking
paths around a wetland system. Maintenance access to constructed wetland needs to
be considered when determining the layout of a wetland system.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-8
10.3 Design Process
The following sections detail the design steps required for constructed wetlands. Key
design steps following the site planning and concept development stages are:
10.3.1 Step 1: Confirm treatment size
A conceptual design of a constructed wetland system is typically undertaken prior to
detailed design. The performance of the concept design must be checked to ensure
that stormwater treatment objectives will be satisfied.
1. Confirm treatment performance of concept design
2. Determine design flows
3. Design inlet zone
(see Design Procedure for Sedimentation Basin in Chapter 4)
4. Design macrophyte zone
a. Length to width ration and hydraulic efficiency
b. Designing the macrophyte zone bathymetry
c. Macrophyte zone edge design for safety
5. Design macrophyte zone outlet
a. Riser outlet - Size and location of orifices
b. Maintenance drain
c. Discharge pipe
6. Design high flow bypass channel
7. Verify design
a. Macrophyte zone resuspension protection
b. Confirm treatment performance
9. Consider maintenance requirements
8. Specify vegetation
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-9
The performance of a concept design is checked using sizing curves. Sizing curves
for TSS, TP and TN removal for a range of feasible extended detention depths are
given in Figure 10.3 to Figure 10.5.
The curves for Singapore were derived using the Model for Urban Stormwater
Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC; CRCCH 2003), assuming the system
receives direct runoff with pre-treatment through an inlet zone and with the
macrophyte zone of 0.25 m average permanent pool depth and a notional detention
time of 72 hours. The curves provide the detailed designer with a useful visual guide
to illustrate the sensitivity of constructed wetland performance to the ratio of
macrophyte zone treatment area and contributing catchment area.
The curves given in Figure 10.3 to Figure 10.5 allow the detailed designer to make a
rapid assessment as to whether the concept design falls within the optimal size
range or if it is potentially under or over-sized, i.e.
an under-sized system might indicate the wetland is part of a treatment train
or that another supplementary treatment device may be located somewhere
else within the catchment. This should be checked by the detailed designer.
an over-sized system suggests the concept design of the wetland may have
been inadvertently sized the wetland such that it is operating well beyond its
point of diminishing performance (i.e. where incremental increases in
wetland size, and thus cost, result in only a marginal increase in treatment
performance). In this instance, the detailed designer should confirm whether
or not the wetland size can be reduced or if additional treatment devices may
be required.
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Wetland S urfac e Area (% of Imprevious C atchment)
T
S
S
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
750m m Ext Det
500m m Ext Det
250m m Ext Det
Figure 10.3 Wetland TSS removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-10
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Wetland S urface Area (% of Imprevious C atc hment)
T
P
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
750mm Ext Det
500mm Ext Det
250mm Ext Det
Figure 10.4 Wetland TP removal performance (Reference: Station 43)
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20
Wetland S urfac e Area (% of Imprevious C atc hment)
T
N
R
e
m
o
v
a
l
(
%
)
750mm Ext Det
500mm Ext Det
250mm Ext Det
Figure 10.5 Wetland TN removal performance for Singapore
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-11
10.3.2 Step 2: Determine Design Flows
10.3.2.1 Design Discharges
The following design flows is required to configure the inlet zone and high flow bypass
elements of a constructed wetland:
Design operation flow (1 year ARI) for sizing the inlet zone (i.e. sedimentation
basin) and the control outlet structure (i.e. overflow pit and pipe connection)
discharging to macrophyte zone.
Above design flow for design of the high flow bypass around the macrophyte
zone. The discharge capacity for the bypass system may vary depending on
the particular situation but will typically correspond to one of the following:
- Minor design flow (5 year ARI) for situations where only the minor
drainage system is directed to the inlet zone. Relevant local
government guidelines should be referred to for the required design
event for the minor design flow.
- Major flood flow (100 year ARI) for situations where both the minor
and major drainage system discharge into the inlet zone.
10.3.2.2 Design Flow Estimation
A range of hydrologic methods can be applied to estimate design flows. If the typical
catchment areas are relatively small, the Rational Method design procedure is
considered to be a suitable method for estimating design flows. However, if the
constructed wetland is to form part of a flood detention basin (Section 10.2.5) or if the
catchment area to the wetland is large (> 50 ha), then a catchment flood routing
modelling approach should be adopted for flood estimation.
10.3.3 Step 3: Design Inlet Zone
As outlined in Section 10.2.3, the
inlet zone of a constructed
stormwater wetland is designed as a
sedimentation basin (refer Chapter
4) and serves two functions:
(1) Pre-treatment of inflow to remove
coarse to medium sized sediment;
and
(2) Hydrologic control of inflows into
the macrophyte zone and bypass of
floods during above design
operating conditions. The inlet zone
consists of the following elements:
- Sedimentation basin pool to capture coarse to medium sediment (125 m or
larger).
- Inlet zone connection to the macrophyte zone (or control structure as defined
in Chapter 4) normally consisting of an overflow pit within the inlet zone
connected to one or more pipes through the embankment separating the inlet
zone and the macrophyte zone.
- High flow bypass weir (or spillway outlet structure) to deliver above design
flood flows to the high flow bypass channel.
For more information and design guidance for each of the inlet zone elements listed
above, the reader is referred to Chapter 4 Sedimentation Basins. When applying the
design procedure outlined in Chapter 4, the following should be used as a guide:
The inlet zone typically must comprise a deep open water body (> 1.5 m) that
operates essentially as a sedimentation basin designed to capture coarse to
medium sized sediment (i.e. 125m or larger).
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-12
It may be necessary for a Gross Pollutant Trap (GPT) to be installed such that
litter and large debris can be captured at the interface between the incoming
waterway (or pipe) and the open water of the inlet zone. This is particularly
necessary if the open water of the inlet zone also serves a landscape feature
of high visibility.
The crest of the overflow pit must be set at the permanent pool level of the
inlet zone. It is common practice to set the permanent pool level in the inlet
zone to be above the permanent water level of the downstream, receiving
macrophyte zone to provide for unimpeded inflow to the macrophyte zone. As
the macrophyte zone progressive become inundated over its extended
detention depth, the overflow pit in the inlet zone will become submerged
where downstream water levels will influence subsequent discharge rates into
the wetland, ultimately causing the bypass operation to be activated.
The overflow pit and connecting pipe between the inlet zone and macrophyte
zone should be designed to convey the design operation flow (i.e. 1 year ARI
peak discharge). Assuming inlet control operation:-
the dimension of the overflow pit (control structure) should be
determined to ensure that adequate operating capacity as a weir or a
submerged glory hole or orifice with a water level corresponding to
the crest of the by-pass spillway;
the pipe size that connects the inlet zone to the macrophyte zone is
determined by assuming the macrophyte zone is at the permanent
pool level and with upstream water level at the crest of the overflow
pit.
An energy dissipater is usually required at the end of the pipes to reduce
velocities and distribute flows into the macrophyte zone.
The inlet zone is to have a structural base (e.g. rock) to define the base when
desilting and provide support for maintenance plant/ machinery when entering
the basin for maintenance.
The high flow bypass weir (spillway outlet) is to be set at the same level as
the top of extended detention in the macrophyte zone.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-13
Figure 10.6 Typical inlet zone design for a constructed wetland
10.3.4 Step 4: Designing the Macrophyte Zone
10.3.4.1 Length to Width Ratio and Hydraulic Efficiency
To optimise wetland performance, it is important to avoid short circuit flow paths and
poorly mixed regions within the macrophyte zone. One way to minimise this is to
adopt a high length to width ratio not less than 5 to 1 for the macrophyte zone. Length
to width ratios less than this can lead to poor hydrodynamic conditions and reduced
water quality treatment performance.
The expected hydrodynamic characteristics can be defined by the hydraulic efficiency
of the wetland, defined by Persson et al. (1999). The hydraulic efficiency is greatly
influenced by the length to width ratio of the wetland, the relative position of the inlet
and the outlet, and the inclusion and placement of any baffles, islands or flow
spreaders. Hydraulic efficiency has a range from 0 to 1, with 1 representing the most
efficient configuration for sedimentation. The design of the macrophyte zone of a
constructed wetland should aim to have a hydraulic efficiency greater than 0.7.
Engineers Australia (2006) recommend that constructed wetland systems should not
have a hydraulic efficiency () less than 0.5.
Guidance on estimating hydraulic efficiency is given in Figure 10.7. The shape
designed as o in diagrams O and P represent islands in the waterbody and the
double line in diagram Q represents a weir structure to distribute flows evenly
(Persson et al. 1999).
Inlet Zone (sedimentation
basin)
Macrophyte Zone
Energy Dissipater
Connection Pipe(s)
Overflow Pit
Inlet connection to
macrophyte zone
Design Surface
Natural Surface
High Flow
Bypass
Channel
Bypass Weir
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-14
Figure 10.7 Hydraulic Efficiency,
10.3.4.2 Designing the Macrophyte Zone Bathymetry
It is good design practice to provide a range of habitat areas within the macrophyte
zone to support a variety of plant species, ecological niches and perform a range of
treatment processes. The macrophyte zone therefore typically comprises four marsh
zones (defined by water depth) and an open water zone. The four marsh zones are
ephemeral marsh, shallow marsh, marsh and deep marsh as depicted in Figure 10.8.
The bathymetry across the four marsh zones is to vary gradually ranging from 0.2 m
above the permanent pool level (i.e. ephemeral marsh) to a maximum of 0.5 m below
the permanent pool level (i.e. deep marsh).
The relative proportion of each marsh zone will be dependent on the specific
pollutant(s) being targeted by the wetland. For example, a wetland targeting
phosphorus removal would typically have a higher proportion of ephemeral marsh
zone where the frequent cycles of inundation and draining promotes the locking of
phosphorus onto the soil particles within the macrophyte zone substrate. Conversely,
if nitrogen is the target pollutant, the macrophyte zone would typically have a higher
proportion of marsh and deep marsh. The marsh and deep marsh zones facilitate
nitrogen cycling within the aerobic and anaerobic substrate conditions as well as
biological processing of soluble nitrogen from the water column by algal epiphytes and
biofilms attached to the submerged part of the macrophytes in these zones.
The depth of the open water zones should be not less than 1m below the permanent
pool level to avoid colonisation by emergent macrophytes and typically not more than
1.5m depth to allow for colonisation for submerged macrophytes.
To ensure optimal hydraulic efficiency of a wetland for a given shape and aspect ratio,
wetland zones are arranged in bands running across (i.e. perpendicular to) the flow
path (see Figure 10.9). The appropriate bathymetry, coupled with uniform plant
establishment, ensures the macrophyte zone cross section has uniform hydraulic
conveyance, thus reducing the risk of short circuiting.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-15
Figure 10.8 Example Bathymetry of a Constructed Wetland System (GBLA
2004)
Figure 10.9 Schematic layout of a constructed wetland (see also Figure Figure Figure Figure 10 10 10 10. .. .2 22 2)
10.3.4.3 Macrophyte Zone Edge Design for Safety
The batter slopes on approaches and immediately under the permanent water level
have to be configured with consideration of public safety (refer to Figure 10.10).
Inlet zone
Macrophyte zone
Inflow
Deep marsh
Shallow marsh
Ephemeral marsh
Pool
Marsh
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-16
It is recommended that a gentle slope to the water edge and extending below the
water line be adopted before the batter slope steepens into deeper areas. An
alternative to the adoption of a flat batter slope is to provide a 3 m safety bench that
is less than 0.2 m deep below the permanent pool level be built around the wetland.
Safety requirements for individual wetlands may vary from site to site, and it is
recommended that an independent safety audit be conducted of each design.
Figure 10.10 Example of edge design to a constructed wetland system
10.3.4.4 Macrophyte Zone Soil Testing
Constructed wetlands are permanent water bodies and therefore the soils in the base
must be capable of retaining water. Geotechnical investigations of the suitability of the
in-situ soils are required to establish the water holding capacity of the soils. Where the
infiltration rates are too high for permanent water retention, tilling and compaction of
in-situ soils may be sufficient to create a suitable base for the wetland. Where in-situ
soils are unsuitable for water retention, a compacted clay liner may be required (e.g.
300 mm thick). Specialist geotechnical testing and advice must be sought.
10.3.5 Step 5: Design Macrophyte Zone Outlet
A macrophyte zone outlet has two purposes: (1) hydrologic control of the water level
and flows in the macrophyte zone to achieve the design detention time; and (2) to
allow the wetland permanent pool to be drained for maintenance.
10.3.5.1 Riser Outlet Size and Location of Orifices
The riser is designed to provide a uniform notional detention time over the full range of
the extended detention depth
2
. The target maximum discharge may be computed as
the ratio of the volume of the extended detention to the notional detention time, i.e.
(s) time detention notional
) (m volume storage detention extended
= Q
3
riser max
Equation 10.1
The placement of outlet orifices and determining their appropriate diameters is
designed iteratively by varying outlet diameters and levels, using the orifice equation
(Equation 10.2) applied over discrete depths along the length of a riser up to the
maximum detention depth. This can be performed with a spreadsheet as illustrated in
the worked example.
2
It should be noted that detention time is never a constant and the term notional detention time is used to provide a
point of reference in modelling and determining the design criteria for riser outlet structures.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-17
h g C
Q
A
d
riser
o
=
2
max
Equation 10.2
As the outlet orifices can be expected to be small, it is important that the orifices are
prevented from clogging by debris. Some form of debris guard is recommended as
illustrated in the images below.
Figure 10.11 Example devices to prevent clogging of the riser
An alternative to using debris guard is to install the riser within a pit. The pit is
connected to the permanent pool of the macrophyte zone via a submerged pipe
culvert. The connection should be adequately sized such that there is minimal water
level difference between the water within the pit and the water level in the macrophyte
zone. With the water entering into the outlet pit being drawn from below the
permanent pool level, floating debris are prevented from entering the outlet pit while
heavier debris would normally settle onto the bottom of the permanent pool.
Figure 10.12 Typical macrophyte zone outlet arrangement
10.3.5.2 Maintenance Drain
To allow access for maintenance, the wetland should have appropriate allowance for
draining. A maintenance drainage pipe should be provided that connects the low
points in the macrophyte zone bathymetry to the macrophyte zone outlet. A valve is
provided on the maintenance drainage pipe (typically located in the outlet pit), which
can be operated manually. The maintenance drainage pipe should be sized to draw
down the permanent pool within 12 hours (i.e. overnight). If a weir plate is used as a
riser outlet, provision should be made to remove the weir plate and allow drainage for
maintenance.
10.3.5.3 Discharge Pipe
The discharge pipe of the wetland conveys the outflow of the macrophyte zone to the
receiving waters (or existing drainage infrastructure). The conveyance capacity of the
discharge pipe is to be sized to match the higher of the two discharges, i.e. maximum
discharge from the riser or the maximum discharge from the maintenance drain.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-18
10.3.6 Step 6: Design High Flow Bypass Channel
To protect the integrity of the macrophyte zone of the wetland, it is necessary to
consider the desired above-design operation of the wetland system. This is generally
provided for with a high flow route that by-passes the macrophyte zone during flow
conditions that may lead to scour and damage to the wetland vegetation. As outlined
in Section 10.3.3, a function of the inlet zone is to provide hydrologic control of inflow
into the macrophyte zone. A by-pass weir is to be included in the design of the inlet
zone, together with a by-pass floodway (channel) to direct high flows around the
macrophyte zone.
Ideally, the bypass weir level should be set at the top of the extended detention level
in the macrophyte zone. This would ensure that a significant proportion of catchment
inflow will bypass the macrophyte zone once it has reached its maximum operating
extended detention level. The width of the spillway is to be sized to safely pass the
maximum discharge conveyed into the inlet zone or the 100 year ARI discharge (as
defined in Section 10.3.3) with the maximum water level above the crest of the weir to
be defined by the top of embankment level (plus a suitable freeboard provision).
Figure 10.13 Examples of high flow bypass systems
10.3.7 Step 7: Verify Design
10.3.7.1 Macrophyte Zone Re-suspension Protection
The principle pathway for biological uptake of soluble nutrients in wetlands is through
biofilms (epiphytes) attached to the surface of the macrophyte vegetation. The
biofilms, being mostly algae and bacteria, are susceptible to wash out under high flow
conditions. Further, wetland surveys indicate that up to 90% of the total nutrients are
stored in the sediments, therefore, the key to effective retention of pollutants is
managing high velocity flows that could potentially resuspend and remobilise these
stored pollutants.
A velocity check is to be conducted for design conditions, when the wetland water
level is at the top of the extended detention level and the riser is operating at design
capacity, to ensure velocities are less than 0.05 m/s through all zones of the wetland.
The following condition must be met:
0.05m/s <
A
Q
section
riser max
Equation 10.3
Where
Q
max riser
= target maximum discharge (defined in Equation 10.1) (m
3
/s)
A
section
= wetland cross sectional area at narrowest point*, measured from top
of extended detention (m
2
)
Minimum wetland cross-section is used when undertaking this velocity check
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-19
10.3.7.2 Confirm Treatment Performance
If the basic wetland parameters established by the conceptual design phase have
changed during the course of undertaking detailed design (e.g. macrophyte zone area,
extended detention depth, etc.) then the designer should verify that the current design
meets the required water quality improvement performance. This can be done by
simulating the current design using MUSIC.
10.3.8 Step 8: Specify Vegetation
Vegetation planted in the macrophyte zone (i.e. marsh and pool areas) is designed to
treat stormwater flows, as well as add aesthetic value. Dense planting of the littoral
berm zone will inhibit public access to the macrophyte zone, minimising potential
damage to the plants and the safety risks posed by water bodies. Terrestrial planting
may also be recommended to screen areas and provide an access barrier to
uncontrolled areas of the stormwater treatment system.
Plant species for the wetland area will be selected based on the water regime,
microclimate and soil types of the region, and the life histories, physiological and
structural characteristics, natural distribution, and community groups of the wetland
plants. The reader is referred the National parks Board of Singapore for a list of
suggested plant species suitable for constructed wetland systems in Singapore and
recommended planting densities. The distribution of the species within the wetland
will relate to their structure, function, relationship and compatibility with other species.
Planting densities should ensure that 70-80% cover is achieved after two growing
seasons (2 years) will be recommended.
10.3.9 Step 9: Consider Maintenance Requirements
A specific maintenance plan and schedule should be developed for the wetland, either
as part of a maintenance plan for the whole treatment train, or for each individual
asset. Guidance on maintenance plans is provided in Section 10.6. The maintenance
plan should consider how maintenance is to be performed on the wetland, for
example, where and how the wetland can be accessed and where litter is likely to
collect.
10.3.10 Design Calculation Summary
Following is a design calculation summary sheet for the key design elements.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-20
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-21
10.4 Checking tools
This section provides a number of checking aids for designers and referral authorities.
In addition, advice on construction techniques and lessons learnt from building
wetland systems are provided.
Checklists are provided for:
Design assessments
Construction (during and post)
Operation and maintenance inspections
10.4.1 Design assessment checklist
The checklist below presents the key design features that should be reviewed when
assessing a design of a bioretention basin. These considerations include
configuration, safety, maintenance and operational issues that should be addressed
during the design phase.
Where an item results in an N when reviewing the design, referral should be made
back to the design procedure to determine the impact of the omission or error.
In addition to the checklist, a proposed design should have all necessary permits for
its installations. The referral agency should ensure that all relevant permits are in
place. These can include permits to clear vegetation, to dredge, create a waterbody,
divert flows or disturb downstream aquatic ecosystems.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-22
WETLAND DESIGN ASSESSMENT CHECKLIST
Wetland Location:
Hydraulics: Design operational flow (m
3
/s): Above design flow (m
3
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Wetland Area (ha):
TREATMENT Y N
MUSIC modelling performed?
INLET ZONE Y N
Discharge pipe/structure to inlet zone sufficient for maximum design flow?
Scour protection provided at inlet for inflow velocities?
Configuration of inlet zone (aspect, depth and flows) allows settling of particles >125m?
Bypass weir incorporated into inlet zone?
Bypass weir length sufficient to convey 'above design flow' ?
Bypass weir crest at macrophyte zone top of extended detention depth?
Bypass channel has sufficient capacity to convey 'above design flow'?
Bypass channel has sufficient scour protection for design velocities?
Inlet zone connection to macrophyte zone overflow pit and connection pipe sized to convey the design operation flow?
Inlet zone connection to macrophyte zone allows energy dissipation?
Structure from inlet zone to macrophyte zone enables isolation of the macrophyte zone for maintenance?
Inlet zone permanent pool level above macrophyte permanent pool level?
Maintenance access allowed for into base of inlet zone?
Public safety design considerations included in inlet zone design?
Where required, gross pollutant protection measures provided on inlet structures (both inflows and to macrophyte zone)
MACROPHYTE ZONE Y N
Extended detention depth >0.25m and <0.5m?
Vegetation bands perpendicular to flow path?
Appropriate range of macrophyte vegetation (ephemeral, shallow, marsh, deep marsh)?
Sequencing of vegetation bands provides continuous gradient to open water zones?
Vegetation appropriate to selected band?
Aspect ratio provides hydraulic efficiency =>0.5?
Velocities from inlet zone <0.05 m/s or scouring protection provided?
Public safety design considerations included in macrophyte zone (i.e. batter slopes less than 5(H):1(V)?
Maintenance access provided into areas of the macrophyte zone (especially open water zones)?
Safety audit of publicly accessible areas undertaken?
Freeboard provided above extended detention depth to define embankments?
OUTLET STRUCTURES Y N
Riser outlet provided in macrophyte zone?
Notional detention time of 48-72 hours?
Orifice configuration allows for a linear storage-discharge relationship for full range of the extended detention depth?
Maintenance drain provided?
Discharge pipe has sufficient capacity to convey maximum of either the maintenance drain flows or riser pipe flows with
scour protection?
Protection against clogging of orifice provided on outlet structure?
COMMENTS
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-23
10.5 Construction advice
This section provides general advice for the construction of wetlands. It is based on
observations from construction projects around Australia.
10.5.1.1 Protection from existing flows
It is important to have protection from upstream flows during construction of a wetland
system. A mechanism to divert flows around a construction site, protect from litter and
debris is required. This can be achieved by constructing a high flow bypass channel
initially and then diverting all inflows along the channel until the wetland system is
complete.
During building construction, it is recommended that the inlet zone form a
sedimentation basin reducing the load of coarse sediment discharging to the
macrophyte zone (Leinster, 2006). The disconnection between the inlet and
macrophyte zone should remain in place to ensure the majority of flows from the
catchment continue to bypass the macrophyte zone thus allowing the wetland plants
to reach full maturity without the risk of being smothered with coarse sediment. At the
completion of all building activity the inlet zone is de-silted, the disconnection between
the inlet zone and macrohpyte zone is removed and the constructed wetland allowed
to operate in accordance with the design.
10.5.1.2 High flow contingencies
Contingencies to manage risks associated with flood events during construction are
required. All machinery should be stored above acceptable flood levels and the site
stabilised as well as possible at the end of each day. Plans for dewatering following
storms should also be made.
10.5.1.3 Erosion control
Immediately following earthworks it is good practice to revegetate all exposed surfaces
with sterile grasses (e.g. hydro-seed). These will stabilise soils, prevent weed
invasion yet not prevent future planting from establishing.
10.5.1.4 Inlet erosion checks
It is good practice to check the operation of inlet erosion protection measures following
the first few rainfall events. It is important to check for these early in the systems life,
to avoid continuing problems. Should problems occur in these events the erosion
protection should be enhanced.
10.5.1.5 Tolerances
It is importance to stress that particular attention be placed on ensuring that
construction tolerances of key wetlands features (e.g base, longitudinal and batters)
are kept to a minimum. The relative levels of the control structure are particularly
important in achieving the required hydraulic performance. It is also important to
ensure that as water levels reduce (e.g. for maintenance) that areas drain back into
designated pools with distributed shallow pools across the wetland to be avoided.
Generally plus or minus 5 mm is acceptable.
The bathymetry of the macrophyte zone must be free from localised depressions and
low points resulting from earthworks. This is particularly important to achieve a well
distributed flow path and to prevent isolated pools from forming (potentially creating
mosquito habitat) when the wetland drains. Generally an earthworks tolerance of plus
or minus 25 mm is considered acceptable.
10.5.1.6 Transitions
It is important to pay attention to the detail of earthworks to ensure smooth transitions
between benches and batter slopes. This will allow for strong edge vegetation to
establish and avoid local ponding (that can enhance mosquito breeding habitat).
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-24
10.5.1.7 Inlet zone access
An important component of an inlet zone is accessibility for maintenance. Should
excavators be capable of reaching all parts of the inlet zone and access track may not
be required to the base of the inlet zone, however an access track around the
perimeter of the inlet zone is required. If sediment collection is by using earthmoving
equipment, then a stable ramp will be required into the base of the inlet zone
(maximum slope 1:10).
10.5.1.8 Inlet zone base
To aid maintenance it is recommended to construct the inlet zone with a hard (i.e rock)
bottom. This is important if maintenance of the wetland requires driving into the basin.
It also serves an important role for determining the levels that excavation should
extend to (i.e. how deep to dig) for either systems cleaned from the banks or directly
accessed.
10.5.1.9 Dewatering collected sediments
An area should be constructed that allows for dewatering of removed sediments from
a sediment basin. This allows the removed sediments to be transported as dry
material and can greatly reduce disposal costs compared to liquid wastes. This area
should be located such that water from the material drains back into the basin.
Material should be allowed to drain for a minimum of overnight before disposal.
10.5.1.10 Timing for planting
Timing of vegetation planting is dependent on a suitable time of year (and potential
irrigation requirements) as well as timing in relation to the phases of development.
Temporary sediment controls should always be used prior to planting as lead times
from earthworks to planting are often long.
10.5.1.11 Vegetation establishment
During the establishment phase water levels should be controlled carefully to prevent
seedlings from being desiccated or drowned. This is best achieved with the use of
maintenance drains. Once plants are established water levels can be raised to
operational levels.
10.5.1.12 Bird protection
Protection from bird feeding on newly planted vegetation (e.g. nets) should be
considered in consultant with the National Parks Board of Singapore.
10.5.2 Construction Inspection Checklist
The following checklist presents the key items to be reviewed when inspecting the
constructed wetland system during and at the completion of construction. The
checklist is to be used by Construction Site Supervisors and local authority
Compliance Inspectors to ensure all the elements of the constructed wetland have
been constructed in accordance with the design. If an item is ticked as unsatisfactory
appropriate actions must be specified and delivered to rectify the construction issue
before final inspection sign-off is given.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-25
WETLAND CONSTRUCTION INSPECTION CHECKLIST
Site:
Date:
Time:
Constructed by:
Weather:
Contact During Visit:
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Items inspected
Checked Adequate
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION
Preliminary Works Structural components cont
1. Erosion and sediment control plan adopted 22. Ensure spillway is level
2. Limit public access 23. Provision of maintenance drain(s)
3. Location same as plans 24. Collar installed on pipes
4. Site protection from existing flows 25. Low flow channel is adequate
5. All required permits in place 26. Protection of riser from debris
Earthworks 27. Bypass channel stabilised
6. Integrity of banks 28. Erosion protection at macrophyte outlet
7. Batter slopes as plans Vegetation
8. Impermeable (eg. clay) base installed 29. Vegetation appropriate to zone (depth)
9. Maintenance access to whole wetland 30. Weed removal prior to planting
10. Compaction process as designed 31.Provision for water level control
11. Placement of adequate topsoil 32. Vegetation layout and densities as designed
12. Levels as designed for base, benches,
banks and spillway (including freeboard)
33. Provision for bird protection
13. Check for groundwater intrusion 34. By-pass channel vegetated
14. Stabilisation with sterile grass Erosion and Sediment Control
Structural components
35. Disconnect inlet zone from macrophyte zone
(flows via high flow bypass)
15. Location and levels of outlet as designed
36. Inlet zone to be used as sediment basin during
construction
16. Safety protection provided
37. Stabilisation immediately following earthworks
and planting of terrestrial landscape around basin
17. Pipe joints and connections as designed 38. Silt fences and traffic control in place
18. Concrete and reinforcement as designed 39. Inlet zone desilted prior to wetland online
19. Inlets appropriately installed 40. Inlet zone disconnection removed
20. Inlet energy dissipation installed
21. No seepage through banks
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 8. Public safety adequate
2. Confirm structural element sizes 9. Check for uneven settling of banks
3. Check batter slopes
10. Evidence of stagnant water, short circuiting or
vegetation scouring
4. Vegetation planting as designed 11. Evidence of litter or excessive debris
5. Erosion protection measures working 12. Provision of removed sediment drainage area
6. Pre-treatment installed and operational 13. Evidence of debris in high flow bypass
7. Maintenance access provided 14. Macrophyte outlet free of debris
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-26
10.6 Maintenance requirements
Wetlands treat runoff by filtering it through vegetation and providing extended
detention to allow sedimentation to occur. In addition, they have a flow management
role that needs to be maintained to ensure adequate flood protection for local
properties and protection of the wetland ecosystem.
Maintaining vibrant vegetation and adequate flow conditions in a wetland are the key
maintenance considerations. Weeding, planting and debris removal are the dominant
tasks. In addition the wetland needs to be protected from high loads of sediment and
debris and the inlet zone needs to be maintained in the same way as sedimentation
basins (see Chapter 4).
The most intensive period of maintenance is during the plant establishment period
(first two years) when weed removal and replanting may be required.
Other components of the system that will require careful consideration are the inlet
points. Inlets can be prone to scour and build up of litter. Occasional litter removal
and potential replanting may be required as part of maintaining an inlet zone.
Maintenance is primarily concerned with:
- Maintenance of flow to and through the system
- Maintaining vegetation
- Preventing undesired vegetation from taking over the desirable vegetation
- Removal of accumulated sediments
- Litter and debris removal
Vegetation maintenance will include:
- Removal of noxious plants or weeds
- Re-establishment of plants that die
Similar to other types of stormwater practices, debris removal is an ongoing
maintenance function. Debris, if not removed, can block inlets or outlets, and can be
unsightly if located in a visible location. Inspection and removal of debris should be
done regularly, but debris should be removed whenever it is observed on the site.
Inspections are also recommended following large storm events to check for scour.
10.6.1 Operation & maintenance inspection form
The form below should be used whenever an inspection is conducted and kept as a
record on the asset condition and quantity of removed pollutants over time.
Inspections should occur every 3-months for the first year and then 6-monthly
thereafter. More detailed site specific maintenance schedules should be developed
for major wetland systems and include a brief overview of the operation of the system
and key aspects to be checked during each inspection. An example is presented as
part of the worked example in Section 10.7.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-27
WETLAND MAINTENANCE CHECKLIST
Inspection Frequency: 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS Y N ACTION REQUIRED (DETAILS)
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter within inlet or macrophyte zones?
Sediment within inlet zone requires removal (record depth, remove if >50%)?
Overflow structure integrity satisfactory?
Evidence of dumping (building waste, oils etc)?
Terrestrial vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Aquatic vegetation condition satisfactory (density, weeds etc)?
Replanting required?
Settling or erosion of bunds/batters present?
Evidence of isolated shallow ponding?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Outlet structure free of debris?
Maintenance drain operational (check)?
Resetting of system required?
COMMENTS
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-28
10.7 Worked example
10.7.1 Worked example introduction
As part of a residential development in Singapore, stormwater runoff is to be conveyed
to a constructed wetland for water quality treatment. An illustration of the site and
proposed layout of the wetland is shown in the figure below. This worked example
describes the design process for each component of the constructed wetland: inlet
zone (including the bypass weir), macrophyte zone, macrophyte zone outlet and high
flow bypass channel.
Figure 10.14 Layout of Proposed Wetland System
Catchment and site description
The contributing catchment area of the proposed wetland is 10ha. The catchment is
densely developed with residential and industrial developments.
The site has a moderate fall of 2.5 m from south to north and is constrained by roads
to the west and north and by steeper grades to the east. Soils through the site have
been classified as clay. Stormwater runoff is collected and conveyed to the wetland
inlet zone via conventional piped drainage with minor storm (i.e. the 5 year ARI event)
flows discharged to the wetland inlet zone via a 975 mm diameter pipe and major
storm (100yr ARI) entering via overland flow.
Design Objectives
The design objectives for the wetland system are to:
- Promote sedimentation of particles larger than 125m within the inlet zone.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-29
- Optimise the relationship between detention time, wetland volume and the
hydrologic effectiveness of the system to maximise treatment given the
wetland volume site constraints.
- Ensure that the required detention period is achieved for all flow though the
wetland system through the incorporation of a riser outlet system.
- Provide for by-pass operation when the inundation of the macrophyte zone
reaches the design maximum extended detention depth.
Concept Design Criteria
The conceptual design of the constructed wetland (as shown in Figure 10.14)
established the following key design elements to ensure effective operation:
- Wetland macrophyte zone extended detention depth of 0.5m, permanent pool
level of 11.5m and an area of 15,000 m
2
(equivalent to 15% of the catchment
area)
- Inlet zone permanent pool level of 11.7m, which is 0.2m above the permanent
pool level of the macrophyte zone
- Bypass weir (spillway outlet) level of 12.0m set at the top of extended
detention in the wetland macrophyte zone and 0.3 m above the inlet zone
permanent pool level
- High flow bypass channel longitudinal grade of 1.5%.
Landscape Requirements
In addition, a landscape design will be required and they include:
Macrophyte zone vegetation (including edge vegetation)
Terrestrial vegetation.
10.7.2 Calculation Steps
The design of a constructed wetland system has been divided into the following 7
calculations steps:
Step 1 Confirm treatment size
Step 2 Estimate design flows
Step 3 Design inlet zone
Step 4 Macrophyte zone
Step 5 Macrophyte zone outlet
Step 6 : Design High Flow Bypass Channel
Step 7 Verification Checks
Details for each calculation step are provided below. A design calculation summary
has been completed for the worked example and is given at the conclusion of the
calculation steps.
Step 1 Confirm treatment size
As a basic check of the adequacy of the size of the wetland, reference is made to the
performance curves presented in Figure 10.3 to Figure 10.5. A macrophyte area of
1.5ha (equivalent to 15% of the catchment area) provides a pollutant load reduction of
78%, 72% and 50% reduction of TSS, TP and TN respectively from mean annual
loads typically generated from an urban catchment.
Step 2 Estimate design flows
The site has a contributing catchment of 10ha which is drained via conventional pipe
drainage. Both the minor storm (5yr ARI) and the major storm (100yr ARI) flows enter
the inlet zone of the wetland. Therefore, the above design flow is set to correspond
to the 100year ARI peak flow. The design operation flow, which is required to size
the inlet zone and the inlet zone connection to the macrophyte zone, is set to
correspond to the 1year ARI peak flow.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-30
Design flows are established using the Rational Method, as given in the Code of
Practice on Surface Water Drainage (PUB, 2000). The rational method is given by
360
c
CIA
Q =
Where
C = Runoff coefficient
I = Rainfall intensity (mm/hr)
A
c
= Catchment area (ha)
a. time of concentration
The time of concentration of the catchment was determined to be 10min.
b. Runoff coefficients
The Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage describes runoff coefficients based
on the degree and type of development within the catchment. The catchment for the
worked example is densely developed with residential and industrial developments.
The corresponding runoff coefficient is 0.8.
c. Rainfall Intensities
The rainfall intensity at a time of concentration of 10minutes for the 1yr ARI and 100yr
ARI event are determined from the IDF curve for Singapore contained in Appendix 2 of
the Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (2000), i.e.
I
1
= 106 mm/hr I
100
= 271 mm/hr
d. Design flows
Applying the Rational Method for the above parameters and a catchment area of 10ha
gives the following design flows:
Q
1
= 2.3 m
3
/s Q
100
= 6.0 m
3
/s
Step 3 Design inlet zone
The design of the inlet zone is undertaken in accordance with the design procedures
outlined in Chapter 4 (Sedimentation Basin). A summary of the key inlet zone
elements is provided below.
Inlet Zone (Sedimentation Basin) Size
a. Sediment Basin Area
An initial estimate of the inlet zone area can be established using the curves given in
Figure 4.3. For a peak 1 year ARI flow of 2.3 m
3
/s, a basin area of 520 m
2
is required
to capture 90% of the 125m particles for flows up to the design operation flow
(1 year ARI = 2.3 m
3
/s). This area represents approximately 0.25% of the site area.
A more detailed design procedure for a sedimentation basin is contained in Chapter 4
of this document.
b. Clean-out frequency
The inlet zone (sedimentation basin) should have adequate storage to ensure desilting
is not more frequent than once a year. Desilting is required when sediment storage
reaches half the volume of the permanent pool volume of the basin.
The design depth of the permanent pool is adopted to be 1.5 m. Adopting a batter
slope of 1:3 below the water line, the sedimentation volume available for storage is
544 m
3
. Thus, clean out of the sedimentation basin is required when sediment
deposition volume exceeds 272 m
3
.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-31
Assuming a sediment loading rate of 3.0 m
3
/ha/yr and a capture efficiency of 90%, the
cleanout frequency I computed to be:-
Cleanout frequency (years) = 10
9 . 0 10 3
272
=
years OK
Inlet Zone Connection to Macrophyte Zone
The hydraulic structure connecting the inlet zone to the macrophyte zone consists of
an overflow pit (in the inlet zone) and a connection pipe with the capacity to convey
the design operation flow (1yr ARI = 2.3 m
3
/s). The conceptual design defined the
following design elements:
- Inlet zone permanent pool level (overflow pit crest level) = 11.7m which is
0.2m above the permanent pool level of the macrophyte zone
- Bypass weir (spillway outlet) crest level = 12m which is the top of extended
detention for the wetland and 0.3 m above the inlet zone permanent pool
level.
It is common practice to allow for 0.3m of freeboard above the afflux level when setting
the top of embankment elevation.
Overflow Pit
Two possible flow conditions need to be checked for overflow conditions: weir flow
conditions (with extended detention of 0.3 m) and orifice flow conditions.
a. Weir Flow Conditions
The required perimeter of the outlet pit to pass the 1yr ARI flow (2.3 m
3
/s) with an
afflux of 0.3 m can be calculated using the following equation assuming 50%
blockage:
m P
P
h C B
Q
P
w
des
5 . 16
3 . 0 7 . 1 5 . 0
3 . 2
2 / 3
2 / 3
=
=
=
The equivalent area, assuming the pit is square, is 18m
2
.
b. Orifice Flow Conditions
The required area of the outlet pit can be calculated as follows:
2
2 . 3
3 . 0 81 . 9 2 6 . 0 5 . 0
3 . 2
2
m A
A
h g C B
Q
A
o
o
d
des
o
=
=
=
In this case the weir flow condition is limiting. Considering the overflow pit is to convey
the design operation flow (1yr ARI) or slightly greater, a minimum pit of 1.8m x 1.8m
will be required (area 3.2 m
2
). The top of the pit is to be fitted with a letter box grate.
This will ensure large debris does not enter the control structure while avoiding the
likely of blockage of the grate by smaller debris.
c. Connection Pipe(s)
As the connection pipe (i.e. between the inlet zone and the macrophyte zone) is to be
submerged, the size can be determined by first estimating the required velocity in the
connection pipe using the following:
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-32
g 2
V 2
h
2
=
Where
h = head level driving flow through the pipe (defined as the spillway outlet level
minus the normal water level in the downstream treatment system)
= 12m 11.5m = 0.5m
g = gravity (9.81 m/s
2
)
Note: the coefficient of 2 in the equation is a conservative estimate of the sum of entry and exit loss
coefficients (Kin + Kout).
Back calculating gives a velocity of 2.2m/s in the connection pipe. The pipe size
required to carry the 1yr ARI design flow of 2.3 m
3
/s is hence 1.1m
2
. It is
recommended that multiple pipes be used to connect the inlet and the macrophyte
zones. Three pipes of 750 mm diameter will be required.
The obvert of the pipes is to be set below the permanent water level in the wetland
macrophyte zone (11.5 m) meaning the invert is set at 10.80 m. The dimension of the
over pit to accommodate the pipe connection is thus 3 m by 1.5 m.
In summary, the control outlet structure will be an overflow pit, 3m by 1.5m with the
crest level at RL 11.5m and a raised grated cover set at RL 11.6m. The
outlet/connection pipe to the wetland will be three 750mm in diameter pipes with their
inverts set at RL 10.8m.
High Flow Bypass Weir
All flows in excess of the design operation flow and up to the above design flow are
to bypass the wetland macrophyte zone. This is facilitated by a high flow bypass weir
(spillway outlet) designed to convey the above design flow (100yr ARI) with the weir
crest level 0.3 m above the permanent pool of the inlet pond (RL 12.0m).
Assuming a maximum afflux of 0.3 m, the weir length is calculated using the weir flow
equation
m L
L
h C
Q
L
w
yr
22
3 . 0 7 . 1
6
2
3
2 / 3
100
=
=
To ensure no flows breach the embankment separating the inlet zone and the
macrophyte zone the embankment crest level is to be set at 12.6 m AHD (i.e. 0.3 m
freeboard on top of the maximum afflux level over the high flow bypass weir).
Summary of inlet zone dimensions
The dimensions for the sedimentation basin are summarised below.
Open water area = 520m
2
Basin width = 45m
Basin length = 12m
Depth of permanent
pool
= 1.5m
Overflow pit = 3.0m x 1.5m with grate set at RL 11.7 m
Pipe connection (to
wetland)
= 3 x 750mm RCPs at RL 10.8m
High flow bypass weir = 22m length at RL 12.0m
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-33
Step 4 Macrophyte zone
Length to width ratio and hydraulic efficiency
The hydraulic efficiency describes the effectiveness of the basin to retain sediment. A
reasonable estimate of the hydraulic efficiency can be made based on the length to
width ratio of the basin, the relative position of entry and exit points and any flow
diverting systems (e.g. baffles).
The concept design (Figure 10.14) describes the macrophyte zone as L-shaped and
an area of 15,000m
2
, and a width to length ratio of 1:6. Case K (= 0.37) shown in
(Figure 10.7) has a L-shaped layout but with an equivalent aspect ratio of 1:3. Case
G (= 0.76) has an equivalent aspect ratio of 1:8 with a sinuous shape. With a length
to width ratio of 1:6, and an L-shaped configuration, a hydraulic efficiency of 0.6 is
considered reasonable.
Designing the macrophyte zone bathymetry
The macrophyte zone of the wetland is divided into four marsh zones and an open
water zone as described below:
The bathymetry across the four marsh zones is to vary gradually over the
length of the macrophyte zone, ranging from 0.2 m above the permanent pool
level (ephemeral zone) to 0.5 m below the permanent pool level (Table 10.2).
The ephemeral marsh zone is to be located adjacent to the pathway and
bridge crossing mid way along the wetland.
The permanent pools upstream and downstream of the ephemeral zone are to
be connected via the maintenance drain to ensure the upstream permanent
pool can drain down to RL11.5 m following a rainfall event.
The depth of the open water zone in the vicinity of the outlet structure is to be
1 m below the permanent pool level.
The marsh zones are arranged in bands of equal depth running across the
flow path to optimise hydraulic efficiency and reduce the risk of short-
circuiting.
Table 10.2: Indicative Break of Marsh Zones
Zone Depth Range (m)
Proportion of Macrophyte
Zone Surface Area (m)
Open Water (Pool) >1.0 below permanent pool 10%
Transition 0.5 1.0 below permanent pool 10%
Deep Marsh 0.35 0.5 below permanent pool 20%
Marsh 0.2 0.35 below permanent pool 20%
Shallow Marsh 0.0 0.2 below permanent pool 20%
Ephemeral Marsh 0.2 0.0 above permanent pool 20%
Macrophyte Zone Edge Design for Safety
The batter slopes on approaches and immediately under the permanent water level
have to been configured with consideration of public safety:
- Generally, batter slopes of 1(V):8(H) from the top of the extended detention
depth to 0.3 m beneath the water line has been adopted.
- The general grade through the wetland below the waterline is 1(V):8(H) or
flatter.
- The batters directly adjacent and within the open water zones of the
macrophyte are limited to 1(V):8(H).
Step 5 Macrophyte zone outlet
Riser Outlet Size and Location of Orifices
The target maximum discharge may be computed as the ratio of the volume of the
extended detention to the notional detention time, i.e.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-34
(s) time detention notional
) (m volume storage detention extended
= Q
3
riser max
The extended detention storage volume is approximated as 7,500m
3
(given a surface
area of 15,000m
2
and an extended detention depth of 0.5m). The wetland will be
designed for a notional detention time of 72hrs. Hence the maximum discharge from
the riser is 0.03m
3
/s.
The placement of outlet orifices and determining their appropriate diameters is
designed iteratively by varying outlet diameters and levels, using the orifice equation
(Equation 10.2) applied over discrete depths along the length of a riser up to the
maximum detention depth. The outlet diameters and positioning are varied to ensure
a 72hr nominal detention time at each outlet position.
The final iteration is presented in the excel spreadsheet below. The resulting orifice
configuration is described schematically in Figure 10.15. Note that the riser pipe has
no role in managing the flows greater than 0.03m
3
/s (Q
max, riser
). For flows above the
extended detention depth the high flow bypass is activated. A notional upstand riser
pipe diameter of 225 mm is selected.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-35
Orifice Position (invert level) 0 0.125 0.25 0.375 m (above 11.5m)
Orifice diameter 40 40 30 30 (mm)
Number of orifices 6 4 5 3 (-)
Area/orifice
1.3E-03
(1.310
-3
)
1.3E-03
(1.310
-3
)
7.1E-04
(7.110
-4
)
7.1E-04
(7.110
-4
) (m
2
)
Position No. Water depth
(m)
Volume
(m
3
)
Flow at given extended detention depth
(L/s)
Total Flow
(L/s)
tdet
(hrs)
1 0 0 0 0
2 0.125 1875 7.08 7.1 74
3 0.25 3750 10.02 4.72 14.7 71
4 0.375 5625 12.27 6.68 3.32 22.3 70
5 0.5 7500 14.17 8.18 4.70 1.99 29.0 72
0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35
Discharge (L/s)
O
r
i
f
i
c
e
P
o
s
i
t
i
o
n
(
m
a
b
o
v
e
1
1
.
5
m
A
H
D
)
Figure 10.15 Riser configuration
As the required orifices are small, it is necessary to include measures to prevent
blocking of the orifices. The riser is to be installed within an outlet pit with a pipe
connection to the permanent pool of the macrophyte zone. The connection is via a
225mm diameter pipe. The pit is accessed via the locked screen on top of the pit.
Maintenance Drains
To allow access for maintenance, the wetland is to be drained via a maintenance drain
(i.e. pipe) that connects the low points in the macrophyte bathymetry. The drain must
be sized to draw down the permanent pool of the macrophyte zone in 12 hours with
allowance for manual operation (i.e. inclusion of valve). The permanent pool is
assumed to have a mean depth of 0.25m.
The mean flow rate to draw down the macrophyte zone over a notional 12 hour period
based on a permanent pool volume of 3,750m
2
is calculated as follows
s L Q / 87
3600 12
3750
=
=
The size of the maintenance drain can be established using the Mannings equation
assuming the drain/ pipe is flowing full and at 0.5 % grade:
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-36
n
S R A
Q
2
1
3
2
=
Where
Q = The mean flow rate required for maintenance (0.087m
3
/s)
A = Cross sectional area of pipe (m
2
)
R =
Hydraulic radius (m), equivalent to the cross sectional area divided by the
wetted perimeter
S = Slope of drainage pipe (0.5%)
n = Roughness coefficient (0.015m for finished concrete)
The pipe diameter is calculated to be 320mm.
The size of the valve can be established using the orifice equation, assuming the
orifice operates under inlet control:
h g 2 C
Q
A
d
o
=
Q = Flow (m
3
/s)
C
d
= Discharge Coefficient (0.6)
A
o
= Valve area (0.06m
2
)
g = 9.81 m/s
2
h = Hydraulic head (m)
The valve area is calculated as 0.06m
2
, given the discharge coefficient is 0.6 and h is
one third the hydraulic head. The equivalent diameter is 270mm.
Discharge Pipe
The discharge pipe of the wetland conveys the outflow of the macrophyte zone to the
receiving waters (or existing drainage infrastructure). Under normal operating
conditions, this pipe will need to have sufficient capacity to convey the larger of the
discharges from the riser (30L/s) or the maintenance drain (87L/s). Considering the
maintenance drain flow is the larger of the two flows the discharge pipe size is set to
the size of the maintenance drain (320mm pipe at 0.5% as calculated above).
Summary of Macrophyte Zone Outlet
Riser outlet = 225mm diameter pipe with following orifice detail:
Level Orifices Orifice Diameter
RL11.5 m 6 40 mm
RL11.625 m 4 40 mm
RL11.75 m 5 30 mm
RL11.875 m 3 30 mm
Maintenance drain = 320mm diameter pipe at 0.5% grade
Maintenance control = 2000 x 4000 mm with letter box grate set at RL11.7 m
Discharge pipe = 270mm diameter valve
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-37
Step 6 : Design High Flow Bypass Channel
The bypass channel accepts above design flow (100yr ARI = 6.0m
3
/s) from the inlet
zone (via the bypass weir) and conveys this flow around the macrophyte zone of the
wetland. The configuration of the bypass channel can be designed using Mannings
Equation:
n
S R A
Q
2
1
3
2
=
Where
Q = above design flow (100yr ARI = 6.0m
3
/s)
A = Cross sectional area (m
2
)
R =
Hydraulic radius (m), equivalent to the cross sectional area divided by the
wetted perimeter
S = Slope of drainage pipe (1.5%)
n = Roughness coefficient (0.035m for earth with gravel and weeds)
A turf finish is to be adopted for the bypass channel. A Mannings n of 0.035 (for earth
with gravel and weeds) stipulated in the Singapore Code of Practice on Surface Water
Drainage is considered appropriate for flow depths more than double the height of the
grass.
Assuming there is a 0.3m drop from the bypass weir crest to the upstream invert of the
bypass channel and 5(H):1(V) batters, the base width of the bypass channel can be
established by setting the maximum flow depth in the bypass channel at 0.3m. This
ensures flow in the channel does not backwater (i.e. submerge) the bypass weir.
For a base width of 19m, the flow through the channel is calculated as 9.0m
3
/s, which
is greater than the 100yr ARI flow. Hence, the bypass channel is adequately sized.
Step 7 Verification Checks
Macrophyte Zone Re-suspension Protection
A velocity check is to be conducted for when the wetland is at the top of the extended
detention level and the riser is operating at design capacity. This check is to ensure
velocities through the macrophyte zone (V
macrophyte zone
) are less than 0.05 m/s to avoid
potential scour of biofilms from the wetland plants (macrophytes) and re-suspension of
the sediments (Equation 10.3).
The flow rate through the riser was calculated as 30L/s. The cross sectional area
refers to the narrowest section of the wetland measured from the top of the extended
detention. The narrowest point in the wetland is the ephemeral marsh (refer to Figure
10.14). If the minimum depth at the top of the ephemeral marsh is 0.3m, and the
length of the wetland is 50m (given a cross sectional area of 15,000m
2
and a width to
length ratio of 1:6), the cross sectional area is 15m
2
. The velocity is calculated to be:
s m/ 05 . 0 002 . 0
15
03 . 0
=
Confirm Treatment Performance
The key functional elements of the constructed wetland developed as part of the
conceptual design (i.e. area, extended detention depth) were not adjusted as part of
the detailed design. Therefore, the performance check undertaken in Step 1 still
applies.
Step 8: Vegetation Specification
The vegetation specification for the various zones within the wetland will be advised
once the list of recommended plantings has been established by National Parks Board
of Singapore.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-38
10.7.3 Design Calculation Summary
The sheet below summarises the results of the design calculations.
Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 Chapter 10 - -- - Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands Constructed Wetlands
Engineering Procedures for ABC Waters Design Features Page 10-39
10.8 References
CRCCH (Cooperative Research Centre for Catchment Hydrology), 2003, Model for
Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC) User Guide, Version 2.0,
December
Engineers Australia, 2003, Australian Runoff Quality Guidelines, DRAFT, June
GbLA Landscape Architects, 2004, Preliminary drawings for Mernda Wetland, Report
for Stockland
Institution of Engineers Australia, 1997, Australian Rainfall and Runoff A guide to
flood estimation, Editor in Chief Pilgram, D.H.
Persson, J., Somes, N.L.G. and Wong T.H.F., 1999, Hydraulic efficiency and
constructed wetland and ponds, Water Science and Technology Vol 40 No 3 pp 291
289
Public Utilities Board (PUB), 2000, Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage, Fifth
Edition
Infiltration
11
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines
11 11 11 11
Chapter 11 Infiltration Systems
11.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................4
11.2 Design Considerations ....................................................................................................7
11.2.1. Design Objectives ............................................................................................................. 7
11.2.2. Selecting the Type of Infiltration System ............................................................................... 7
11.2.3. Design (Sizing) Methods .................................................................................................... 7
11.2.4. Pre-treatment of Stormwater ............................................................................................... 8
11.2.5. Site Terrain ...................................................................................................................... 9
11.2.6. In-Situ Soils...................................................................................................................... 9
11.2.7. Groundwater .................................................................................................................. 10
11.2.8. Building Setbacks (Clearances) ......................................................................................... 11
11.2.9. Flow Management .......................................................................................................... 11
11.3. Design Process ......................................................................................................12
11.3.1. Step 1: Site and Soil Evaluation ........................................................................................ 13
11.3.2. Step 2: Confirm Design Objectives .................................................................................... 13
11.3.3. Step 3: Select Infiltration System Type ............................................................................... 13
11.3.4. Step 4: Pre-treatment Design ............................................................................................ 13
11.3.5. Step 5: Determine Design Flows ....................................................................................... 13
11.3.6. Step 6: Size Infiltration System .......................................................................................... 14
11.3.7. Step 7: Locate Infiltration System ...................................................................................... 15
11.3.8. Step 8: Set Infiltration Depths (sub-surface systems only) ..................................................... 15
11.3.9. Step 9: Specify Infiltration Detention Volume Elements ........................................................ 15
11.3.10. Step 10: Flow Management Design ................................................................................ 16
11.3.11. Step 11: Consider Maintenance Requirements ................................................................. 18
11.3.12. Design Calculation Summary ........................................................................................ 19
11.4. Construction and Establishment ................................................................................21
11.4.1. Maintenance Requirements .............................................................................................. 21
11.5. Checking Tools ........................................................................................................22
11.5.1. Design Assessment Checklist ........................................................................................... 22
11.5.2. Construction Checklist ..................................................................................................... 22
11.5.3. Operation and Maintenance Inspection Form ...................................................................... 22
11.5.4. Asset Transfer Checklist .................................................................................................. 22
11.6. Infiltration measure worked example .........................................................................27
11.6.1. Worked example introduction ............................................................................................ 27
11.6.2. Step 1: Site and Soil Evaluation ........................................................................................ 28
11.6.3. Step 2: Confirm Design Objectives .................................................................................... 29
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines
11.6.4. Step 3: Select Infiltration System Type ............................................................................... 29
11.6.5. Step 4: Pre-treatment Design ............................................................................................ 29
11.6.6. Step 5: Determine Design Flows ....................................................................................... 29
11.6.7. Step 6: Size Infiltration System .......................................................................................... 30
11.6.8. Step 7: Locate Infiltration System ...................................................................................... 30
11.6.9. Step 8: Set Infiltration Depths............................................................................................ 30
11.6.10. Step 9: Specify Infiltration Detention Volume Elements .................................................... 31
11.6.11. Step 10: Hydraulic Control Design .................................................................................. 31
11.6.12. Perforated Inflow Pipes ................................................................................................ 32
11.6.13. Bypass Design ............................................................................................................ 33
11.6.14. Design Calculation Summary ........................................................................................ 35
11.7. References .............................................................................................................37
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 4
11.1 Introduction
Stormwater infiltration systems capture stormwater runoff and encourage infiltration into
surrounding in-situ soils and underlying groundwater. This has the benefit of reducing
stormwater runoff peak flows and volumes, reducing downstream flooding, managing the
hydrologic regime entering downstream aquatic ecosystems and improving groundwater
recharge.
The purpose of infiltration systems in a stormwater management strategy is as a
conveyance measure (to capture and infiltrate flows), NOT as a stormwater treatment
system. Appropriate pre-treatment of stormwater entering infiltration systems is required
to avoid clogging and to protect groundwater quality.
Infiltration systems generally consist of a detention volume and an infiltration area (or
infiltration surface):
The detention volume can be located above or below ground and is designed to
detain a certain volume of runoff and make it available for infiltration. When the
detention volume is exceeded, the system is designed to overflow to the
downstream drainage systems and the receiving environment.
The infiltration area is the surface or interface between the detention volume
and the in-situ soils through which the collected water is infiltrated.
The application of infiltration systems is best suited to moderately to highly permeable in-
situ soils (i.e. sandy loam to sandy soils); however, infiltration systems can still be applied
in locations with less permeable soils by providing larger detention volumes and
infiltration areas.
There are four basic types of infiltration systems:
Leaky Well
A leaky well is typically used in small scale residential applications and consists of a
vertical perforated pipe (concrete or PVC) and an open base (Figure 11.1). Pretreated
stormwater enters via an inlet pipe at the top of the well and when the detention volume
is full, an overflow pipe delivers excess waters to the downstream drainage system. The
perforations in the open pipe and the base are covered with a geotextile (non-woven) and
the pipe is surrounded by a ring of clean gravel (5 - 10 mm particle size diameter).
Figure 11.1 Leaky Well Infiltration System (Engineers Australia 2006)
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 5
Infiltration Trench
Infiltration trenches consist of a trench, typically 0.5 - 1.5 m deep, filled with gravel or
modular plastic cells lined with geotextile (non-woven) and placed under 300 mm of
backfill (topsoil or sandy loam). Pretreated runoff enters the trench either directly or via
an inlet control pit, with excess waters delivered downstream via an overflow pipe. If the
trench contains gravel fill then a perforated distribution pipe is incorporated into the
system to ensure effective distribution of stormwater into the detention volume. A typical
configuration of an infiltration trench is shown in Figure 11.2.
Figure 11.2 Infiltration Trench (Engineers Australia 2006)
Infiltration Soak-away
Soak-aways are similar to trenches in operation but have a larger plan area, being
typically rectangular, and of shallower depth (Figure 11.3). Infiltration soak-aways can be
applied across a range of scales from residential allotments through to open space or
parklands.
Figure 11.3 Operation of a Gravel Filled Trench or Soak-away Type Infiltration
System
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 6
Infiltration Basin
Infiltration basins are typically used in larger scale applications where space is not a
constraint (e.g. parklands). They consist of natural or constructed depressions designed
to capture and store stormwater runoff on the surface (i.e. the detention volume is located
above ground) prior to infiltration into the in-situ soils (Figure 11.4).
A typical section through an infiltration basin is provided in Figure 11.5. Infiltration basins
are best suited to sand or sandy-clay in-situ soils and can be planted out with a range of
vegetation to blend into the local landscape. Pre-treatment of stormwater entering
infiltration basins is required with the level of pre-treatment varying depending on in-situ
soil type and basin vegetation. Further guidance in this regard is provided in
Section11.2.4.
Figure 11.4 Infiltration Basin
Figure 11.5 Infiltration Basin Typical Section
Detention volume (surface ponding)
In-situ soil
Gravel
(optional)
Sandy loam or in-situ soil
Turf or
mass planting
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 7
11.2 Design Considerations
11.2.1. Design Objectives
Infiltration systems can be designed to achieve a range of objectives including:
Minimising the volume of stormwater runoff from a development
Preserving pre-development hydrology
Capturing and infiltrating flows up to a particular design flow
Enhancing groundwater recharge or preserving pre-development groundwater
recharge.
The design objective will vary from one location to another and will depend on site
characteristics, development form and the requirements of the receiving ecosystems. It is
essential that these objectives are established as part of the conceptual design process
and approved by the Public Utilities Board prior to commencing the engineering design.
11.2.2. Selecting the Type of Infiltration System
Selection of the type of infiltration system for a particular application must occur as part of
the conceptual design process (i.e. Site Based Stormwater Management Plan) by
assessing the site conditions against the relative merits of the four basic types of
infiltration systems described in Section 0. There is a range of resources available to
assist with this selection process, including Australian Runoff Quality (Engineers Australia
2006), Water Sensitive Urban Design: Basic Procedures for Source Control of
Stormwater (Argue 2004) and Water Sensitive Urban Design: Technical Guidelines for
Western Sydney (UPRCT 2004).
In general, selection of the type of infiltration system is determined by the size of the
contributing catchment. Table 11.1 provides guidance on selection by listing the type of
infiltration systems against typical scales of application.
Table 11.1 Infiltration Types and Associated Application Scales
Infiltration Type
Allotment Scale
(< 0.1 ha)*
Medium Scale
(0.1 - 10 ha)*
Large Scale
(> 10 ha)*
Leaky Wells
Infiltration Trenches
Infiltration Soak-aways
Infiltration Basins
* Catchment area directing flow to the infiltration system
11.2.3. Design (Sizing) Methods
Establishing the size of an infiltration system requires consideration of the volume and
frequency of runoff discharged into the infiltration system, the available detention volume
and the infiltration rate (product of infiltration area and hydraulic conductivity of in-situ
soils). The approach for establishing these design elements depends on the design
objectives as outlined in Section 11.2.1. For the purposes of these guidelines, the
infiltration system design objectives can be addressed by two design methods: the
hydrologic effectiveness method and the design storm method. These methods are
summarised in
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 8
Table 11.2 and discussed in the following sections.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 9
Table 11.2 Design (Sizing) Methods to Deliver Infiltration System Design Objectives
Infiltration Design objective
*Hydrologic Effectiveness
Method
*Design Storm
Method
Minimise the volume of stormwater runoff from a
development
Preserve pre-development hydrology
Capture and infiltrate flows up to a particular design flow
Enhance groundwater recharge or preserve pre-
development groundwater recharge
11.2.3.1. Hydrologic Effectiveness Method
Where the design objective is the infiltration of a specific proportion of the mean annual
runoff, the hydraulic effectiveness approach can be adopted for sizing infiltration systems.
For a given catchment area and meteorological conditions, the hydrologic effectiveness
of an infiltration system is determined by the combined effect of the quality and quantity
of runoff, the detention volume, in-situ soil hydraulic conductivity and infiltration area.
The hydrologic effectiveness of an infiltration system requires long term continuous
simulation which can be undertaken using the Model for Urban Stormwater Improvement
Conceptualisation (MUSIC) (CRCCH 2005). However, in most situations, where a
number of the design considerations can be fixed (i.e. frequency of runoff, depth of
detention storage, saturated hydraulic conductivity); hydrologic effectiveness curves can
be generated and used as the design tool for establishing the infiltration system size.
The hydrologic effectiveness curves derived for infiltration systems (with defined
parameters) located in Singapore are presented in Section 11.3.6.1 and represent Step 6
in the design steps required for infiltration measures.
11.2.3.2. Design Storm Method
Where the design objective for a particular infiltration system is peak discharge
attenuation or the capture and infiltration of a particular design storm event (e.g. 3-month
ARI event), then the design storm approach can be adopted for sizing the infiltration
system.
This method involves defining the required detention volume by comparing the volume
of inflow and outflow for a particular design storm, and then calculating the infiltration
area to ensure the system empties within a specified period of time. This approach
requires further development for application in Singapore and therefore, unless otherwise
approved by Public Utilities Board, the Hydrologic Effectiveness Method must be used.
9.1.111.2.4. Pre-treatment of Stormwater
Pre-treatment of stormwater entering an infiltration system is primarily required to
minimise the potential for clogging of the infiltration media and to protect groundwater
quality. In line with these requirements, there are two levels of stormwater pre-treatment
required:
Level 1 Pre-treatment - To prevent blockage of the infiltration system media, stormwater
should be treated to remove coarse and medium sized sediments and litter. Level 1 pre-
treatment applies to all four types of infiltration system.
Level 2 Pre-treatment - To protect groundwater quality, pre-treatment is required to
remove fine particulates and dissolved pollutants, such as nutrients and metals. This
second level of treatment is the most stringent as any stormwater infiltrated must be of
equal, or preferably superior, quality to that of the receiving groundwater to ensure the
groundwater quality and values are protected. To determine an appropriate level of pre-
treatment, assessment in consultation with PUB of the groundwater aquifer quality,
possible uses and suitability of treated stormwater for recharge is required.
Formatted: Indent: Hanging: 2.55
cm, Outline numbered + Level: 3 +
Numbering Style: 1, 2, 3, + Start at:
1 + Alignment: Left + Aligned at: 1.11
cm + Indent at: 2.38 cm, Tab stops:
0.95 cm, Left + 1.27 cm, Left
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 10
Level 2 pre-treatment applies to leaky wells, infiltration trenches and infiltration soak-
aways. It also applies to most infiltration basin applications. However, level 2 pre-
treatment is not required if the infiltration system can be designed to function as a
bioretention system i.e. where basins are located on sandy loam to clay soils of low
hydraulic conductivity (<180 mm/hr) and the depth to groundwater is greater than 1.0 m.
The system can be planted out with rush and reed species and pollutant removal takes
place prior to waters entering the underlying groundwater. A summary of pre-treatment
requirements for each of the infiltration system types is presented in Table 11.3.
Table 11.3 Pre-treatment Requirements for Each Type of Infiltration System
Infiltration Type
Level 1
Pre-treatment
Level 2
Pre-treatment
Leaky Well
Infiltration Trench
Infiltration Soak-away
Infiltration Basin
- Sandy clay to clay soils (Ksat < 180 mm/hr) + dense
ground cover
- Sandy clay to clay soils (Ksat < 180 mm/hr) + turf ground
cover
- Sandy soils (Ksat > 180 mm/hr)
Note K
sat
= saturated hydraulic conductivity (mm/hr) of in-situ soil (see Section
11.2.6.1)
11.2.4.11.2.5. Site Terrain
Infiltration into steep terrain can result in stormwater re-emerging onto the surface at
some point downslope. The likelihood of this pathway for infiltrated water is dependent on
the soil structure. Duplex soils and shallow soil over rock create situations where re-
emergence of infiltrated water to the surface is most likely to occur. These soil conditions
do not necessarily preclude infiltrating stormwater, unless leaching of soil salt is
associated with this process. The provision for managing this pathway will need to be
taken into consideration at the design stage to ensure hazards or nuisance to
downstream sites are avoided.
Additionally, the introduction of infiltration systems on steep terrain can increase the risk
of slope instability. Installation of infiltration systems on slopes greater than 10 % will not
be approved by the Public Utilities Board unless a detailed engineering assessment has
been undertaken.
11.2.5.11.2.6. In-Situ Soils
11.2.5.1.11.2.6.1. Hydraulic Conductivity
Hydraulic conductivity of the in-situ soil is the rate at which water passes through a soil
medium. It influences both the suitability of infiltration systems and the size of the
infiltration area. Therefore, it is essential that field measurement of hydraulic conductivity
be undertaken to confirm assumptions of soil hydraulic conductivity adopted during the
concept design stage. The determination of hydraulic conductivity must be undertaken in
accordance with procedures which provides an estimate of saturated hydraulic
conductivity (K
sat
)(i.e. the hydraulic conductivity of a soil when it is fully saturated with
water). The typical ranges of saturated hydraulic conductivities for homogeneous soils
are provided in Table 11.4.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 11
Table 11.4 Typical Soil Types and Associated Saturate Hydraulic Conductivity
(Engineers Australia 2006)
Soil Type
Saturated Hydraulic Conductivity
m/s mm/hr
Coarse Sand >1 x 10-4 >360
Sand 5 x 10-5 to 1 x 10-4 180 360
Sandy Loam 1 x 10-5 to 5 x 10-5 36 to 180
Sandy Clay 1 x 10-6 to 1 x 10-5 3.6 to 36
Medium clay 1 x 10-7 to 1 x 10-6 0.36 3.6
Heavy Clay 1 x 10-7 0.0 to 0.36
When assessing the appropriateness of infiltration systems and the type of in-situ soils,
the following issues must be considered:
Soils with a saturated hydraulic conductivity of 3.6 mm/hr to 360 mm/hr are preferred for
infiltration application.
Infiltration systems are neither appropriate nor functional where the in-situ soils are very
heavy clays (i.e. < 0.36 mm/hr).
Soils with a low hydraulic conductivity (0.36 - 3.6 mm/hr) do not necessarily preclude the
use of infiltration systems even though the required infiltration/ storage area may become
prohibitively large. However, soils with lower hydraulic conductivities will be more
susceptible to clogging and will therefore require enhanced pre-treatment to remove
sediment.
11.2.5.2.11.2.6.2. Soil Salinity
Infiltration systems must be avoided in areas with poor soil conditions, in particular sodic/
saline and dispersive soils, and shallow saline groundwater. If the Site and Soil
Evaluation (refer to Section 11.3.1) identifies poor soil conditions, then the Public Utilities
Board will not approve the use of infiltration systems.
11.2.5.3.11.2.6.3. Impermeable Subsoil, Rock and Shale
Infiltration systems must not be placed in locations where soils are underlain by rock or a
soil layer with little or no permeability (i.e. K
sat
< 0.36 mm/hr). In locations where fractured
or weathered rocks prevail, the use of infiltration systems may be approved by the Public
Utilities Board provided detailed engineering testing has been carried out to ensure the
rock will accept infiltration.
11.2.6.11.2.7. Groundwater
11.2.6.1.11.2.7.1. Groundwater Quality
As outlined in Section 11.2.4, the suitability of infiltrating stormwater and the necessary
pre-treatment requires assessment of the groundwater quality. The principle legislation
governing the management of groundwater quality is that there should be no
deterioration in groundwater quality. This means the stormwater being infiltrated must be
of equal or preferably superior quality to that of the receiving groundwater in order to
ensure the groundwater quality and values are protected. To determine an appropriate
level of pre-treatment for stormwater, assessment of the groundwater aquifer quality,
possible uses and suitability for recharge is required and must be approved by the public
Utilities Board.
11.2.6.2.11.2.7.2. Groundwater Table
A second groundwater related design consideration is to ensure that the base of an
infiltration system is always above the groundwater table. It is generally recommended
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 12
that the base of the infiltration system be a minimum of 1.0 m above the seasonal high
water table.
If a shallow groundwater table is likely to be encountered, investigation of the seasonal
variation of groundwater levels is essential. This should include an assessment of
potential groundwater mounding (i.e. localised raising of the water table in the immediate
vicinity of the infiltration system) that in shallow groundwater areas could cause problems
with nearby structures.
11.2.7.11.2.8. Building Setbacks (Clearances)
Infiltration systems should not be placed near building footings to avoid the influence of
continually wet sub-surface or greatly varying soil moisture content on the structural
integrity. Australian Runoff Quality (Engineers Australia 2006) recommends minimum
distances from structures and property boundaries (to protect possible future buildings in
neighbouring properties) for different soil types. These values are shown in Table 11.5.
Table 11.5 Minimum Setback Distances (adapted from Engineers Australia 2006)
Soil Type
Saturated Hydraulic
Conductivity
(mm/hr)
Minimum distance from
structures and property
boundaries
Sands >180 1.0 m
Sandy Loam 36 to 180 2.0 m
Sandy Clay 3.6 to 36 4.0 m
Medium to Heavy Clay 0.0 to 3.6 5.0 m
11.2.8.11.2.9. Flow Management
The following issues should be considered when designing the hydraulic control
structures within infiltration systems:
For large scale systems (i.e. infiltration basins), the surface of the infiltration
area must be flat to ensure uniform distribution of flow and to prevent hydraulic
overloading on a small portion of the infiltration area.
For gravel filled infiltration systems, flow should be delivered to the detention
volume via a perforated pipe(s) network that is located and sized to convey the
design flow into the infiltration systems and allow distribution of flows across the
entire infiltration area.
Where possible, above design flows will bypass the infiltration systems. This
can be achieved in a number of ways. For smaller applications, an overflow pipe
or pit, which is connected to the downstream drainage system, can be used. For
larger applications, a discharge control pit can be located upstream of the
infiltration system. This will function much like the inlet zone of a constructed
wetland to regulate flows (i.e. 1 year ARI) into the infiltration systems and bypass
above design flows (i.e. > 1 year ARI).
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 13
11.3. Design Process
The following sections detail the design steps required for infiltration measures. Key
design steps are as follows:-
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 14
11.3.1. Step 1: Site and Soil Evaluation
As outlined in Section 11.2.6, there are a range of site and soil conditions which influence
infiltration system design. To define the sites capability to infiltrate stormwater, a Site
and Soil Evaluation must be undertaken. The evaluation should provide the following:
Soil type
Hydraulic conductivity
Presence of soil salinity (where applicable)
Presence of rock shale
Slope of terrain (%)
Groundwater details (depth, quality and uses).
11.3.2. Step 2: Confirm Design Objectives
This step involves confirming the design objectives, defined as part of the conceptual
design, to ensure the correct infiltration system design method is selected (refer to Table
11.2).
11.3.3. Step 3: Select Infiltration System Type
This step involves selecting the type of infiltration system by assessing the site conditions
against the relative merits of the four infiltration systems described in Section 0. In
general, the scale of application dictates selection of the infiltration system. Table 11.1
provides guidance in this regard.
For further guidance in selecting infiltration systems, designer should refer to Australian
Runoff Quality (Engineers Australia 2006), Water Sensitive Urban Design: Basic
Procedures for Source Control of Stormwater (Argue 2004) and the Water Sensitive
Urban Design: Technical Guidelines for Western Sydney (UPRCT 2004).
11.3.4. Step 4: Pre-treatment Design
As outlined in Section 11.2.4 and Table 11.3, both Level 1 Pre-treatment (minimising risk
of clogging) and Level 2 Pre-treatment (groundwater protection) are required for all
infiltration systems except for specific infiltration basin applications. To determine Level 2
requirements, an assessment of the groundwater must be undertaken to define existing
water quality, potential uses (current and future) and suitability for recharge.
Pre-treatment measures for roof runoff include the provision of leaf and roof litter guards
along the roof gutter and rainwater tanks. Pre-treatment for urban runoff includes
sediment basins, vegetated swales, bioretention systems or constructed wetlands as
outlined in the other chapters of this guideline.
11.3.5. Step 5: Determine Design Flows
11.3.5.1. Design Flows
To configure the inflow system and high flow bypass elements of the infiltration system
the following design flows generally apply:
Design operation flow for sizing the inlet to the infiltration system. This will
typically correspond to one of the following:
o 1 year ARI or less for situations where a discharge control pit is used to
regulate flows into the infiltration system and bypass larger flows
o 2 - 10 year ARI (minor design flow, typically the 5 year ARI event in
Singapore) for situations where the minor drainage system is directed
to the infiltration system.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 15
Above design flow for design of the high flow bypass around the infiltration
system. The discharge capacity for the bypass system may vary depending on
the particular situation but will typically correspond to one of the following:
o 2 - 10 year ARI (minor design flow) for situations where only the minor
drainage system is directed to the infiltration system.
o 50 - 100 year ARI (major design flow) for situations where both the
minor and major drainage system discharge to the infiltration system.
9.1.1.111.3.5.2. Design Flow Estimation
A range of hydrologic methods can be applied to estimate design flows. If typical
catchment areas are relatively small, the Rational Method design procedure is
considered suitable. However, if the infiltration system is to form part of a detention basin
or if the catchment area to the system is large (> 50 ha) then a full flood routing
computation method should be used to estimate design flows.
9.1.211.3.6. Step 6: Size Infiltration System
As outlined in Section 11.2.3, there are two design methods available for establishing the
size of the detention volume and infiltration area of infiltration systems: the hydrologic
effectiveness method and the design storm method. Unless otherwise approved by the
Public Utilities Board, the hydrologic effectiveness method must be used when designing
infiltration systems.
9.1.2.111.3.6.1. Hydrologic Effectiveness Method
Figure 11.6 below shows the relationship between the hydrologic effectiveness,
infiltration area and detention storage for a range of soil hydraulic conductivities,
detention storage depths and detention storage volumes (adjusted for media porosity) for
the reference station 43 in Singapore. The curves were derived using the Model for
Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation.
The curves in Figure 11.6 are generally applicable to infiltration measure applications
within residential, industrial and commercial land uses. If the configuration of the
infiltration measure concept design is significantly different to that described below then
the curves may not provide an accurate indication of performance and the detailed
designer should use MUSIC to size the infiltration system.
The curves were derived conservatively assuming that the systems have the following
characteristics:
varying in-situ soil hydraulic conductivity
detention volume area was confined to the space allocated for the infiltration
area
detention volume effective depth of 1.0 m. Note that this is equivalent to an
actual depth 1 m when the media porosity is 1.0 (i.e. an open detention volume
with no fill media) or 3.0 m and porosity of 0.33 (gravel filled detention volume)
These curves can be used to establish the size of both the detention volume and
infiltration area of the infiltration systems to achieve a particular hydrologic effectiveness.
The designer is required to select the relevant hydrologic effectiveness curve by
establishing the likely configuration and form of the infiltration system, namely whether it
will be an open void detention volume (porosity = 1.0) or gravel filled (porosity = 0.35).
If linear interpolation between the curves is used to estimate the infiltration area required
for systems with hydraulic conductivities between those shown on the charts, it should be
noted that the relationship between the curves is not linear. As a result, these
interpolations do not provide an exact representation of the size of infiltration area as a %
Formatted: Indent: Hanging: 3.19
cm, Outline numbered + Level: 4 +
Numbering Style: 1, 2, 3, + Start at:
1 + Alignment: Left + Aligned at: 1.92
cm + Indent at: 3.19 cm, Tab stops:
1.9 cm, Left
Formatted: Indent: Hanging: 2.55
cm, Outline numbered + Level: 3 +
Numbering Style: 1, 2, 3, + Start at:
1 + Alignment: Left + Aligned at: 1.11
cm + Indent at: 2.38 cm, Tab stops:
1.27 cm, Left
Formatted: Indent: Left: 0 cm,
Hanging: 1.9 cm, Outline numbered +
Level: 4 + Numbering Style: 1, 2, 3,
+ Start at: 1 + Alignment: Left +
Aligned at: 1.92 cm + Indent at: 3.19
cm
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 16
of catchment area. Designers must be careful not to under size infiltration areas through
this process.
Hydrolog ic E ffec tivenes s
0%
10%
20%
30%
40%
50%
60%
70%
80%
90%
100%
0 2 4 6 8 10 12
Infiltration Bas in Area (% impervious catchment (as s umed to be 1m effective depth - accounting for media poros ity)
H
y
d
r
o
l
o
g
i
c
E
f
f
e
c
t
i
v
e
n
e
s
s
(
%
)
3.6mm/h r
36mm/hr
360mm/hr
1800mm/hr
3600mm/hr
S aturated Hydraulic
C onductivity of in-s itu
s oil
Figure 11.6 Hydrologic Effectiveness of Detention Storages for Infiltration
Systems [Reference Station 43]
11.3.6.11.3.7. Step 7: Locate Infiltration System
This step involves locating the infiltration system in accordance with the requirement set
out in Section 11.2.8 and Table 11.5 to minimise the risk of damage to structures from
wetting and drying of soils (i.e. swelling and shrinking of soils and slope stability).
11.3.7.11.3.8. Step 8: Set Infiltration Depths (sub-surface systems only)
For sub-surface infiltration systems, selection of the optimum depth requires
consideration of the seasonal high water table and the appropriate cover of soil to the
surface.
Seasonal groundwater table - As outlined in Section 11.2.7.2, it is generally
recommended that the base of the infiltration system be a minimum of 1 m above
the seasonal high water table.
Cover (i.e. depth of soil above top of infiltration system) Minimum cover of 0.3
m. For systems created using modular plastic cell storage units, an engineering
assessment is required.
11.3.8.11.3.9. Step 9: Specify Infiltration Detention Volume Elements
The following design and specification requirements must be documented as part of the
design process for leaky wells, infiltration trenches and soak-aways.
11.3.8.1.11.3.9.1. Gravel
Where the infiltration detention volume is created through the use of a gravel-filled
trench then the gravel must be a uniform size of between 25 - 100 mm diameter and
must be clean (free of fines).
11.3.8.2.11.3.9.2. Modular Plastic Cells
Where the infiltration detention volume is created through the use of modular plastic cells,
the design must be accompanied by an engineering assessment of the plastic cells and
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 17
their appropriateness considering the loading above the infiltration system. A minimum
150 mm thick layer of coarse sand or fine gravel must underlie the base of the plastic
cells.
11.3.8.3.11.3.9.3. Geofabric
Geofabric must be installed along the side walls and through the base of the infiltration
detention volume to prevent the migration of in-situ soils into the system. For this reason,
in infiltration systems the use of non-woven geofabric with a minimum perforation or
mesh of 0.25 mm is most appropriate.
11.3.8.4.11.3.9.4. Inspection Wells
It is good design practice to install inspection wells at numerous locations in an infiltration
system. This allows water levels to be monitored during and after storm events and for
infiltration rates to be confirmed over time.
11.3.9.11.3.10. Step 10: Flow Management Design
The design of the hydraulic control for infiltration systems varies for the different
systems. For smaller applications, all pretreated flows will enter directly into the
system and an overflow pipe or pit will be used to convey excess flow to the
drainage system. For larger applications, a discharge control pit will be located
of the infiltration system. This control pit functions to regulate flows for the
interval (3-month ARI) into the infiltration systems and acts to bypass flows
design criteria (> 3-month ARI) in a manner similar to the inlet zone of a
wetland.
Table 11.6 summarises the typical hydraulic control requirements for the different types
of infiltration system.
Table 11.6 Typical Hydraulic Control Requirements for Infiltration Systems
Infiltration Type
Inflow Overflow/ Bypass
Direct inflow
Discharge
control pit
Overflow pipe/ pit
Discharge
control pit
Leaky Wells
Infiltration Trenches
Infiltration Soak-aways
Infiltration Basins
Note: For gravel filled infiltration systems, flow should be delivered to the detention volume via a perforated
pipe network.
The hydraulic control measures described in
Table 11.6 are designed using the following techniques.
11.3.9.1.11.3.10.1. Pipe Flows (Inflow Pipe and Overflow Pipe)
Pipe flows are to be calculated in accordance the Singapore Code of Practice which use
standard pipe equations that account for energy losses associated with inlet and outlet
conditions and friction losses within the pipe. For most applications, the pipe or culvert
will operate under outlet control with the inlet and outlet of the pipe/ culvert being fully
submerged. With relatively short pipe connections, friction losses are typically small and
can be computed using Mannings equation.
11.3.9.2.11.3.10.2. Perforated Inflow Pipes
Two design checks are required to ensure that the perforated inflow pipes within the
gravel of the filled infiltration systems have sufficient capacity to convey the design
operation flow (Section 11.3.5) and distribute this flow into the infiltration system,:
Ensure the pipe itself has capacity to convey the design operation flow
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 18
Ensure the perforations are adequate to pass the design operation flow.
It is recommended that the maximum spacing of the perforated pipes is 3 m (centres) and
that the minimum grade is 0.5 % from the inflow point. The inflow pipes should be
extended to the surface of the infiltration system to allow inspection and maintenance
when required. The base of the infiltration system must remain flat.
Perforated Pipe Conveyance
To confirm the capacity of the perforated pipes to convey the design operation flow,
Mannings equation can be used (which assumes pipe full flow but not under pressure).
When completing this calculation it should be noted that installing multiple perforated
pipes in parallel is a means of increasing the capacity of the perforated pipe system.
Perforated Pipe Slot Conveyance
The capacity of the slots in the perforated pipe needs to be greater than the maximum
infiltration rate to ensure the slots does not become the hydraulic control in the
infiltration system (i.e. to ensure the in-situ soils and detention volume set the hydraulic
behaviour rather than the slots in the perforated pipe). To do this, orifice flow can be
assumed to occur through the slots and the sharp edged orifice equation used to
calculate the flow through the slots for the full length of perforated pipe. Firstly, the
number and size of perforations needs to be determined (typically from manufacturers
specifications) and used to estimate the flow rate out of the pipes, with the driving head
being the difference between the overflow level and the invert of the perforated pipe. It is
conservative, but reasonable, to use a blockage factor to account for partial blockage of
the perforations. A 50 % blockage should be used.
h g 2 A C B Q
d perf
= Equation 11-1
Where
Q
perf
= flow through perforations (m
3
/s)
B = blockage factor (0.5)
C
d
= orifice discharge coefficient (assume 0.61 for sharp edge orifice)
A = total area of the perforations (m
2
)
g = gravity (9.79 m/s
2
)
h = head above the centroid of the perforated pipe (m)
If the capacity of the perforated pipe system is unable to convey the design operation
flow then additional perforated pipes will be required.
11.3.9.3.11.3.10.3. Overflow Pit
To size an overflow pit, two checks should be made to test for either drowned or free
flowing conditions. A broad crested weir equation can be used to determine the length of
weir required (assuming free flowing conditions) and an orifice equation used to estimate
the area between openings required in the grate cover (assuming drowned outlet
conditions). A blockage factor is to be used that assumes the grate is 50 % blocked.
While the smaller of the two would normally suffice, the larger of the two pit
configurations should be adopted to provide a level of conservatism. Furthermore, the
size of the pit should also be selected to ensure that it would adequately accommodate
the stormwater pipe draining from it.
For free overfall conditions (weir equation):
2 / 3
w weir
h L C B Q =
Equation 11-2
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 19
Where
Q
weir
= flow into pit (weir) under free overfall conditions (m
3
/s)
B = blockage factor (= 0.5)
C
w
= weir coefficient (= 1.66)
L = length of weir (perimeter of pit) (m)
h = flow depth above the weir (pit) (m)
Once the length of weir is calculated, a standard sized pit can be selected with a
perimeter at least the same length of the required weir length.
For drowned outlet conditions (orifice equation):
h g 2 A C B Q
d orifice
=
Equation 11-3
Where B, g and h have the same meaning as above
Q
orifice
= flow rate into pit under drowned conditions (m
3
/s)
C
d
= discharge coefficient for sharp edge orifice (adopt 0.6)
A = area of orifice (perforations in inlet grate) (m
2
)
When designing grated field inlet pits, reference is to the requirements of the Public
Utilities Board.
11.3.9.4.11.3.10.4. Overflow Weir
In applications where infiltration systems require a discharge control pit, a spillway outlet
weir will form part of the high flow bypass system to convey the above design flow. The
spillway outlet weir level will be set at the top of the detention storage to ensure
catchment flows bypass the infiltration system once the detention volume is full. The
length of the spillway outlet weir is to be sized to safely pass the maximum flow
discharged to the discharge control pit (as defined the above design flow in Section
11.3.5).
The required length of the spillway outlet weir can be computed using the weir flow
equation (Equation 11.2) and the above design flow (Section 11.3.5).
11.3.10.11.3.11. Step 11: Consider Maintenance Requirements
Consider how maintenance is to be performed on the infiltration system (e.g. how and
where is access available, where sediment likely to collect etc.). A specific maintenance
plan and schedule should be developed for the infiltration system, either as part of a
maintenance plan for the whole treatment train, or for each individual asset. Guidance on
maintenance plans is provided in Section 11.4.1.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 20
11.3.11.11.3.12. Design Calculation Summary
Following is a design calculation summary sheet for the key design elements of an
infiltration system to aid the design process.
INFILTRATION SYSTEMS DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Calculation Task Outcome Check
Catchment Characteristics
Catchment area ha
Catchment landuse (i.e residential, commercial etc.)
Storm event entering infiltration system (minor or major) year ARI
1 Site and soil evaluation
Site and Soil Evaluation' undertaken in accordance with AS1547-2000 Clause 4.1.3
Soil type
Hydraulic conductivity (Ksat) mm/hr
Presence of soil salinity
Presence of rock/shale
Infiltration site terrain (% slope)
Groundwater level m HD
m below surface
Groundwater quality
Groundwater uses
2 Confirm design objectives
Confirm design objective as defined by conceptual design
3 Select infiltration system type
Leaky Well
Infiltration Trench
Infiltration 'Soak-away'
Infiltration Basin
4 Pre-treatment design
Level 1 Pre-treatment (avoid clogging)
Level 2 Pre-treatment (groundwater quality protection)
5 Determine design flows
'Design operation flow' (i.e. 1 year ARI) year ARI
'Above design flow' (i.e. 2 - 100 year ARI) year ARI
Time of concentration
minutes
Identify rainfall intensities
'Design operation flow' - I1 year ARI mm/hr
'Above design flow'- I2 100 year ARI mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient
'Design operation flow' - C1 year ARI
'Above design flow'- C2 100 year ARI
Peak design flows
'Design operation flow' - 1 year ARI m
3
/s
'Above design flow' (2-100 year ARI) m
3
/s
6 Size infiltration system
Hydrologic effectiveness approach
Hydrologic effectiveness objective %
Depth m
Porosity (void = 1.0, gravel filled = 0.35)
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 21
INFILTRATION SYSTEMS DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Calculation Task Outcome Check
'Infiltration Area' m
2
'Detention Volume' m
3
7 Locate infiltration system
Minimum distance from boundary (Table 11.5) m
Width m
Length m
8 Set infiltration depths (sub-surface systems only)
Ground surface level m HD
Groundwater level m HD
m below surface
Infiltration system depth m
Top of infiltration system m HD
Base of infiltration system m HD
Cover m
Depth to water table m
9 Specify infiltration 'detention volume' elements
Gravel size mm diam.
Modular plastic cells
Geofabric
10 Flow management design
Inflow/Overflow structures
Direct inflow
Overflow pit/pipe
Discharge control pit
Discharge pipe
Pipe capacity m
3
/s
Pipe size mm diam.
Inflow pipe
Pipe capacity m
3
/s
Pipe size mm diam.
Overflow pipe
Pipe capacity m
3
/s
Pipe size mm diam.
Overflow pit
Pit capacity m
3
/s
Pit size mm x mm
Perforated inflow pipes
No. of pipes
Pipe size mm
Discharge control pit
Pit size mm x mm
Weir length m
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 22
11.4. Construction and Establishment
It is important to note in the context of a development site and associated
construction/building works, delivering infiltration measures can be a challenging task.
Construction activities which can generate large sediment loads in runoff
which can clog infiltration measures
Construction traffic and other works can result in damage to the infiltration
measures.
A careful construction and establishment approach is needed to ensure that the
system is delivered in accordance with its design intent. A staged construction and
establishment methodology for infiltration measures is provided in Leinster (2006).
11.4.1. Maintenance Requirements
Maintenance for infiltration measures aims at ensuring the system does not clog with
sediments and that an appropriate infiltration rate is maintained. The most important
consideration during maintenance is to ensure the pre-treatment elements are
operating as designed to prevent sediments from blocking the infiltration measure and
to prevent groundwater contamination.
To ensure the system is operating as designed, the infiltration zone should be
inspected every 1 - 6 months (or after each major rainfall event) depending on the size
and complexity of the system. Typical maintenance of infiltration systems will involve:
Routine inspection to identify any surface ponding after the design infiltration
period, which would indicate clogging/ blockage of the underlying aggregate or
the base of the trench.
Routine inspection of inlet points to identify any areas of scour, litter build up,
sediment accumulation or blockages.
Removal of accumulated sediment and clearing of blockages to inlets.
Tilling of the infiltration surface, or removing the surface layer, if there is
evidence of clogging.
Maintaining the surface vegetation (if present).
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 23
11.5. Checking Tools
This section provides a number of checking aids for designers and assessment
officers. In addition, the following checking tools are provided:
Design Assessment Checklist
Construction Inspection Checklist (during and post)
Operation and Maintenance Inspection Form
Asset Transfer Checklist (following on-maintenance period).
11.5.1. Design Assessment Checklist
The Design Assessment Checklist presents the key design features that are to be
reviewed when assessing the design of an infiltration system. These considerations
include configuration, safety, maintenance and operational issues that need to be
addressed during the design phase. If an item receives an N when reviewing the
design, referral is to be made back to the design procedure to determine the impact of
the omission or error.
In addition to the checklist, a proposed design should have all necessary permits for its
installation. Assessment officers will require that all relevant permits are in place prior
to accepting a design.
11.5.2. Construction Checklist
The Construction Checklist presents the key items to be reviewed when inspecting the
infiltration measure during and at the completion of construction. The checklist is to be
used by Construction Site Supervisors and Compliance Inspectors to ensure all the
elements of the infiltration measure have been constructed in accordance with the
design. If an item receives an N in satisfactory criteria then appropriate actions must
be specified and delivered to rectify the construction issue before final inspection sign-
off is given.
11.5.3. Operation and Maintenance Inspection Form
In addition to checking and maintaining the function of pre-treatment elements, the
Operation and Maintenance Form can be used during routine maintenance inspections
of the infiltration measure and kept as a record on the asset condition and quantity of
removed pollutants over time. Inspections should occur every 1 - 6 months depending on
the size and complexity of the system. More detailed site specific maintenance schedules
should be developed for major infiltration systems and include a brief overview of the
operation of the system and key aspects to be checked during each inspection.
11.5.4. Asset Transfer Checklist
Land ownership and asset ownership are key considerations prior to construction of a
stormwater treatment device. A proposed design should clearly identify the asset
owner and who is responsible for its maintenance. The proposed owner should be
responsible for performing the asset transfer checklist. The Asset Transfer Checklist
provides a template for facilitating asset transfer following the maintenance period.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 24
Infiltration Measure Design Assessment Checklist
Asset I.D.
Infiltration Measure Location:
Hydraulics: Design operational flow (m
3
/s): Above design flow (m
3
/s):
Area: Catchment Area (ha): Infiltration Area (m
2
): Detention Volume (m
3
):
SITE AND SOIL EVALUATION Y N
Site and Soil Evaluation undertaken
Soil types appropriate for infiltration (Ksat > 0.36mm/hr, no salinity problems, no rock/shale)?
PRE-TREATMENT
Groundwater conditions assessed and objectives established?
Level 1 Pre-Treatment provided?
Level 2 Pre-Treatment provided?
INFILTRATION SYSTEM Y N
Design objective established?
Has the appropriate design approach been adopted?
Infiltration system setbacks appropriate?
Base of infiltration system >1m above seasonal high groundwater table?
Has appropriate cover (soil depth above infiltration system) been provided?
If placed on >10% terrain (ground slope), has engineering assessment been undertaken?
FLOW MANAGEMENT Y N
Overall flow conveyance system sufficient for design flood event?
Are the inflow systems designed to convey design flows?
Bypass/ overflow sufficient for conveyance of design flood event?
COMMENTS
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 25
Infiltration Measures Construction Inspection Checklist
Asset I.D. Inspected by:
Site: Date:
Time:
Constructed by: Weather:
Contact during
visit:
Items inspected
Checked Satisfactory
Items inspected
Checked Satisfactory
Y N Y N Y N Y N
DURING CONSTRUCTION
A. FUNCTIONAL INSTALLATION Structural components
Preliminary Works
10. Location and levels of infiltration system and overflow
points as designed
1. Erosion and sediment control plan adopted 11. Pipe joints and connections as designed
2. Traffic control measures 12. Concrete and reinforcement as designed
3. Location same as plans 13. Inlets appropriately installed
4. Site protection from existing flows 14.Provision of geofabric to sides and base
Earthworks 15. Correct fill media/modular system used
5. Excavation as designed B. SEDIMENT & EROSION CONTROL (if required)
6. Side slopes are stable 16. Stabilisation immediately following earthworks
Pre-treatment 17. Silt fences and traffic control in place
7. Maintenance access provided 18. Temporary protection layers in place
8. Invert levels as designed C. OPERATIONAL ESTABLISHMENT
9. Ability to freely drain
19. Temporary protection layers and associated silt
removed
FINAL INSPECTION
1. Confirm levels of inlets and outlets 6. Check for uneven settling of surface
2. Traffic control in place 7. No surface clogging
3. Confirm structural element sizes 8. Maintenance access provided
4. Gravel as specified 9. Construction generated sediment and debris removed
5. Confirm pre-treatment is working
COMMENTS ON INSPECTION
ACTIONS REQUIRED
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Inspection officer signature:
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 26
Infiltration Measures Maintenance Checklist
Asset I.D.
Inspection Frequency: 1 to 6 monthly Date of Visit:
Location:
Description:
Site Visit by:
INSPECTION ITEMS Y N ACTION REQUIRED (DETAILS)
Sediment accumulation in pre-treatment zone?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures?
Evidence of dumping (eg building waste)?
Evidence of extended ponding times (eg. algal growth)?
Evidence of silt and clogging within 'detention volume'?
Clogging of flow management systems (sediment or debris)?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
Drainage system inspected?
Resetting of system required?
COMMENTS
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 27
Infiltration Measure Asset Transfer Checklist
Asset Description:
Asset ID:
Asset Location:
Construction by:
'On-maintenance' Period:
TREATMENT Y N
System appears to be working as designed visually?
No obvious signs of under-performance?
MAINTENANCE Y N
Maintenance plans and indicative maintenance costs provided for each asset?
Inspection and maintenance undertaken as per maintenance plan?
Inspection and maintenance forms provided?
ASSET INSPECTED FOR DEFECTS AND/OR MAINTENANCE ISSUES AT TIME OF ASSET TRANFSFER Y N
Sediment accumulation at inflow points?
Litter present?
Erosion at inlet or other key structures?
Traffic damage present?
Evidence of dumping (e.g. building waste)?
Evidence of ponding?
Surface clogging visible?
Damage/vandalism to structures present?
COMMENTS
ASSET INFORMATION Y N
Design Assessment Checklist provided?
As constructed plans provided?
Copies of all required permits (both construction and operational) submitted?
Proprietary information provided (if applicable)?
Digital files (eg drawings, survey, models) provided?
Asset listed on asset register or database?
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 28
11.6. Infiltration measure worked
example
11.6.1. Worked example introduction
An infiltration system is to be installed to treat stormwater runoff from a residential
allotment. Pre-treatment of stormwater prior to discharge into the ground via
infiltration is essential to ensure sustainable operation of the infiltration system and
protection of groundwater (as discussed in Australian Runoff Quality, Engineers
Australia, 2006). Suspended solids and sediment are the key water quality
constituents requiring pre-treatment prior to infiltration. Roof runoff is directed into a
rainwater tank for storage and to be used as an alternative source of water. Overflow
from the rainwater tank can be discharged directly into the gravel trench for infiltration
into the surrounding sandy soil without further pre-treatment. Stormwater runoff from
paved areas will be directed to a pre-treatment vegetated swale and then into a gravel
trench for temporary storage and infiltration. An illustration of the proposed allotment
stormwater management scheme is shown in Figure 11.7.
Figure 11.7 Illustration of Allotment Stormwater Management Scheme
[source: Urban Water Resource Centre, University of South Australia;
http://www.unisa.edu.au/uwrc/ham.htm ]
The allotment in question in this worked example is 10000 m
2
in area on a rectangular
site with an overall impervious surface area of 5000 m
2
. The site layout is shown in
Figure 11.8.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 29
5KL
rainwater
tank
Figure 11.8 Site Layout
Of the impervious surfaces, roof areas make up a total of 2100 m
2
, while on-ground
impervious surfaces make up the remaining 2900 m
2
. There is no formal stormwater
drainage system, with stormwater runoff discharging into a small table drain in the
front of the property. The design objective of the infiltration system is retention of
stormwater runoff from the allotment with a hydrologic effectiveness of 95%.
Stormwater flows in excess of the detention capacity of the infiltration system are
directed towards the road table drain at the front of the property.
Roof runoff is directed to a 5 kL rainwater tank. Although rainwater tanks can provide
significant peak discharge reduction owing to their available storage capacity, in this
worked example an assumption is made that the 5kL tank will be full. The design
criteria for the infiltration system are to:
Provide pre-treatment of stormwater runoff.
Determine an appropriate size of infiltration system.
Ensure that the inlet configuration to the infiltration system includes provision
for by-pass of stormwater when the infiltration system is operating at its full
capacity.
This worked example focuses on the design of the infiltration system and associated
hydraulic structures.
11.6.2. Step 1: Site and Soil Evaluation
The site characteristics are summarised as follows:
Catchment area 2100 m
2
(roof)
2900 m
2
(ground level paved)
5000 m
2
(pervious)
10000 m
2
(Total)
Landuse/surface type pervious area is either grassed or landscaped with
garden beds.
Overland flow slope Lot is 25m wide, 40m deep, slope = 3%
To define the sites suitability for infiltration of stormwater Boreholes were
drilled at 2 locations within the site and the results are as follows:
Soil type = sandy loam
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 30
Hydraulic conductivity = 80 mm/hr
Presence of soil salinity = no problems discovered
Presence of rock or shale = no rock or shale discovered
Slope/ terrain (%) = 2 4 %, ground level 10 m Height Datum (HD) in
infiltration location
Groundwater details (depth, quality and uses) = water table 5 m below surface
(5 m HD), moderate water quality with local bores used for irrigation.
Field tests found the soil to be suitable for infiltration.
11.6.3. Step 2: Confirm Design Objectives
The design objectives are summarised as follows:
Size infiltration trench to retain 95% of the mean annual runoff volume from
the site.
Design the inlet and outlet structures to convey the peak 3-month ARI flow
from the critical (flow rate) storm event. Ensure the inlet configuration includes
provision for stormwater bypass when the infiltration system is full.
Pre-treat stormwater runoff.
Design appropriate ground cover and terrestrial vegetation over the infiltration
trench.
11.6.4. Step 3: Select Infiltration System Type
Based on the site attributes, the scale of the infiltration application (i.e. 1.0 ha) and
Table 11.1, an infiltration soak-away system is selected.
11.6.5. Step 4: Pre-treatment Design
An infiltration soak-away has been selected for the site, reference to Section 11.2.4
and Table 11.3 indicates that Level 1 pre-treatment is required. Roof runoff is directed
to a rainwater tank. Although the tank may often be full, it nevertheless serves a
useful function as a sedimentation basin. A conservative approach to calculating the
infiltration capacity was taken by assuming that the 5kL tank will be full at the
commencement of the design event. This configuration is considered sufficient to
provide the required sediment pre-treatment for roof runoff.
Stormwater runoff from paved areas is directed to a combination of grass buffer areas
and a vegetated swale area which is slightly depressed to provide for trapping of
suspended solids conveyed by stormwater. Stormwater flows from the swale area into
a grated sump pit and then into the infiltration system.
Pre-treatment for sediment removal is therefore provided by the following:
Connection of roof runoff into a rainwater tank;
Paved area runoff is conveyed to a combination of grassed buffer areas and a
vegetated swale.
11.6.6. Step 5: Determine Design Flows
As described in Section 11.3.5.1, the design operation flow is required to size the inlet
to the infiltration system. In this case, flows into the infiltration system are to be
regulated through a discharge control pit, which will deliver flows up to the 3-month
ARI into the infiltration system. Flows greater than the 3-month ARI, or when the
infiltration system is full, will bypass the infiltration system by overtopping the overflow
weir in the discharge control pit. Therefore:
design operation flow = 3-month ARI
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 31
Design flows and Runoff Coefficients were estimated using the Rational Method as
described in the Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage (Public Utilities Board
2006).
Catchment area = 10000 m
2
t
c
~ 6 min
C = 0.65
Rainfall Intensities t
c
= 6 mins
I
3 month
= 60.6 mm/hr
I
100
= 275 mm/hr
Rational Method Q = CIA/360 [A = 1.0 Ha]
Q
3 month
= 0.109 m
3
/s
Q
100
= 0.497 m
3
/s
11.6.7. Step 6: Size Infiltration System
Estimating the required storage volume of the infiltration system is through computer
simulation or reference to the design curves in Figure 11.6.
With a sandy loam in situ soil, a saturated hydraulic conductivity of 360 mm/hr is
adopted and Figure 11.6 shows that the required storage area (assuming an effective
depth of 1m) is 3% of the contributing impervious area. Thus the storage volume
required is 0.65 x 10000 x 0.03 = 195 m
3
.
11.6.8. Step 7: Locate Infiltration System
As the general fall of the site is to the front of the property, it is proposed that the
infiltration system be sited near the front of the property with paved area runoff
directed to grassed buffers and a feature vegetated landscaped area adjacent to the
infiltration system. Given the sandy soil profile of the site, the minimum distance of the
infiltration system from structures and property boundary is 1 m.
Overflow from the infiltration system will be directed to the table drain of the street in
front of the property.
11.6.9. Step 8: Set Infiltration Depths
The depth of the infiltration systems must be set to ensure the base is a minimum of
1.0 m above the seasonal high water table and there is a minimum of 0.3 m cover.
Considering the water table sits 5 m below surface, a maximum infiltration depth of 3.7
m applies with 0.5m of soil covering the soak-away.
Infiltration depth = 1.0 m
Depth to water table = 3.5 m
The available site area is approximately 48 m
2
and therefore, the effective depth to
achieve storage of 195m
3
is 4.1 m. A gravel-filled trench will be used and will have a
porosity of 0.35. The resulting actual depth of the infiltration tank will need to be
11.7m.
The proposed layout of the infiltration system is shown in Figure 11.9.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 32
Figure 11.9 Layout of Stormwater Infiltration System
11.6.10. Step 9: Specify Infiltration Detention Volume Elements
The following design specification applies to the infiltration soak-away:
Gravel - clean (fines free) stone/ gravel with a uniform size of 5 mm diameter.
Geofabric - Geofabric must to be installed along the side walls and through the
base of the infiltration detention volume to prevent the migration of in-situ soils
into the system. Geofabric must be non-woven type with a minimum
perforation or mesh size of 0.25 mm.
11.6.11. Step 10: Hydraulic Control Design
Flow into the infiltration soak-away will be regulated through a discharge control pit
with overflow or bypass flows being directed into the piped drainage system located in
the road reserve. As depicted in Figure 11.10. The discharge control pit consists of
the following:
Inflow pipe - connection between the pit and the infiltration basin sized to
convey design operation flow (3-month ARI)
Perforated inflow pipes - to distribute design operation flow (3-month ARI)
into the gravel filled detention volume
overflow weir flows above the 3-month ARI to bypass the infiltration system
and to be directed to the street table drain.
5KL
rainwater
tank
16
x 3m
infiltration unit
Discharge
control pit
Pre- treatment
vegetated
landscaped
area
Overflow
connected to
drain
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 33
Figure 11.10 Pit Inlet design Connection to Infiltration System
Peak 3-month design flow = 0.109 m
3
/s (calculated previously) and assuming pervious
area not contributing any runoff. There will be approximately 0.046 m
3
/s discharging
from the rainwater tank overflow and 0.063 m
3
/s from other paved areas.
There are two inlets to the infiltration system, i.e. one from the rainwater tank and the
second from the driveway (see Figure 11.9). These inlets are to be designed to
discharge flows up to 0.063 m
3
/s each into the infiltration trench with overflows
directed to the table drain on the street in front of the property.
Pipe connections from the inlet pits to the infiltration system and street table drain are
computed using the orifice flow
gh C
Q
A
d
o
2
=
C
d
= Discharge Coefficient for sharp edge orifice (0.6)
h = Depth of water above the centroid of the orifice (m)
A
o
= Orifice area (m
2
)
For pipe connections to the infiltration system, adopt h = 0.15 m; Q = 0.063m
3
/s
This gives an orifice area (A
o
) of 0.062 m
2
, equivalent to a 280 mm diameter pipe
adopt 300 mm diameter uPVC pipe.
9.1.311.6.12. Perforated Inflow Pipes
To ensure appropriate distribution of flows into the gravel filled detention volume,
three 300 mm diameter perforated pipes laid in parallel (0.75 m apart) are to accept
flows from the 300 mm diameter RCP.
Two design checks are required:
Ensure the pipe has capacity to convey the design operation flow (0.109 m
3
/s).
Ensure the perforations are adequate to pass the design operation flow.
Internal Weir
Compacted Soil
500
1200
600
400
Gravel - filled
soakaway
300m UPVC
Outlet pipe
Mesh Screen
Discharge
Control Pit
Formatted: Indent: Left: 0 cm,
Hanging: 1.59 cm, Outline numbered
+ Level: 3 + Numbering Style: 1, 2, 3,
+ Start at: 1 + Alignment: Left +
Aligned at: 1.11 cm + Indent at: 2.38
cm
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 34
Perforated Pipe Conveyance
Mannings equation is applied to estimate the flow rate in the perforated pipes and
confirm the capacity of the pipes is sufficient to convey the design operation flow
(0.109 m
3
/s). The three 300 mm diameter perforated pipes are to be laid in parallel at
a grade of 0.5 %.
n
S R A
Q
2
1
3
2
. .
= Mannings equation
Applying the Mannings equation using Mannings n = 0.015 finds:
Q (flow per pipe) = 0.320 m
3
/s
Q
Total
= 0.960 m
3
/s (for three pipes) > 0.109 m
3
/s, and hence OK.
Perforated Pipe Slot Conveyance
To ensure the perforated pipe slots are not a hydraulic choke in the system, the flow
capacity of perforated pipe slots is estimated and compared with the design operation
flow (0.109 m
3
/s). To estimate the flow rate, an orifice equation (equation 11-5) is
applied as follows:
h g 2 A C B Q
d orifice
=
Where:
Head (h) = 0.4 m
Blockage (B) = 0.5 (50 % blocked)
Area (A) = 3150 mm
2
/m clear perforations, hence blocked area
= 1575 mm
2
/m
Slot Width = 1.5 mm
Slot Length = 7.5 mm
Pipe diameter = 300 mm
Coefficient (C
d
) = 0.61 (assume slot width acts as a sharp edged orifice).
Number of unblocked slots per metre = (1575)/(1.5x7.5) = 140
(Note: blockage factor (B) already accounted for in Area calculation above)
Inlet capacity /m of pipe = 140 ] 4 . 0 81 . 9 2 ) 0075 . 0 0015 . 0 ( 61 . 0 [
= 0.0027 m
3
/s
Inlet capacity/m x total length (3 lengths of 16 m)
= 0.0027 x (3 x 16) = 0.129 m
3
/s > 0.109, hence OK.
Perforated pipes = 3 x 300 mm diameter perforated pipe laid in parallel, 0.75 m apart
and at 0.5 % grade.
11.6.12.11.6.13. Bypass Design
An overflow weir (internal weir) located within the discharge control pit (Figure 11.11)
separates the inflow pipe to the infiltration system from the overflow pipe that conveys
excess flows to the street table drain. The overflow internal weirs in discharge control
pits are to be sized to convey the peak 3-month ARI flow and the overflow weir is
designed to provide at least 150m freeboard i.e.
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 35
(For conservative design, choose the larger flow for design of discharge control pit,
0.063 m
3
/s)
Q
design
= 2 x 0.063 m
3
/s (two inlet pits) = 0.126m
3
/s
The weir flow equation (equation 11-6) is used to determine the required weir length:
2 / 3
w weir
h L C B Q =
So, using the
Q
design
flow = 0.126 m
3
/s
B = 1.0 (no blockage for internal weir)
C
w
= 1.66
h = 0.3 m
We can solve for L, giving a weir length (L) = 0.46 m.
To size the pipe connection to the street table drain, use the orifice equation and solve
for A
h g 2 A C B Q
d orifice
=
Adopting:
h =0.40 m;
Q = 0.126 m
3
/s
B = 1
g = 9.81
C
d
= 0.6 (assumes sharp edge orifice)
This gives an orifice area (A) of 0.075 m
2
, equivalent to a 310 mm diameter pipe
adopt 450 mm diameter uPVC pipe.
Figure 11.11 Weir used for infiltration system bypass
Discharge control pit
600
250
600m UPVC pipe
connected to street
drainage system 300mm UPVC
High
flows
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 36
11.6.13.11.6.14. Design Calculation Summary
.INFILTRATION SYSTEMS DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Calculation Task Outcome Check
Catchment Characteristics
Catchment area 0.1 ha
Catchment landuse (i.e residential, commercial etc.) Residential
Storm event entering infiltration system (minor or major) 3-month year ARI
1 Site and soil evaluation
Site and Soil Evaluation' undertaken in accordance
Soil type Sandy-loam
Hydraulic conductivity (Ksat) 360 mm/hr
Presence of soil salinity No
Presence of rock/shale No
Infiltration site terrain (% slope) 3
Groundwater level RL 5 m
5 m below surface
Groundwater quality Moderate
Groundwater uses Irrigation
2 Confirm design objectives
Confirm design objective as defined by conceptual design 95% HE
3 Select infiltration system type
Leaky Well
Infiltration Trench
Infiltration 'Soak-away'
Infiltration Basin
4 Pre-treatment design
Level 1 Pre-treatment (avoid clogging)
Level 2 Pre-treatment (groundwater quality protection)
5 Determine design flows
'Design operation flow' (< or =1 year ARI) 3-month year ARI
'Above design flow' (2 - 100 year ARI) 100 year ARI
Time of concentration
6 minutes
Identify rainfall intensities
'Design operation flow' - I1 year ARI 60.6 mm/hr
'Above design flow'- I2 100 year ARI 275 mm/hr
Design runoff coefficient
'Design operation flow' - C1 year ARI 0.65
'Above design flow'- C2 100 year ARI 0.65
Peak design flows
'Design operation flow' 3-month ARI 0.109 m
3
/s
'Above design flow' (100 year ARI) 0.497 m
3
/s
6 Size infiltration system
Hydrologic effectiveness approach
Hydrologic effectiveness objective 95 %
Depth - m
Porosity (void = 1.0, gravel filled = 0.35) 0.35
'Infiltration Area' 48 m
2
'Detention Volume' 19.5 m
3
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 37
.INFILTRATION SYSTEMS DESIGN CALCULATION SUMMARY
CALCULATION SUMMARY
Calculation Task Outcome Check
7 Locate infiltration system
Minimum distance from boundary (Table 11.5) 1.2 m
Width 3 m
Length 16 m
8 Set infiltration depths (sub-surface systems only)
Ground surface level RL10 m
Groundwater level RL 5 m
5 m below surface
Infiltration system depth 1.2 m
Top of infiltration system RL 4.5 m
Base of infiltration system RL 3.3 m
Cover 0.5 m
Depth to water table 1.7 m
9 Specify infiltration 'detention volume' elements
Gravel size 5 mm diam.
Modular plastic cells
Geofabric
10 Flow management design
Inflow/Overflow structures
Direct inflow
Overflow pit/pipe
Discharge control pit
Discharge pipe
Pipe capacity 0.126 m
3
/s
Pipe size 450 mm diam.
Inflow pipe
Pipe capacity 0.063 m
3
/s
Pipe size 300 mm diam.
Overflow pipe
Pipe capacity 0.126 m
3
/s
Pipe size 450 mm diam.
Overflow pit
Pit capacity - m
3
/s N/A
Pit size - mm x mm N/A
Perforated inflow pipes
No. of pipes 3
Pipe size 300 mm
Discharge control pit
Pit size mm x mm N/A
Weir length 1 m N/A
Chapter Chapter Chapter Chapter 11 11 11 11 Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems Infiltration Systems
ABC Waters Stormwater Quality Management Guidelines Page 38
11.7. References
Argue JR (ed) 2004, Water Sensitive Urban Design: Basic Procedures for Source
Control of Stormwater, AWA, University of South Australia
CRCCH (Cooperative Research Centre for Catchment Hydrology), 2003, Model for
Urban Stormwater Improvement Conceptualisation (MUSIC) User Guide, Version 2.0,
December
DPI, IMEA & BCC (Department of Primary Industries Water Resources, Institute of
Municipal Engineers Australia Qld Division & Brisbane City Council) 1992,
Queensland Urban Drainage Manual (QUDM), prepared by Neville Jones &
Associates and Australian Water Engineering for DPI, IMEA & BCC, Brisbane
1
.
Engineers Australia 2006, Australian Runoff Quality, Engineers Australia,
ACT,http://www.arq.org.au/
Engineers Australia, 2003, Australian Runoff Quality Guidelines, DRAFT, June
Institution of Engineers Australia, 1997, Australian Rainfall and Runoff A guide to
flood estimation, Editor in Chief Pilgram, D.H.
Leinster, S 2006, Delivering the Final Product Establishing Water Sensitive Urban
Design Systems, 7
th
International Conference on Urban Drainage Modelling and 4
th
International Conference on Water Sensitive Urban Design Book of Proceedings,
Volume 2, A Deletic and T Fletcher (eds), Melbourne.
Melbourne Water. 2005. WSUD Engineering Procedures: Stormwater. CSIRO
Publishing.
Public Utilities Board (2006). Code of Practice on Surface Water Drainage. Singapore.
50p.
Standards Australia 2000, AS/NZS 1547:2000: On-site domestic wastewater
management, Standards Australia
UPRCT (Upper Parramatta River Catchment Trust) 2004, Water Sensitive Urban
Design: Technical Guidelines for Western Sydney, prepared by URS Australia Pty Ltd
for UPRCT, NSW